expr.c (store_constructor_field): If bit position is not multiple of alignment of...
[gcc.git] / gcc / expr.c
1 /* Convert tree expression to rtl instructions, for GNU compiler.
2 Copyright (C) 1988, 92-98, 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3
4 This file is part of GNU CC.
5
6 GNU CC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
7 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
8 the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
9 any later version.
10
11 GNU CC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
12 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
13 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
14 GNU General Public License for more details.
15
16 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
17 along with GNU CC; see the file COPYING. If not, write to
18 the Free Software Foundation, 59 Temple Place - Suite 330,
19 Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
20
21
22 #include "config.h"
23 #include "system.h"
24 #include "machmode.h"
25 #include "rtl.h"
26 #include "tree.h"
27 #include "obstack.h"
28 #include "flags.h"
29 #include "regs.h"
30 #include "hard-reg-set.h"
31 #include "except.h"
32 #include "function.h"
33 #include "insn-flags.h"
34 #include "insn-codes.h"
35 #include "insn-config.h"
36 /* Include expr.h after insn-config.h so we get HAVE_conditional_move. */
37 #include "expr.h"
38 #include "recog.h"
39 #include "output.h"
40 #include "typeclass.h"
41 #include "defaults.h"
42 #include "toplev.h"
43 #include "ggc.h"
44 #include "tm_p.h"
45
46 #define CEIL(x,y) (((x) + (y) - 1) / (y))
47
48 /* Decide whether a function's arguments should be processed
49 from first to last or from last to first.
50
51 They should if the stack and args grow in opposite directions, but
52 only if we have push insns. */
53
54 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
55
56 #if defined (STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD) != defined (ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD)
57 #define PUSH_ARGS_REVERSED /* If it's last to first */
58 #endif
59
60 #endif
61
62 #ifndef STACK_PUSH_CODE
63 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
64 #define STACK_PUSH_CODE PRE_DEC
65 #else
66 #define STACK_PUSH_CODE PRE_INC
67 #endif
68 #endif
69
70 /* Assume that case vectors are not pc-relative. */
71 #ifndef CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE
72 #define CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE 0
73 #endif
74
75 /* If this is nonzero, we do not bother generating VOLATILE
76 around volatile memory references, and we are willing to
77 output indirect addresses. If cse is to follow, we reject
78 indirect addresses so a useful potential cse is generated;
79 if it is used only once, instruction combination will produce
80 the same indirect address eventually. */
81 int cse_not_expected;
82
83 /* Nonzero to generate code for all the subroutines within an
84 expression before generating the upper levels of the expression.
85 Nowadays this is never zero. */
86 int do_preexpand_calls = 1;
87
88 /* Don't check memory usage, since code is being emitted to check a memory
89 usage. Used when current_function_check_memory_usage is true, to avoid
90 infinite recursion. */
91 static int in_check_memory_usage;
92
93 /* Chain of pending expressions for PLACEHOLDER_EXPR to replace. */
94 static tree placeholder_list = 0;
95
96 /* This structure is used by move_by_pieces to describe the move to
97 be performed. */
98 struct move_by_pieces
99 {
100 rtx to;
101 rtx to_addr;
102 int autinc_to;
103 int explicit_inc_to;
104 int to_struct;
105 int to_readonly;
106 rtx from;
107 rtx from_addr;
108 int autinc_from;
109 int explicit_inc_from;
110 int from_struct;
111 int from_readonly;
112 int len;
113 int offset;
114 int reverse;
115 };
116
117 /* This structure is used by clear_by_pieces to describe the clear to
118 be performed. */
119
120 struct clear_by_pieces
121 {
122 rtx to;
123 rtx to_addr;
124 int autinc_to;
125 int explicit_inc_to;
126 int to_struct;
127 int len;
128 int offset;
129 int reverse;
130 };
131
132 extern struct obstack permanent_obstack;
133
134 static rtx get_push_address PROTO ((int));
135
136 static rtx enqueue_insn PROTO((rtx, rtx));
137 static int move_by_pieces_ninsns PROTO((unsigned int, int));
138 static void move_by_pieces_1 PROTO((rtx (*) (rtx, ...), enum machine_mode,
139 struct move_by_pieces *));
140 static void clear_by_pieces PROTO((rtx, int, int));
141 static void clear_by_pieces_1 PROTO((rtx (*) (rtx, ...),
142 enum machine_mode,
143 struct clear_by_pieces *));
144 static int is_zeros_p PROTO((tree));
145 static int mostly_zeros_p PROTO((tree));
146 static void store_constructor_field PROTO((rtx, int, int, enum machine_mode,
147 tree, tree, int, int));
148 static void store_constructor PROTO((tree, rtx, int, int));
149 static rtx store_field PROTO((rtx, int, int, enum machine_mode, tree,
150 enum machine_mode, int, int,
151 int, int));
152 static enum memory_use_mode
153 get_memory_usage_from_modifier PROTO((enum expand_modifier));
154 static tree save_noncopied_parts PROTO((tree, tree));
155 static tree init_noncopied_parts PROTO((tree, tree));
156 static int safe_from_p PROTO((rtx, tree, int));
157 static int fixed_type_p PROTO((tree));
158 static rtx var_rtx PROTO((tree));
159 static int readonly_fields_p PROTO((tree));
160 static rtx expand_expr_unaligned PROTO((tree, int *));
161 static rtx expand_increment PROTO((tree, int, int));
162 static void preexpand_calls PROTO((tree));
163 static void do_jump_by_parts_greater PROTO((tree, int, rtx, rtx));
164 static void do_jump_by_parts_equality PROTO((tree, rtx, rtx));
165 static void do_compare_and_jump PROTO((tree, enum rtx_code, enum rtx_code, rtx, rtx));
166 static rtx do_store_flag PROTO((tree, rtx, enum machine_mode, int));
167
168 /* Record for each mode whether we can move a register directly to or
169 from an object of that mode in memory. If we can't, we won't try
170 to use that mode directly when accessing a field of that mode. */
171
172 static char direct_load[NUM_MACHINE_MODES];
173 static char direct_store[NUM_MACHINE_MODES];
174
175 /* If a memory-to-memory move would take MOVE_RATIO or more simple
176 move-instruction sequences, we will do a movstr or libcall instead. */
177
178 #ifndef MOVE_RATIO
179 #if defined (HAVE_movstrqi) || defined (HAVE_movstrhi) || defined (HAVE_movstrsi) || defined (HAVE_movstrdi) || defined (HAVE_movstrti)
180 #define MOVE_RATIO 2
181 #else
182 /* If we are optimizing for space (-Os), cut down the default move ratio */
183 #define MOVE_RATIO (optimize_size ? 3 : 15)
184 #endif
185 #endif
186
187 /* This macro is used to determine whether move_by_pieces should be called
188 to perform a structure copy. */
189 #ifndef MOVE_BY_PIECES_P
190 #define MOVE_BY_PIECES_P(SIZE, ALIGN) (move_by_pieces_ninsns \
191 (SIZE, ALIGN) < MOVE_RATIO)
192 #endif
193
194 /* This array records the insn_code of insns to perform block moves. */
195 enum insn_code movstr_optab[NUM_MACHINE_MODES];
196
197 /* This array records the insn_code of insns to perform block clears. */
198 enum insn_code clrstr_optab[NUM_MACHINE_MODES];
199
200 /* SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS is non-zero if unaligned accesses are very slow. */
201
202 #ifndef SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS
203 #define SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS STRICT_ALIGNMENT
204 #endif
205 \f
206 /* This is run once per compilation to set up which modes can be used
207 directly in memory and to initialize the block move optab. */
208
209 void
210 init_expr_once ()
211 {
212 rtx insn, pat;
213 enum machine_mode mode;
214 int num_clobbers;
215 rtx mem, mem1;
216 char *free_point;
217
218 start_sequence ();
219
220 /* Since we are on the permanent obstack, we must be sure we save this
221 spot AFTER we call start_sequence, since it will reuse the rtl it
222 makes. */
223 free_point = (char *) oballoc (0);
224
225 /* Try indexing by frame ptr and try by stack ptr.
226 It is known that on the Convex the stack ptr isn't a valid index.
227 With luck, one or the other is valid on any machine. */
228 mem = gen_rtx_MEM (VOIDmode, stack_pointer_rtx);
229 mem1 = gen_rtx_MEM (VOIDmode, frame_pointer_rtx);
230
231 insn = emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (0, NULL_RTX, NULL_RTX));
232 pat = PATTERN (insn);
233
234 for (mode = VOIDmode; (int) mode < NUM_MACHINE_MODES;
235 mode = (enum machine_mode) ((int) mode + 1))
236 {
237 int regno;
238 rtx reg;
239
240 direct_load[(int) mode] = direct_store[(int) mode] = 0;
241 PUT_MODE (mem, mode);
242 PUT_MODE (mem1, mode);
243
244 /* See if there is some register that can be used in this mode and
245 directly loaded or stored from memory. */
246
247 if (mode != VOIDmode && mode != BLKmode)
248 for (regno = 0; regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
249 && (direct_load[(int) mode] == 0 || direct_store[(int) mode] == 0);
250 regno++)
251 {
252 if (! HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (regno, mode))
253 continue;
254
255 reg = gen_rtx_REG (mode, regno);
256
257 SET_SRC (pat) = mem;
258 SET_DEST (pat) = reg;
259 if (recog (pat, insn, &num_clobbers) >= 0)
260 direct_load[(int) mode] = 1;
261
262 SET_SRC (pat) = mem1;
263 SET_DEST (pat) = reg;
264 if (recog (pat, insn, &num_clobbers) >= 0)
265 direct_load[(int) mode] = 1;
266
267 SET_SRC (pat) = reg;
268 SET_DEST (pat) = mem;
269 if (recog (pat, insn, &num_clobbers) >= 0)
270 direct_store[(int) mode] = 1;
271
272 SET_SRC (pat) = reg;
273 SET_DEST (pat) = mem1;
274 if (recog (pat, insn, &num_clobbers) >= 0)
275 direct_store[(int) mode] = 1;
276 }
277 }
278
279 end_sequence ();
280 obfree (free_point);
281 }
282
283 /* This is run at the start of compiling a function. */
284
285 void
286 init_expr ()
287 {
288 current_function->expr
289 = (struct expr_status *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct expr_status));
290
291 pending_chain = 0;
292 pending_stack_adjust = 0;
293 inhibit_defer_pop = 0;
294 saveregs_value = 0;
295 apply_args_value = 0;
296 forced_labels = 0;
297 }
298
299 void
300 mark_expr_status (p)
301 struct expr_status *p;
302 {
303 if (p == NULL)
304 return;
305
306 ggc_mark_rtx (p->x_saveregs_value);
307 ggc_mark_rtx (p->x_apply_args_value);
308 ggc_mark_rtx (p->x_forced_labels);
309 }
310
311 void
312 free_expr_status (f)
313 struct function *f;
314 {
315 free (f->expr);
316 f->expr = NULL;
317 }
318
319 /* Small sanity check that the queue is empty at the end of a function. */
320 void
321 finish_expr_for_function ()
322 {
323 if (pending_chain)
324 abort ();
325 }
326 \f
327 /* Manage the queue of increment instructions to be output
328 for POSTINCREMENT_EXPR expressions, etc. */
329
330 /* Queue up to increment (or change) VAR later. BODY says how:
331 BODY should be the same thing you would pass to emit_insn
332 to increment right away. It will go to emit_insn later on.
333
334 The value is a QUEUED expression to be used in place of VAR
335 where you want to guarantee the pre-incrementation value of VAR. */
336
337 static rtx
338 enqueue_insn (var, body)
339 rtx var, body;
340 {
341 pending_chain = gen_rtx_QUEUED (GET_MODE (var), var, NULL_RTX, NULL_RTX,
342 body, pending_chain);
343 return pending_chain;
344 }
345
346 /* Use protect_from_queue to convert a QUEUED expression
347 into something that you can put immediately into an instruction.
348 If the queued incrementation has not happened yet,
349 protect_from_queue returns the variable itself.
350 If the incrementation has happened, protect_from_queue returns a temp
351 that contains a copy of the old value of the variable.
352
353 Any time an rtx which might possibly be a QUEUED is to be put
354 into an instruction, it must be passed through protect_from_queue first.
355 QUEUED expressions are not meaningful in instructions.
356
357 Do not pass a value through protect_from_queue and then hold
358 on to it for a while before putting it in an instruction!
359 If the queue is flushed in between, incorrect code will result. */
360
361 rtx
362 protect_from_queue (x, modify)
363 register rtx x;
364 int modify;
365 {
366 register RTX_CODE code = GET_CODE (x);
367
368 #if 0 /* A QUEUED can hang around after the queue is forced out. */
369 /* Shortcut for most common case. */
370 if (pending_chain == 0)
371 return x;
372 #endif
373
374 if (code != QUEUED)
375 {
376 /* A special hack for read access to (MEM (QUEUED ...)) to facilitate
377 use of autoincrement. Make a copy of the contents of the memory
378 location rather than a copy of the address, but not if the value is
379 of mode BLKmode. Don't modify X in place since it might be
380 shared. */
381 if (code == MEM && GET_MODE (x) != BLKmode
382 && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == QUEUED && !modify)
383 {
384 register rtx y = XEXP (x, 0);
385 register rtx new = gen_rtx_MEM (GET_MODE (x), QUEUED_VAR (y));
386
387 RTX_UNCHANGING_P (new) = RTX_UNCHANGING_P (x);
388 MEM_COPY_ATTRIBUTES (new, x);
389 MEM_ALIAS_SET (new) = MEM_ALIAS_SET (x);
390
391 if (QUEUED_INSN (y))
392 {
393 register rtx temp = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (new));
394 emit_insn_before (gen_move_insn (temp, new),
395 QUEUED_INSN (y));
396 return temp;
397 }
398 return new;
399 }
400 /* Otherwise, recursively protect the subexpressions of all
401 the kinds of rtx's that can contain a QUEUED. */
402 if (code == MEM)
403 {
404 rtx tem = protect_from_queue (XEXP (x, 0), 0);
405 if (tem != XEXP (x, 0))
406 {
407 x = copy_rtx (x);
408 XEXP (x, 0) = tem;
409 }
410 }
411 else if (code == PLUS || code == MULT)
412 {
413 rtx new0 = protect_from_queue (XEXP (x, 0), 0);
414 rtx new1 = protect_from_queue (XEXP (x, 1), 0);
415 if (new0 != XEXP (x, 0) || new1 != XEXP (x, 1))
416 {
417 x = copy_rtx (x);
418 XEXP (x, 0) = new0;
419 XEXP (x, 1) = new1;
420 }
421 }
422 return x;
423 }
424 /* If the increment has not happened, use the variable itself. */
425 if (QUEUED_INSN (x) == 0)
426 return QUEUED_VAR (x);
427 /* If the increment has happened and a pre-increment copy exists,
428 use that copy. */
429 if (QUEUED_COPY (x) != 0)
430 return QUEUED_COPY (x);
431 /* The increment has happened but we haven't set up a pre-increment copy.
432 Set one up now, and use it. */
433 QUEUED_COPY (x) = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (QUEUED_VAR (x)));
434 emit_insn_before (gen_move_insn (QUEUED_COPY (x), QUEUED_VAR (x)),
435 QUEUED_INSN (x));
436 return QUEUED_COPY (x);
437 }
438
439 /* Return nonzero if X contains a QUEUED expression:
440 if it contains anything that will be altered by a queued increment.
441 We handle only combinations of MEM, PLUS, MINUS and MULT operators
442 since memory addresses generally contain only those. */
443
444 int
445 queued_subexp_p (x)
446 rtx x;
447 {
448 register enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (x);
449 switch (code)
450 {
451 case QUEUED:
452 return 1;
453 case MEM:
454 return queued_subexp_p (XEXP (x, 0));
455 case MULT:
456 case PLUS:
457 case MINUS:
458 return (queued_subexp_p (XEXP (x, 0))
459 || queued_subexp_p (XEXP (x, 1)));
460 default:
461 return 0;
462 }
463 }
464
465 /* Perform all the pending incrementations. */
466
467 void
468 emit_queue ()
469 {
470 register rtx p;
471 while ((p = pending_chain))
472 {
473 rtx body = QUEUED_BODY (p);
474
475 if (GET_CODE (body) == SEQUENCE)
476 {
477 QUEUED_INSN (p) = XVECEXP (QUEUED_BODY (p), 0, 0);
478 emit_insn (QUEUED_BODY (p));
479 }
480 else
481 QUEUED_INSN (p) = emit_insn (QUEUED_BODY (p));
482 pending_chain = QUEUED_NEXT (p);
483 }
484 }
485 \f
486 /* Copy data from FROM to TO, where the machine modes are not the same.
487 Both modes may be integer, or both may be floating.
488 UNSIGNEDP should be nonzero if FROM is an unsigned type.
489 This causes zero-extension instead of sign-extension. */
490
491 void
492 convert_move (to, from, unsignedp)
493 register rtx to, from;
494 int unsignedp;
495 {
496 enum machine_mode to_mode = GET_MODE (to);
497 enum machine_mode from_mode = GET_MODE (from);
498 int to_real = GET_MODE_CLASS (to_mode) == MODE_FLOAT;
499 int from_real = GET_MODE_CLASS (from_mode) == MODE_FLOAT;
500 enum insn_code code;
501 rtx libcall;
502
503 /* rtx code for making an equivalent value. */
504 enum rtx_code equiv_code = (unsignedp ? ZERO_EXTEND : SIGN_EXTEND);
505
506 to = protect_from_queue (to, 1);
507 from = protect_from_queue (from, 0);
508
509 if (to_real != from_real)
510 abort ();
511
512 /* If FROM is a SUBREG that indicates that we have already done at least
513 the required extension, strip it. We don't handle such SUBREGs as
514 TO here. */
515
516 if (GET_CODE (from) == SUBREG && SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (from)
517 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (from)))
518 >= GET_MODE_SIZE (to_mode))
519 && SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (from) == unsignedp)
520 from = gen_lowpart (to_mode, from), from_mode = to_mode;
521
522 if (GET_CODE (to) == SUBREG && SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (to))
523 abort ();
524
525 if (to_mode == from_mode
526 || (from_mode == VOIDmode && CONSTANT_P (from)))
527 {
528 emit_move_insn (to, from);
529 return;
530 }
531
532 if (to_real)
533 {
534 rtx value;
535
536 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode) < GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode))
537 {
538 /* Try converting directly if the insn is supported. */
539 if ((code = can_extend_p (to_mode, from_mode, 0))
540 != CODE_FOR_nothing)
541 {
542 emit_unop_insn (code, to, from, UNKNOWN);
543 return;
544 }
545 }
546
547 #ifdef HAVE_trunchfqf2
548 if (HAVE_trunchfqf2 && from_mode == HFmode && to_mode == QFmode)
549 {
550 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_trunchfqf2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
551 return;
552 }
553 #endif
554 #ifdef HAVE_trunctqfqf2
555 if (HAVE_trunctqfqf2 && from_mode == TQFmode && to_mode == QFmode)
556 {
557 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_trunctqfqf2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
558 return;
559 }
560 #endif
561 #ifdef HAVE_truncsfqf2
562 if (HAVE_truncsfqf2 && from_mode == SFmode && to_mode == QFmode)
563 {
564 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_truncsfqf2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
565 return;
566 }
567 #endif
568 #ifdef HAVE_truncdfqf2
569 if (HAVE_truncdfqf2 && from_mode == DFmode && to_mode == QFmode)
570 {
571 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_truncdfqf2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
572 return;
573 }
574 #endif
575 #ifdef HAVE_truncxfqf2
576 if (HAVE_truncxfqf2 && from_mode == XFmode && to_mode == QFmode)
577 {
578 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_truncxfqf2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
579 return;
580 }
581 #endif
582 #ifdef HAVE_trunctfqf2
583 if (HAVE_trunctfqf2 && from_mode == TFmode && to_mode == QFmode)
584 {
585 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_trunctfqf2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
586 return;
587 }
588 #endif
589
590 #ifdef HAVE_trunctqfhf2
591 if (HAVE_trunctqfhf2 && from_mode == TQFmode && to_mode == HFmode)
592 {
593 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_trunctqfhf2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
594 return;
595 }
596 #endif
597 #ifdef HAVE_truncsfhf2
598 if (HAVE_truncsfhf2 && from_mode == SFmode && to_mode == HFmode)
599 {
600 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_truncsfhf2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
601 return;
602 }
603 #endif
604 #ifdef HAVE_truncdfhf2
605 if (HAVE_truncdfhf2 && from_mode == DFmode && to_mode == HFmode)
606 {
607 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_truncdfhf2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
608 return;
609 }
610 #endif
611 #ifdef HAVE_truncxfhf2
612 if (HAVE_truncxfhf2 && from_mode == XFmode && to_mode == HFmode)
613 {
614 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_truncxfhf2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
615 return;
616 }
617 #endif
618 #ifdef HAVE_trunctfhf2
619 if (HAVE_trunctfhf2 && from_mode == TFmode && to_mode == HFmode)
620 {
621 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_trunctfhf2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
622 return;
623 }
624 #endif
625
626 #ifdef HAVE_truncsftqf2
627 if (HAVE_truncsftqf2 && from_mode == SFmode && to_mode == TQFmode)
628 {
629 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_truncsftqf2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
630 return;
631 }
632 #endif
633 #ifdef HAVE_truncdftqf2
634 if (HAVE_truncdftqf2 && from_mode == DFmode && to_mode == TQFmode)
635 {
636 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_truncdftqf2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
637 return;
638 }
639 #endif
640 #ifdef HAVE_truncxftqf2
641 if (HAVE_truncxftqf2 && from_mode == XFmode && to_mode == TQFmode)
642 {
643 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_truncxftqf2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
644 return;
645 }
646 #endif
647 #ifdef HAVE_trunctftqf2
648 if (HAVE_trunctftqf2 && from_mode == TFmode && to_mode == TQFmode)
649 {
650 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_trunctftqf2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
651 return;
652 }
653 #endif
654
655 #ifdef HAVE_truncdfsf2
656 if (HAVE_truncdfsf2 && from_mode == DFmode && to_mode == SFmode)
657 {
658 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_truncdfsf2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
659 return;
660 }
661 #endif
662 #ifdef HAVE_truncxfsf2
663 if (HAVE_truncxfsf2 && from_mode == XFmode && to_mode == SFmode)
664 {
665 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_truncxfsf2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
666 return;
667 }
668 #endif
669 #ifdef HAVE_trunctfsf2
670 if (HAVE_trunctfsf2 && from_mode == TFmode && to_mode == SFmode)
671 {
672 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_trunctfsf2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
673 return;
674 }
675 #endif
676 #ifdef HAVE_truncxfdf2
677 if (HAVE_truncxfdf2 && from_mode == XFmode && to_mode == DFmode)
678 {
679 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_truncxfdf2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
680 return;
681 }
682 #endif
683 #ifdef HAVE_trunctfdf2
684 if (HAVE_trunctfdf2 && from_mode == TFmode && to_mode == DFmode)
685 {
686 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_trunctfdf2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
687 return;
688 }
689 #endif
690
691 libcall = (rtx) 0;
692 switch (from_mode)
693 {
694 case SFmode:
695 switch (to_mode)
696 {
697 case DFmode:
698 libcall = extendsfdf2_libfunc;
699 break;
700
701 case XFmode:
702 libcall = extendsfxf2_libfunc;
703 break;
704
705 case TFmode:
706 libcall = extendsftf2_libfunc;
707 break;
708
709 default:
710 break;
711 }
712 break;
713
714 case DFmode:
715 switch (to_mode)
716 {
717 case SFmode:
718 libcall = truncdfsf2_libfunc;
719 break;
720
721 case XFmode:
722 libcall = extenddfxf2_libfunc;
723 break;
724
725 case TFmode:
726 libcall = extenddftf2_libfunc;
727 break;
728
729 default:
730 break;
731 }
732 break;
733
734 case XFmode:
735 switch (to_mode)
736 {
737 case SFmode:
738 libcall = truncxfsf2_libfunc;
739 break;
740
741 case DFmode:
742 libcall = truncxfdf2_libfunc;
743 break;
744
745 default:
746 break;
747 }
748 break;
749
750 case TFmode:
751 switch (to_mode)
752 {
753 case SFmode:
754 libcall = trunctfsf2_libfunc;
755 break;
756
757 case DFmode:
758 libcall = trunctfdf2_libfunc;
759 break;
760
761 default:
762 break;
763 }
764 break;
765
766 default:
767 break;
768 }
769
770 if (libcall == (rtx) 0)
771 /* This conversion is not implemented yet. */
772 abort ();
773
774 value = emit_library_call_value (libcall, NULL_RTX, 1, to_mode,
775 1, from, from_mode);
776 emit_move_insn (to, value);
777 return;
778 }
779
780 /* Now both modes are integers. */
781
782 /* Handle expanding beyond a word. */
783 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode) < GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode)
784 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode) > BITS_PER_WORD)
785 {
786 rtx insns;
787 rtx lowpart;
788 rtx fill_value;
789 rtx lowfrom;
790 int i;
791 enum machine_mode lowpart_mode;
792 int nwords = CEIL (GET_MODE_SIZE (to_mode), UNITS_PER_WORD);
793
794 /* Try converting directly if the insn is supported. */
795 if ((code = can_extend_p (to_mode, from_mode, unsignedp))
796 != CODE_FOR_nothing)
797 {
798 /* If FROM is a SUBREG, put it into a register. Do this
799 so that we always generate the same set of insns for
800 better cse'ing; if an intermediate assignment occurred,
801 we won't be doing the operation directly on the SUBREG. */
802 if (optimize > 0 && GET_CODE (from) == SUBREG)
803 from = force_reg (from_mode, from);
804 emit_unop_insn (code, to, from, equiv_code);
805 return;
806 }
807 /* Next, try converting via full word. */
808 else if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode) < BITS_PER_WORD
809 && ((code = can_extend_p (to_mode, word_mode, unsignedp))
810 != CODE_FOR_nothing))
811 {
812 if (GET_CODE (to) == REG)
813 emit_insn (gen_rtx_CLOBBER (VOIDmode, to));
814 convert_move (gen_lowpart (word_mode, to), from, unsignedp);
815 emit_unop_insn (code, to,
816 gen_lowpart (word_mode, to), equiv_code);
817 return;
818 }
819
820 /* No special multiword conversion insn; do it by hand. */
821 start_sequence ();
822
823 /* Since we will turn this into a no conflict block, we must ensure
824 that the source does not overlap the target. */
825
826 if (reg_overlap_mentioned_p (to, from))
827 from = force_reg (from_mode, from);
828
829 /* Get a copy of FROM widened to a word, if necessary. */
830 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode) < BITS_PER_WORD)
831 lowpart_mode = word_mode;
832 else
833 lowpart_mode = from_mode;
834
835 lowfrom = convert_to_mode (lowpart_mode, from, unsignedp);
836
837 lowpart = gen_lowpart (lowpart_mode, to);
838 emit_move_insn (lowpart, lowfrom);
839
840 /* Compute the value to put in each remaining word. */
841 if (unsignedp)
842 fill_value = const0_rtx;
843 else
844 {
845 #ifdef HAVE_slt
846 if (HAVE_slt
847 && insn_data[(int) CODE_FOR_slt].operand[0].mode == word_mode
848 && STORE_FLAG_VALUE == -1)
849 {
850 emit_cmp_insn (lowfrom, const0_rtx, NE, NULL_RTX,
851 lowpart_mode, 0, 0);
852 fill_value = gen_reg_rtx (word_mode);
853 emit_insn (gen_slt (fill_value));
854 }
855 else
856 #endif
857 {
858 fill_value
859 = expand_shift (RSHIFT_EXPR, lowpart_mode, lowfrom,
860 size_int (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (lowpart_mode) - 1),
861 NULL_RTX, 0);
862 fill_value = convert_to_mode (word_mode, fill_value, 1);
863 }
864 }
865
866 /* Fill the remaining words. */
867 for (i = GET_MODE_SIZE (lowpart_mode) / UNITS_PER_WORD; i < nwords; i++)
868 {
869 int index = (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN ? nwords - i - 1 : i);
870 rtx subword = operand_subword (to, index, 1, to_mode);
871
872 if (subword == 0)
873 abort ();
874
875 if (fill_value != subword)
876 emit_move_insn (subword, fill_value);
877 }
878
879 insns = get_insns ();
880 end_sequence ();
881
882 emit_no_conflict_block (insns, to, from, NULL_RTX,
883 gen_rtx_fmt_e (equiv_code, to_mode, copy_rtx (from)));
884 return;
885 }
886
887 /* Truncating multi-word to a word or less. */
888 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode) > BITS_PER_WORD
889 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode) <= BITS_PER_WORD)
890 {
891 if (!((GET_CODE (from) == MEM
892 && ! MEM_VOLATILE_P (from)
893 && direct_load[(int) to_mode]
894 && ! mode_dependent_address_p (XEXP (from, 0)))
895 || GET_CODE (from) == REG
896 || GET_CODE (from) == SUBREG))
897 from = force_reg (from_mode, from);
898 convert_move (to, gen_lowpart (word_mode, from), 0);
899 return;
900 }
901
902 /* Handle pointer conversion */ /* SPEE 900220 */
903 if (to_mode == PQImode)
904 {
905 if (from_mode != QImode)
906 from = convert_to_mode (QImode, from, unsignedp);
907
908 #ifdef HAVE_truncqipqi2
909 if (HAVE_truncqipqi2)
910 {
911 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_truncqipqi2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
912 return;
913 }
914 #endif /* HAVE_truncqipqi2 */
915 abort ();
916 }
917
918 if (from_mode == PQImode)
919 {
920 if (to_mode != QImode)
921 {
922 from = convert_to_mode (QImode, from, unsignedp);
923 from_mode = QImode;
924 }
925 else
926 {
927 #ifdef HAVE_extendpqiqi2
928 if (HAVE_extendpqiqi2)
929 {
930 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_extendpqiqi2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
931 return;
932 }
933 #endif /* HAVE_extendpqiqi2 */
934 abort ();
935 }
936 }
937
938 if (to_mode == PSImode)
939 {
940 if (from_mode != SImode)
941 from = convert_to_mode (SImode, from, unsignedp);
942
943 #ifdef HAVE_truncsipsi2
944 if (HAVE_truncsipsi2)
945 {
946 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_truncsipsi2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
947 return;
948 }
949 #endif /* HAVE_truncsipsi2 */
950 abort ();
951 }
952
953 if (from_mode == PSImode)
954 {
955 if (to_mode != SImode)
956 {
957 from = convert_to_mode (SImode, from, unsignedp);
958 from_mode = SImode;
959 }
960 else
961 {
962 #ifdef HAVE_extendpsisi2
963 if (HAVE_extendpsisi2)
964 {
965 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_extendpsisi2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
966 return;
967 }
968 #endif /* HAVE_extendpsisi2 */
969 abort ();
970 }
971 }
972
973 if (to_mode == PDImode)
974 {
975 if (from_mode != DImode)
976 from = convert_to_mode (DImode, from, unsignedp);
977
978 #ifdef HAVE_truncdipdi2
979 if (HAVE_truncdipdi2)
980 {
981 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_truncdipdi2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
982 return;
983 }
984 #endif /* HAVE_truncdipdi2 */
985 abort ();
986 }
987
988 if (from_mode == PDImode)
989 {
990 if (to_mode != DImode)
991 {
992 from = convert_to_mode (DImode, from, unsignedp);
993 from_mode = DImode;
994 }
995 else
996 {
997 #ifdef HAVE_extendpdidi2
998 if (HAVE_extendpdidi2)
999 {
1000 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_extendpdidi2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
1001 return;
1002 }
1003 #endif /* HAVE_extendpdidi2 */
1004 abort ();
1005 }
1006 }
1007
1008 /* Now follow all the conversions between integers
1009 no more than a word long. */
1010
1011 /* For truncation, usually we can just refer to FROM in a narrower mode. */
1012 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode) < GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode)
1013 && TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode),
1014 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode)))
1015 {
1016 if (!((GET_CODE (from) == MEM
1017 && ! MEM_VOLATILE_P (from)
1018 && direct_load[(int) to_mode]
1019 && ! mode_dependent_address_p (XEXP (from, 0)))
1020 || GET_CODE (from) == REG
1021 || GET_CODE (from) == SUBREG))
1022 from = force_reg (from_mode, from);
1023 if (GET_CODE (from) == REG && REGNO (from) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
1024 && ! HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (REGNO (from), to_mode))
1025 from = copy_to_reg (from);
1026 emit_move_insn (to, gen_lowpart (to_mode, from));
1027 return;
1028 }
1029
1030 /* Handle extension. */
1031 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode) > GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode))
1032 {
1033 /* Convert directly if that works. */
1034 if ((code = can_extend_p (to_mode, from_mode, unsignedp))
1035 != CODE_FOR_nothing)
1036 {
1037 emit_unop_insn (code, to, from, equiv_code);
1038 return;
1039 }
1040 else
1041 {
1042 enum machine_mode intermediate;
1043 rtx tmp;
1044 tree shift_amount;
1045
1046 /* Search for a mode to convert via. */
1047 for (intermediate = from_mode; intermediate != VOIDmode;
1048 intermediate = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (intermediate))
1049 if (((can_extend_p (to_mode, intermediate, unsignedp)
1050 != CODE_FOR_nothing)
1051 || (GET_MODE_SIZE (to_mode) < GET_MODE_SIZE (intermediate)
1052 && TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode),
1053 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (intermediate))))
1054 && (can_extend_p (intermediate, from_mode, unsignedp)
1055 != CODE_FOR_nothing))
1056 {
1057 convert_move (to, convert_to_mode (intermediate, from,
1058 unsignedp), unsignedp);
1059 return;
1060 }
1061
1062 /* No suitable intermediate mode.
1063 Generate what we need with shifts. */
1064 shift_amount = build_int_2 (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode)
1065 - GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode), 0);
1066 from = gen_lowpart (to_mode, force_reg (from_mode, from));
1067 tmp = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, to_mode, from, shift_amount,
1068 to, unsignedp);
1069 tmp = expand_shift (RSHIFT_EXPR, to_mode, tmp, shift_amount,
1070 to, unsignedp);
1071 if (tmp != to)
1072 emit_move_insn (to, tmp);
1073 return;
1074 }
1075 }
1076
1077 /* Support special truncate insns for certain modes. */
1078
1079 if (from_mode == DImode && to_mode == SImode)
1080 {
1081 #ifdef HAVE_truncdisi2
1082 if (HAVE_truncdisi2)
1083 {
1084 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_truncdisi2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
1085 return;
1086 }
1087 #endif
1088 convert_move (to, force_reg (from_mode, from), unsignedp);
1089 return;
1090 }
1091
1092 if (from_mode == DImode && to_mode == HImode)
1093 {
1094 #ifdef HAVE_truncdihi2
1095 if (HAVE_truncdihi2)
1096 {
1097 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_truncdihi2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
1098 return;
1099 }
1100 #endif
1101 convert_move (to, force_reg (from_mode, from), unsignedp);
1102 return;
1103 }
1104
1105 if (from_mode == DImode && to_mode == QImode)
1106 {
1107 #ifdef HAVE_truncdiqi2
1108 if (HAVE_truncdiqi2)
1109 {
1110 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_truncdiqi2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
1111 return;
1112 }
1113 #endif
1114 convert_move (to, force_reg (from_mode, from), unsignedp);
1115 return;
1116 }
1117
1118 if (from_mode == SImode && to_mode == HImode)
1119 {
1120 #ifdef HAVE_truncsihi2
1121 if (HAVE_truncsihi2)
1122 {
1123 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_truncsihi2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
1124 return;
1125 }
1126 #endif
1127 convert_move (to, force_reg (from_mode, from), unsignedp);
1128 return;
1129 }
1130
1131 if (from_mode == SImode && to_mode == QImode)
1132 {
1133 #ifdef HAVE_truncsiqi2
1134 if (HAVE_truncsiqi2)
1135 {
1136 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_truncsiqi2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
1137 return;
1138 }
1139 #endif
1140 convert_move (to, force_reg (from_mode, from), unsignedp);
1141 return;
1142 }
1143
1144 if (from_mode == HImode && to_mode == QImode)
1145 {
1146 #ifdef HAVE_trunchiqi2
1147 if (HAVE_trunchiqi2)
1148 {
1149 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_trunchiqi2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
1150 return;
1151 }
1152 #endif
1153 convert_move (to, force_reg (from_mode, from), unsignedp);
1154 return;
1155 }
1156
1157 if (from_mode == TImode && to_mode == DImode)
1158 {
1159 #ifdef HAVE_trunctidi2
1160 if (HAVE_trunctidi2)
1161 {
1162 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_trunctidi2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
1163 return;
1164 }
1165 #endif
1166 convert_move (to, force_reg (from_mode, from), unsignedp);
1167 return;
1168 }
1169
1170 if (from_mode == TImode && to_mode == SImode)
1171 {
1172 #ifdef HAVE_trunctisi2
1173 if (HAVE_trunctisi2)
1174 {
1175 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_trunctisi2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
1176 return;
1177 }
1178 #endif
1179 convert_move (to, force_reg (from_mode, from), unsignedp);
1180 return;
1181 }
1182
1183 if (from_mode == TImode && to_mode == HImode)
1184 {
1185 #ifdef HAVE_trunctihi2
1186 if (HAVE_trunctihi2)
1187 {
1188 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_trunctihi2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
1189 return;
1190 }
1191 #endif
1192 convert_move (to, force_reg (from_mode, from), unsignedp);
1193 return;
1194 }
1195
1196 if (from_mode == TImode && to_mode == QImode)
1197 {
1198 #ifdef HAVE_trunctiqi2
1199 if (HAVE_trunctiqi2)
1200 {
1201 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_trunctiqi2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
1202 return;
1203 }
1204 #endif
1205 convert_move (to, force_reg (from_mode, from), unsignedp);
1206 return;
1207 }
1208
1209 /* Handle truncation of volatile memrefs, and so on;
1210 the things that couldn't be truncated directly,
1211 and for which there was no special instruction. */
1212 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode) < GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode))
1213 {
1214 rtx temp = force_reg (to_mode, gen_lowpart (to_mode, from));
1215 emit_move_insn (to, temp);
1216 return;
1217 }
1218
1219 /* Mode combination is not recognized. */
1220 abort ();
1221 }
1222
1223 /* Return an rtx for a value that would result
1224 from converting X to mode MODE.
1225 Both X and MODE may be floating, or both integer.
1226 UNSIGNEDP is nonzero if X is an unsigned value.
1227 This can be done by referring to a part of X in place
1228 or by copying to a new temporary with conversion.
1229
1230 This function *must not* call protect_from_queue
1231 except when putting X into an insn (in which case convert_move does it). */
1232
1233 rtx
1234 convert_to_mode (mode, x, unsignedp)
1235 enum machine_mode mode;
1236 rtx x;
1237 int unsignedp;
1238 {
1239 return convert_modes (mode, VOIDmode, x, unsignedp);
1240 }
1241
1242 /* Return an rtx for a value that would result
1243 from converting X from mode OLDMODE to mode MODE.
1244 Both modes may be floating, or both integer.
1245 UNSIGNEDP is nonzero if X is an unsigned value.
1246
1247 This can be done by referring to a part of X in place
1248 or by copying to a new temporary with conversion.
1249
1250 You can give VOIDmode for OLDMODE, if you are sure X has a nonvoid mode.
1251
1252 This function *must not* call protect_from_queue
1253 except when putting X into an insn (in which case convert_move does it). */
1254
1255 rtx
1256 convert_modes (mode, oldmode, x, unsignedp)
1257 enum machine_mode mode, oldmode;
1258 rtx x;
1259 int unsignedp;
1260 {
1261 register rtx temp;
1262
1263 /* If FROM is a SUBREG that indicates that we have already done at least
1264 the required extension, strip it. */
1265
1266 if (GET_CODE (x) == SUBREG && SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (x)
1267 && GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (x))) >= GET_MODE_SIZE (mode)
1268 && SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (x) == unsignedp)
1269 x = gen_lowpart (mode, x);
1270
1271 if (GET_MODE (x) != VOIDmode)
1272 oldmode = GET_MODE (x);
1273
1274 if (mode == oldmode)
1275 return x;
1276
1277 /* There is one case that we must handle specially: If we are converting
1278 a CONST_INT into a mode whose size is twice HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT and
1279 we are to interpret the constant as unsigned, gen_lowpart will do
1280 the wrong if the constant appears negative. What we want to do is
1281 make the high-order word of the constant zero, not all ones. */
1282
1283 if (unsignedp && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
1284 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) == 2 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
1285 && GET_CODE (x) == CONST_INT && INTVAL (x) < 0)
1286 {
1287 HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (x);
1288
1289 if (oldmode != VOIDmode
1290 && HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT > GET_MODE_BITSIZE (oldmode))
1291 {
1292 int width = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (oldmode);
1293
1294 /* We need to zero extend VAL. */
1295 val &= ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << width) - 1;
1296 }
1297
1298 return immed_double_const (val, (HOST_WIDE_INT) 0, mode);
1299 }
1300
1301 /* We can do this with a gen_lowpart if both desired and current modes
1302 are integer, and this is either a constant integer, a register, or a
1303 non-volatile MEM. Except for the constant case where MODE is no
1304 wider than HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT, we must be narrowing the operand. */
1305
1306 if ((GET_CODE (x) == CONST_INT
1307 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
1308 || (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
1309 && GET_MODE_CLASS (oldmode) == MODE_INT
1310 && (GET_CODE (x) == CONST_DOUBLE
1311 || (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= GET_MODE_SIZE (oldmode)
1312 && ((GET_CODE (x) == MEM && ! MEM_VOLATILE_P (x)
1313 && direct_load[(int) mode])
1314 || (GET_CODE (x) == REG
1315 && TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode),
1316 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (x)))))))))
1317 {
1318 /* ?? If we don't know OLDMODE, we have to assume here that
1319 X does not need sign- or zero-extension. This may not be
1320 the case, but it's the best we can do. */
1321 if (GET_CODE (x) == CONST_INT && oldmode != VOIDmode
1322 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > GET_MODE_SIZE (oldmode))
1323 {
1324 HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (x);
1325 int width = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (oldmode);
1326
1327 /* We must sign or zero-extend in this case. Start by
1328 zero-extending, then sign extend if we need to. */
1329 val &= ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << width) - 1;
1330 if (! unsignedp
1331 && (val & ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << (width - 1))))
1332 val |= (HOST_WIDE_INT) (-1) << width;
1333
1334 return GEN_INT (val);
1335 }
1336
1337 return gen_lowpart (mode, x);
1338 }
1339
1340 temp = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
1341 convert_move (temp, x, unsignedp);
1342 return temp;
1343 }
1344 \f
1345
1346 /* This macro is used to determine what the largest unit size that
1347 move_by_pieces can use is. */
1348
1349 /* MOVE_MAX_PIECES is the number of bytes at a time which we can
1350 move efficiently, as opposed to MOVE_MAX which is the maximum
1351 number of bhytes we can move with a single instruction. */
1352
1353 #ifndef MOVE_MAX_PIECES
1354 #define MOVE_MAX_PIECES MOVE_MAX
1355 #endif
1356
1357 /* Generate several move instructions to copy LEN bytes
1358 from block FROM to block TO. (These are MEM rtx's with BLKmode).
1359 The caller must pass FROM and TO
1360 through protect_from_queue before calling.
1361 ALIGN (in bytes) is maximum alignment we can assume. */
1362
1363 void
1364 move_by_pieces (to, from, len, align)
1365 rtx to, from;
1366 int len, align;
1367 {
1368 struct move_by_pieces data;
1369 rtx to_addr = XEXP (to, 0), from_addr = XEXP (from, 0);
1370 int max_size = MOVE_MAX_PIECES + 1;
1371 enum machine_mode mode = VOIDmode, tmode;
1372 enum insn_code icode;
1373
1374 data.offset = 0;
1375 data.to_addr = to_addr;
1376 data.from_addr = from_addr;
1377 data.to = to;
1378 data.from = from;
1379 data.autinc_to
1380 = (GET_CODE (to_addr) == PRE_INC || GET_CODE (to_addr) == PRE_DEC
1381 || GET_CODE (to_addr) == POST_INC || GET_CODE (to_addr) == POST_DEC);
1382 data.autinc_from
1383 = (GET_CODE (from_addr) == PRE_INC || GET_CODE (from_addr) == PRE_DEC
1384 || GET_CODE (from_addr) == POST_INC
1385 || GET_CODE (from_addr) == POST_DEC);
1386
1387 data.explicit_inc_from = 0;
1388 data.explicit_inc_to = 0;
1389 data.reverse
1390 = (GET_CODE (to_addr) == PRE_DEC || GET_CODE (to_addr) == POST_DEC);
1391 if (data.reverse) data.offset = len;
1392 data.len = len;
1393
1394 data.to_struct = MEM_IN_STRUCT_P (to);
1395 data.from_struct = MEM_IN_STRUCT_P (from);
1396 data.to_readonly = RTX_UNCHANGING_P (to);
1397 data.from_readonly = RTX_UNCHANGING_P (from);
1398
1399 /* If copying requires more than two move insns,
1400 copy addresses to registers (to make displacements shorter)
1401 and use post-increment if available. */
1402 if (!(data.autinc_from && data.autinc_to)
1403 && move_by_pieces_ninsns (len, align) > 2)
1404 {
1405 /* Find the mode of the largest move... */
1406 for (tmode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT);
1407 tmode != VOIDmode; tmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (tmode))
1408 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (tmode) < max_size)
1409 mode = tmode;
1410
1411 if (USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT (mode) && data.reverse && ! data.autinc_from)
1412 {
1413 data.from_addr = copy_addr_to_reg (plus_constant (from_addr, len));
1414 data.autinc_from = 1;
1415 data.explicit_inc_from = -1;
1416 }
1417 if (USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT (mode) && ! data.autinc_from)
1418 {
1419 data.from_addr = copy_addr_to_reg (from_addr);
1420 data.autinc_from = 1;
1421 data.explicit_inc_from = 1;
1422 }
1423 if (!data.autinc_from && CONSTANT_P (from_addr))
1424 data.from_addr = copy_addr_to_reg (from_addr);
1425 if (USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (mode) && data.reverse && ! data.autinc_to)
1426 {
1427 data.to_addr = copy_addr_to_reg (plus_constant (to_addr, len));
1428 data.autinc_to = 1;
1429 data.explicit_inc_to = -1;
1430 }
1431 if (USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (mode) && ! data.reverse && ! data.autinc_to)
1432 {
1433 data.to_addr = copy_addr_to_reg (to_addr);
1434 data.autinc_to = 1;
1435 data.explicit_inc_to = 1;
1436 }
1437 if (!data.autinc_to && CONSTANT_P (to_addr))
1438 data.to_addr = copy_addr_to_reg (to_addr);
1439 }
1440
1441 if (! SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS
1442 || align > MOVE_MAX || align >= BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT / BITS_PER_UNIT)
1443 align = MOVE_MAX;
1444
1445 /* First move what we can in the largest integer mode, then go to
1446 successively smaller modes. */
1447
1448 while (max_size > 1)
1449 {
1450 for (tmode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT);
1451 tmode != VOIDmode; tmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (tmode))
1452 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (tmode) < max_size)
1453 mode = tmode;
1454
1455 if (mode == VOIDmode)
1456 break;
1457
1458 icode = mov_optab->handlers[(int) mode].insn_code;
1459 if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing
1460 && align >= MIN (BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT / BITS_PER_UNIT,
1461 GET_MODE_SIZE (mode)))
1462 move_by_pieces_1 (GEN_FCN (icode), mode, &data);
1463
1464 max_size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
1465 }
1466
1467 /* The code above should have handled everything. */
1468 if (data.len > 0)
1469 abort ();
1470 }
1471
1472 /* Return number of insns required to move L bytes by pieces.
1473 ALIGN (in bytes) is maximum alignment we can assume. */
1474
1475 static int
1476 move_by_pieces_ninsns (l, align)
1477 unsigned int l;
1478 int align;
1479 {
1480 register int n_insns = 0;
1481 int max_size = MOVE_MAX + 1;
1482
1483 if (! SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS
1484 || align > MOVE_MAX || align >= BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT / BITS_PER_UNIT)
1485 align = MOVE_MAX;
1486
1487 while (max_size > 1)
1488 {
1489 enum machine_mode mode = VOIDmode, tmode;
1490 enum insn_code icode;
1491
1492 for (tmode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT);
1493 tmode != VOIDmode; tmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (tmode))
1494 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (tmode) < max_size)
1495 mode = tmode;
1496
1497 if (mode == VOIDmode)
1498 break;
1499
1500 icode = mov_optab->handlers[(int) mode].insn_code;
1501 if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing
1502 && align >= MIN (BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT / BITS_PER_UNIT,
1503 GET_MODE_SIZE (mode)))
1504 n_insns += l / GET_MODE_SIZE (mode), l %= GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
1505
1506 max_size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
1507 }
1508
1509 return n_insns;
1510 }
1511
1512 /* Subroutine of move_by_pieces. Move as many bytes as appropriate
1513 with move instructions for mode MODE. GENFUN is the gen_... function
1514 to make a move insn for that mode. DATA has all the other info. */
1515
1516 static void
1517 move_by_pieces_1 (genfun, mode, data)
1518 rtx (*genfun) PROTO ((rtx, ...));
1519 enum machine_mode mode;
1520 struct move_by_pieces *data;
1521 {
1522 register int size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
1523 register rtx to1, from1;
1524
1525 while (data->len >= size)
1526 {
1527 if (data->reverse) data->offset -= size;
1528
1529 to1 = (data->autinc_to
1530 ? gen_rtx_MEM (mode, data->to_addr)
1531 : copy_rtx (change_address (data->to, mode,
1532 plus_constant (data->to_addr,
1533 data->offset))));
1534 MEM_IN_STRUCT_P (to1) = data->to_struct;
1535 RTX_UNCHANGING_P (to1) = data->to_readonly;
1536
1537 from1
1538 = (data->autinc_from
1539 ? gen_rtx_MEM (mode, data->from_addr)
1540 : copy_rtx (change_address (data->from, mode,
1541 plus_constant (data->from_addr,
1542 data->offset))));
1543 MEM_IN_STRUCT_P (from1) = data->from_struct;
1544 RTX_UNCHANGING_P (from1) = data->from_readonly;
1545
1546 if (HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT && data->explicit_inc_to < 0)
1547 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (data->to_addr, GEN_INT (-size)));
1548 if (HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT && data->explicit_inc_from < 0)
1549 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (data->from_addr, GEN_INT (-size)));
1550
1551 emit_insn ((*genfun) (to1, from1));
1552 if (HAVE_POST_INCREMENT && data->explicit_inc_to > 0)
1553 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (data->to_addr, GEN_INT (size)));
1554 if (HAVE_POST_INCREMENT && data->explicit_inc_from > 0)
1555 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (data->from_addr, GEN_INT (size)));
1556
1557 if (! data->reverse) data->offset += size;
1558
1559 data->len -= size;
1560 }
1561 }
1562 \f
1563 /* Emit code to move a block Y to a block X.
1564 This may be done with string-move instructions,
1565 with multiple scalar move instructions, or with a library call.
1566
1567 Both X and Y must be MEM rtx's (perhaps inside VOLATILE)
1568 with mode BLKmode.
1569 SIZE is an rtx that says how long they are.
1570 ALIGN is the maximum alignment we can assume they have,
1571 measured in bytes.
1572
1573 Return the address of the new block, if memcpy is called and returns it,
1574 0 otherwise. */
1575
1576 rtx
1577 emit_block_move (x, y, size, align)
1578 rtx x, y;
1579 rtx size;
1580 int align;
1581 {
1582 rtx retval = 0;
1583 #ifdef TARGET_MEM_FUNCTIONS
1584 static tree fn;
1585 tree call_expr, arg_list;
1586 #endif
1587
1588 if (GET_MODE (x) != BLKmode)
1589 abort ();
1590
1591 if (GET_MODE (y) != BLKmode)
1592 abort ();
1593
1594 x = protect_from_queue (x, 1);
1595 y = protect_from_queue (y, 0);
1596 size = protect_from_queue (size, 0);
1597
1598 if (GET_CODE (x) != MEM)
1599 abort ();
1600 if (GET_CODE (y) != MEM)
1601 abort ();
1602 if (size == 0)
1603 abort ();
1604
1605 if (GET_CODE (size) == CONST_INT && MOVE_BY_PIECES_P (INTVAL (size), align))
1606 move_by_pieces (x, y, INTVAL (size), align);
1607 else
1608 {
1609 /* Try the most limited insn first, because there's no point
1610 including more than one in the machine description unless
1611 the more limited one has some advantage. */
1612
1613 rtx opalign = GEN_INT (align);
1614 enum machine_mode mode;
1615
1616 for (mode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT); mode != VOIDmode;
1617 mode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (mode))
1618 {
1619 enum insn_code code = movstr_optab[(int) mode];
1620 insn_operand_predicate_fn pred;
1621
1622 if (code != CODE_FOR_nothing
1623 /* We don't need MODE to be narrower than BITS_PER_HOST_WIDE_INT
1624 here because if SIZE is less than the mode mask, as it is
1625 returned by the macro, it will definitely be less than the
1626 actual mode mask. */
1627 && ((GET_CODE (size) == CONST_INT
1628 && ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (size)
1629 <= (GET_MODE_MASK (mode) >> 1)))
1630 || GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) >= BITS_PER_WORD)
1631 && ((pred = insn_data[(int) code].operand[0].predicate) == 0
1632 || (*pred) (x, BLKmode))
1633 && ((pred = insn_data[(int) code].operand[1].predicate) == 0
1634 || (*pred) (y, BLKmode))
1635 && ((pred = insn_data[(int) code].operand[3].predicate) == 0
1636 || (*pred) (opalign, VOIDmode)))
1637 {
1638 rtx op2;
1639 rtx last = get_last_insn ();
1640 rtx pat;
1641
1642 op2 = convert_to_mode (mode, size, 1);
1643 pred = insn_data[(int) code].operand[2].predicate;
1644 if (pred != 0 && ! (*pred) (op2, mode))
1645 op2 = copy_to_mode_reg (mode, op2);
1646
1647 pat = GEN_FCN ((int) code) (x, y, op2, opalign);
1648 if (pat)
1649 {
1650 emit_insn (pat);
1651 return 0;
1652 }
1653 else
1654 delete_insns_since (last);
1655 }
1656 }
1657
1658 /* X, Y, or SIZE may have been passed through protect_from_queue.
1659
1660 It is unsafe to save the value generated by protect_from_queue
1661 and reuse it later. Consider what happens if emit_queue is
1662 called before the return value from protect_from_queue is used.
1663
1664 Expansion of the CALL_EXPR below will call emit_queue before
1665 we are finished emitting RTL for argument setup. So if we are
1666 not careful we could get the wrong value for an argument.
1667
1668 To avoid this problem we go ahead and emit code to copy X, Y &
1669 SIZE into new pseudos. We can then place those new pseudos
1670 into an RTL_EXPR and use them later, even after a call to
1671 emit_queue.
1672
1673 Note this is not strictly needed for library calls since they
1674 do not call emit_queue before loading their arguments. However,
1675 we may need to have library calls call emit_queue in the future
1676 since failing to do so could cause problems for targets which
1677 define SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES and pass arguments in registers. */
1678 x = copy_to_mode_reg (Pmode, XEXP (x, 0));
1679 y = copy_to_mode_reg (Pmode, XEXP (y, 0));
1680
1681 #ifdef TARGET_MEM_FUNCTIONS
1682 size = copy_to_mode_reg (TYPE_MODE (sizetype), size);
1683 #else
1684 size = convert_to_mode (TYPE_MODE (integer_type_node), size,
1685 TREE_UNSIGNED (integer_type_node));
1686 size = copy_to_mode_reg (TYPE_MODE (integer_type_node), size);
1687 #endif
1688
1689 #ifdef TARGET_MEM_FUNCTIONS
1690 /* It is incorrect to use the libcall calling conventions to call
1691 memcpy in this context.
1692
1693 This could be a user call to memcpy and the user may wish to
1694 examine the return value from memcpy.
1695
1696 For targets where libcalls and normal calls have different conventions
1697 for returning pointers, we could end up generating incorrect code.
1698
1699 So instead of using a libcall sequence we build up a suitable
1700 CALL_EXPR and expand the call in the normal fashion. */
1701 if (fn == NULL_TREE)
1702 {
1703 tree fntype;
1704
1705 /* This was copied from except.c, I don't know if all this is
1706 necessary in this context or not. */
1707 fn = get_identifier ("memcpy");
1708 push_obstacks_nochange ();
1709 end_temporary_allocation ();
1710 fntype = build_pointer_type (void_type_node);
1711 fntype = build_function_type (fntype, NULL_TREE);
1712 fn = build_decl (FUNCTION_DECL, fn, fntype);
1713 ggc_add_tree_root (&fn, 1);
1714 DECL_EXTERNAL (fn) = 1;
1715 TREE_PUBLIC (fn) = 1;
1716 DECL_ARTIFICIAL (fn) = 1;
1717 make_decl_rtl (fn, NULL_PTR, 1);
1718 assemble_external (fn);
1719 pop_obstacks ();
1720 }
1721
1722 /* We need to make an argument list for the function call.
1723
1724 memcpy has three arguments, the first two are void * addresses and
1725 the last is a size_t byte count for the copy. */
1726 arg_list
1727 = build_tree_list (NULL_TREE,
1728 make_tree (build_pointer_type (void_type_node), x));
1729 TREE_CHAIN (arg_list)
1730 = build_tree_list (NULL_TREE,
1731 make_tree (build_pointer_type (void_type_node), y));
1732 TREE_CHAIN (TREE_CHAIN (arg_list))
1733 = build_tree_list (NULL_TREE, make_tree (sizetype, size));
1734 TREE_CHAIN (TREE_CHAIN (TREE_CHAIN (arg_list))) = NULL_TREE;
1735
1736 /* Now we have to build up the CALL_EXPR itself. */
1737 call_expr = build1 (ADDR_EXPR, build_pointer_type (TREE_TYPE (fn)), fn);
1738 call_expr = build (CALL_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (fn)),
1739 call_expr, arg_list, NULL_TREE);
1740 TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (call_expr) = 1;
1741
1742 retval = expand_expr (call_expr, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
1743 #else
1744 emit_library_call (bcopy_libfunc, 0,
1745 VOIDmode, 3, y, Pmode, x, Pmode,
1746 convert_to_mode (TYPE_MODE (integer_type_node), size,
1747 TREE_UNSIGNED (integer_type_node)),
1748 TYPE_MODE (integer_type_node));
1749 #endif
1750 }
1751
1752 return retval;
1753 }
1754 \f
1755 /* Copy all or part of a value X into registers starting at REGNO.
1756 The number of registers to be filled is NREGS. */
1757
1758 void
1759 move_block_to_reg (regno, x, nregs, mode)
1760 int regno;
1761 rtx x;
1762 int nregs;
1763 enum machine_mode mode;
1764 {
1765 int i;
1766 #ifdef HAVE_load_multiple
1767 rtx pat;
1768 rtx last;
1769 #endif
1770
1771 if (nregs == 0)
1772 return;
1773
1774 if (CONSTANT_P (x) && ! LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (x))
1775 x = validize_mem (force_const_mem (mode, x));
1776
1777 /* See if the machine can do this with a load multiple insn. */
1778 #ifdef HAVE_load_multiple
1779 if (HAVE_load_multiple)
1780 {
1781 last = get_last_insn ();
1782 pat = gen_load_multiple (gen_rtx_REG (word_mode, regno), x,
1783 GEN_INT (nregs));
1784 if (pat)
1785 {
1786 emit_insn (pat);
1787 return;
1788 }
1789 else
1790 delete_insns_since (last);
1791 }
1792 #endif
1793
1794 for (i = 0; i < nregs; i++)
1795 emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_REG (word_mode, regno + i),
1796 operand_subword_force (x, i, mode));
1797 }
1798
1799 /* Copy all or part of a BLKmode value X out of registers starting at REGNO.
1800 The number of registers to be filled is NREGS. SIZE indicates the number
1801 of bytes in the object X. */
1802
1803
1804 void
1805 move_block_from_reg (regno, x, nregs, size)
1806 int regno;
1807 rtx x;
1808 int nregs;
1809 int size;
1810 {
1811 int i;
1812 #ifdef HAVE_store_multiple
1813 rtx pat;
1814 rtx last;
1815 #endif
1816 enum machine_mode mode;
1817
1818 /* If SIZE is that of a mode no bigger than a word, just use that
1819 mode's store operation. */
1820 if (size <= UNITS_PER_WORD
1821 && (mode = mode_for_size (size * BITS_PER_UNIT, MODE_INT, 0)) != BLKmode)
1822 {
1823 emit_move_insn (change_address (x, mode, NULL),
1824 gen_rtx_REG (mode, regno));
1825 return;
1826 }
1827
1828 /* Blocks smaller than a word on a BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN machine must be aligned
1829 to the left before storing to memory. Note that the previous test
1830 doesn't handle all cases (e.g. SIZE == 3). */
1831 if (size < UNITS_PER_WORD && BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
1832 {
1833 rtx tem = operand_subword (x, 0, 1, BLKmode);
1834 rtx shift;
1835
1836 if (tem == 0)
1837 abort ();
1838
1839 shift = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, word_mode,
1840 gen_rtx_REG (word_mode, regno),
1841 build_int_2 ((UNITS_PER_WORD - size)
1842 * BITS_PER_UNIT, 0), NULL_RTX, 0);
1843 emit_move_insn (tem, shift);
1844 return;
1845 }
1846
1847 /* See if the machine can do this with a store multiple insn. */
1848 #ifdef HAVE_store_multiple
1849 if (HAVE_store_multiple)
1850 {
1851 last = get_last_insn ();
1852 pat = gen_store_multiple (x, gen_rtx_REG (word_mode, regno),
1853 GEN_INT (nregs));
1854 if (pat)
1855 {
1856 emit_insn (pat);
1857 return;
1858 }
1859 else
1860 delete_insns_since (last);
1861 }
1862 #endif
1863
1864 for (i = 0; i < nregs; i++)
1865 {
1866 rtx tem = operand_subword (x, i, 1, BLKmode);
1867
1868 if (tem == 0)
1869 abort ();
1870
1871 emit_move_insn (tem, gen_rtx_REG (word_mode, regno + i));
1872 }
1873 }
1874
1875 /* Emit code to move a block SRC to a block DST, where DST is non-consecutive
1876 registers represented by a PARALLEL. SSIZE represents the total size of
1877 block SRC in bytes, or -1 if not known. ALIGN is the known alignment of
1878 SRC in bits. */
1879 /* ??? If SSIZE % UNITS_PER_WORD != 0, we make the blatent assumption that
1880 the balance will be in what would be the low-order memory addresses, i.e.
1881 left justified for big endian, right justified for little endian. This
1882 happens to be true for the targets currently using this support. If this
1883 ever changes, a new target macro along the lines of FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING
1884 would be needed. */
1885
1886 void
1887 emit_group_load (dst, orig_src, ssize, align)
1888 rtx dst, orig_src;
1889 int align, ssize;
1890 {
1891 rtx *tmps, src;
1892 int start, i;
1893
1894 if (GET_CODE (dst) != PARALLEL)
1895 abort ();
1896
1897 /* Check for a NULL entry, used to indicate that the parameter goes
1898 both on the stack and in registers. */
1899 if (XEXP (XVECEXP (dst, 0, 0), 0))
1900 start = 0;
1901 else
1902 start = 1;
1903
1904 tmps = (rtx *) alloca (sizeof(rtx) * XVECLEN (dst, 0));
1905
1906 /* If we won't be loading directly from memory, protect the real source
1907 from strange tricks we might play. */
1908 src = orig_src;
1909 if (GET_CODE (src) != MEM)
1910 {
1911 src = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (orig_src));
1912 emit_move_insn (src, orig_src);
1913 }
1914
1915 /* Process the pieces. */
1916 for (i = start; i < XVECLEN (dst, 0); i++)
1917 {
1918 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (XVECEXP (dst, 0, i), 0));
1919 int bytepos = INTVAL (XEXP (XVECEXP (dst, 0, i), 1));
1920 int bytelen = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
1921 int shift = 0;
1922
1923 /* Handle trailing fragments that run over the size of the struct. */
1924 if (ssize >= 0 && bytepos + bytelen > ssize)
1925 {
1926 shift = (bytelen - (ssize - bytepos)) * BITS_PER_UNIT;
1927 bytelen = ssize - bytepos;
1928 if (bytelen <= 0)
1929 abort();
1930 }
1931
1932 /* Optimize the access just a bit. */
1933 if (GET_CODE (src) == MEM
1934 && align*BITS_PER_UNIT >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode)
1935 && bytepos*BITS_PER_UNIT % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode) == 0
1936 && bytelen == GET_MODE_SIZE (mode))
1937 {
1938 tmps[i] = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
1939 emit_move_insn (tmps[i],
1940 change_address (src, mode,
1941 plus_constant (XEXP (src, 0),
1942 bytepos)));
1943 }
1944 else if (GET_CODE (src) == CONCAT)
1945 {
1946 if (bytepos == 0
1947 && bytelen == GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (src, 0))))
1948 tmps[i] = XEXP (src, 0);
1949 else if (bytepos == GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (src, 0)))
1950 && bytelen == GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (src, 1))))
1951 tmps[i] = XEXP (src, 1);
1952 else
1953 abort ();
1954 }
1955 else
1956 {
1957 tmps[i] = extract_bit_field (src, bytelen*BITS_PER_UNIT,
1958 bytepos*BITS_PER_UNIT, 1, NULL_RTX,
1959 mode, mode, align, ssize);
1960 }
1961
1962 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN && shift)
1963 {
1964 expand_binop (mode, ashl_optab, tmps[i], GEN_INT (shift),
1965 tmps[i], 0, OPTAB_WIDEN);
1966 }
1967 }
1968 emit_queue();
1969
1970 /* Copy the extracted pieces into the proper (probable) hard regs. */
1971 for (i = start; i < XVECLEN (dst, 0); i++)
1972 emit_move_insn (XEXP (XVECEXP (dst, 0, i), 0), tmps[i]);
1973 }
1974
1975 /* Emit code to move a block SRC to a block DST, where SRC is non-consecutive
1976 registers represented by a PARALLEL. SSIZE represents the total size of
1977 block DST, or -1 if not known. ALIGN is the known alignment of DST. */
1978
1979 void
1980 emit_group_store (orig_dst, src, ssize, align)
1981 rtx orig_dst, src;
1982 int ssize, align;
1983 {
1984 rtx *tmps, dst;
1985 int start, i;
1986
1987 if (GET_CODE (src) != PARALLEL)
1988 abort ();
1989
1990 /* Check for a NULL entry, used to indicate that the parameter goes
1991 both on the stack and in registers. */
1992 if (XEXP (XVECEXP (src, 0, 0), 0))
1993 start = 0;
1994 else
1995 start = 1;
1996
1997 tmps = (rtx *) alloca (sizeof(rtx) * XVECLEN (src, 0));
1998
1999 /* Copy the (probable) hard regs into pseudos. */
2000 for (i = start; i < XVECLEN (src, 0); i++)
2001 {
2002 rtx reg = XEXP (XVECEXP (src, 0, i), 0);
2003 tmps[i] = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (reg));
2004 emit_move_insn (tmps[i], reg);
2005 }
2006 emit_queue();
2007
2008 /* If we won't be storing directly into memory, protect the real destination
2009 from strange tricks we might play. */
2010 dst = orig_dst;
2011 if (GET_CODE (dst) == PARALLEL)
2012 {
2013 rtx temp;
2014
2015 /* We can get a PARALLEL dst if there is a conditional expression in
2016 a return statement. In that case, the dst and src are the same,
2017 so no action is necessary. */
2018 if (rtx_equal_p (dst, src))
2019 return;
2020
2021 /* It is unclear if we can ever reach here, but we may as well handle
2022 it. Allocate a temporary, and split this into a store/load to/from
2023 the temporary. */
2024
2025 temp = assign_stack_temp (GET_MODE (dst), ssize, 0);
2026 emit_group_store (temp, src, ssize, align);
2027 emit_group_load (dst, temp, ssize, align);
2028 return;
2029 }
2030 else if (GET_CODE (dst) != MEM)
2031 {
2032 dst = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (orig_dst));
2033 /* Make life a bit easier for combine. */
2034 emit_move_insn (dst, const0_rtx);
2035 }
2036 else if (! MEM_IN_STRUCT_P (dst))
2037 {
2038 /* store_bit_field requires that memory operations have
2039 mem_in_struct_p set; we might not. */
2040
2041 dst = copy_rtx (orig_dst);
2042 MEM_SET_IN_STRUCT_P (dst, 1);
2043 }
2044
2045 /* Process the pieces. */
2046 for (i = start; i < XVECLEN (src, 0); i++)
2047 {
2048 int bytepos = INTVAL (XEXP (XVECEXP (src, 0, i), 1));
2049 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (tmps[i]);
2050 int bytelen = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
2051
2052 /* Handle trailing fragments that run over the size of the struct. */
2053 if (ssize >= 0 && bytepos + bytelen > ssize)
2054 {
2055 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
2056 {
2057 int shift = (bytelen - (ssize - bytepos)) * BITS_PER_UNIT;
2058 expand_binop (mode, ashr_optab, tmps[i], GEN_INT (shift),
2059 tmps[i], 0, OPTAB_WIDEN);
2060 }
2061 bytelen = ssize - bytepos;
2062 }
2063
2064 /* Optimize the access just a bit. */
2065 if (GET_CODE (dst) == MEM
2066 && align*BITS_PER_UNIT >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode)
2067 && bytepos*BITS_PER_UNIT % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode) == 0
2068 && bytelen == GET_MODE_SIZE (mode))
2069 {
2070 emit_move_insn (change_address (dst, mode,
2071 plus_constant (XEXP (dst, 0),
2072 bytepos)),
2073 tmps[i]);
2074 }
2075 else
2076 {
2077 store_bit_field (dst, bytelen*BITS_PER_UNIT, bytepos*BITS_PER_UNIT,
2078 mode, tmps[i], align, ssize);
2079 }
2080 }
2081 emit_queue();
2082
2083 /* Copy from the pseudo into the (probable) hard reg. */
2084 if (GET_CODE (dst) == REG)
2085 emit_move_insn (orig_dst, dst);
2086 }
2087
2088 /* Generate code to copy a BLKmode object of TYPE out of a
2089 set of registers starting with SRCREG into TGTBLK. If TGTBLK
2090 is null, a stack temporary is created. TGTBLK is returned.
2091
2092 The primary purpose of this routine is to handle functions
2093 that return BLKmode structures in registers. Some machines
2094 (the PA for example) want to return all small structures
2095 in registers regardless of the structure's alignment.
2096 */
2097
2098 rtx
2099 copy_blkmode_from_reg(tgtblk,srcreg,type)
2100 rtx tgtblk;
2101 rtx srcreg;
2102 tree type;
2103 {
2104 int bytes = int_size_in_bytes (type);
2105 rtx src = NULL, dst = NULL;
2106 int bitsize = MIN (TYPE_ALIGN (type), (unsigned int) BITS_PER_WORD);
2107 int bitpos, xbitpos, big_endian_correction = 0;
2108
2109 if (tgtblk == 0)
2110 {
2111 tgtblk = assign_stack_temp (BLKmode, bytes, 0);
2112 MEM_SET_IN_STRUCT_P (tgtblk, AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (type));
2113 preserve_temp_slots (tgtblk);
2114 }
2115
2116 /* This code assumes srcreg is at least a full word. If it isn't,
2117 copy it into a new pseudo which is a full word. */
2118 if (GET_MODE (srcreg) != BLKmode
2119 && GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (srcreg)) < UNITS_PER_WORD)
2120 srcreg = convert_to_mode (word_mode, srcreg,
2121 TREE_UNSIGNED (type));
2122
2123 /* Structures whose size is not a multiple of a word are aligned
2124 to the least significant byte (to the right). On a BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
2125 machine, this means we must skip the empty high order bytes when
2126 calculating the bit offset. */
2127 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN && bytes % UNITS_PER_WORD)
2128 big_endian_correction = (BITS_PER_WORD - ((bytes % UNITS_PER_WORD)
2129 * BITS_PER_UNIT));
2130
2131 /* Copy the structure BITSIZE bites at a time.
2132
2133 We could probably emit more efficient code for machines
2134 which do not use strict alignment, but it doesn't seem
2135 worth the effort at the current time. */
2136 for (bitpos = 0, xbitpos = big_endian_correction;
2137 bitpos < bytes * BITS_PER_UNIT;
2138 bitpos += bitsize, xbitpos += bitsize)
2139 {
2140
2141 /* We need a new source operand each time xbitpos is on a
2142 word boundary and when xbitpos == big_endian_correction
2143 (the first time through). */
2144 if (xbitpos % BITS_PER_WORD == 0
2145 || xbitpos == big_endian_correction)
2146 src = operand_subword_force (srcreg,
2147 xbitpos / BITS_PER_WORD,
2148 BLKmode);
2149
2150 /* We need a new destination operand each time bitpos is on
2151 a word boundary. */
2152 if (bitpos % BITS_PER_WORD == 0)
2153 dst = operand_subword (tgtblk, bitpos / BITS_PER_WORD, 1, BLKmode);
2154
2155 /* Use xbitpos for the source extraction (right justified) and
2156 xbitpos for the destination store (left justified). */
2157 store_bit_field (dst, bitsize, bitpos % BITS_PER_WORD, word_mode,
2158 extract_bit_field (src, bitsize,
2159 xbitpos % BITS_PER_WORD, 1,
2160 NULL_RTX, word_mode,
2161 word_mode,
2162 bitsize / BITS_PER_UNIT,
2163 BITS_PER_WORD),
2164 bitsize / BITS_PER_UNIT, BITS_PER_WORD);
2165 }
2166 return tgtblk;
2167 }
2168
2169
2170 /* Add a USE expression for REG to the (possibly empty) list pointed
2171 to by CALL_FUSAGE. REG must denote a hard register. */
2172
2173 void
2174 use_reg (call_fusage, reg)
2175 rtx *call_fusage, reg;
2176 {
2177 if (GET_CODE (reg) != REG
2178 || REGNO (reg) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
2179 abort();
2180
2181 *call_fusage
2182 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode,
2183 gen_rtx_USE (VOIDmode, reg), *call_fusage);
2184 }
2185
2186 /* Add USE expressions to *CALL_FUSAGE for each of NREGS consecutive regs,
2187 starting at REGNO. All of these registers must be hard registers. */
2188
2189 void
2190 use_regs (call_fusage, regno, nregs)
2191 rtx *call_fusage;
2192 int regno;
2193 int nregs;
2194 {
2195 int i;
2196
2197 if (regno + nregs > FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
2198 abort ();
2199
2200 for (i = 0; i < nregs; i++)
2201 use_reg (call_fusage, gen_rtx_REG (reg_raw_mode[regno + i], regno + i));
2202 }
2203
2204 /* Add USE expressions to *CALL_FUSAGE for each REG contained in the
2205 PARALLEL REGS. This is for calls that pass values in multiple
2206 non-contiguous locations. The Irix 6 ABI has examples of this. */
2207
2208 void
2209 use_group_regs (call_fusage, regs)
2210 rtx *call_fusage;
2211 rtx regs;
2212 {
2213 int i;
2214
2215 for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (regs, 0); i++)
2216 {
2217 rtx reg = XEXP (XVECEXP (regs, 0, i), 0);
2218
2219 /* A NULL entry means the parameter goes both on the stack and in
2220 registers. This can also be a MEM for targets that pass values
2221 partially on the stack and partially in registers. */
2222 if (reg != 0 && GET_CODE (reg) == REG)
2223 use_reg (call_fusage, reg);
2224 }
2225 }
2226 \f
2227 /* Generate several move instructions to clear LEN bytes of block TO.
2228 (A MEM rtx with BLKmode). The caller must pass TO through
2229 protect_from_queue before calling. ALIGN (in bytes) is maximum alignment
2230 we can assume. */
2231
2232 static void
2233 clear_by_pieces (to, len, align)
2234 rtx to;
2235 int len, align;
2236 {
2237 struct clear_by_pieces data;
2238 rtx to_addr = XEXP (to, 0);
2239 int max_size = MOVE_MAX_PIECES + 1;
2240 enum machine_mode mode = VOIDmode, tmode;
2241 enum insn_code icode;
2242
2243 data.offset = 0;
2244 data.to_addr = to_addr;
2245 data.to = to;
2246 data.autinc_to
2247 = (GET_CODE (to_addr) == PRE_INC || GET_CODE (to_addr) == PRE_DEC
2248 || GET_CODE (to_addr) == POST_INC || GET_CODE (to_addr) == POST_DEC);
2249
2250 data.explicit_inc_to = 0;
2251 data.reverse
2252 = (GET_CODE (to_addr) == PRE_DEC || GET_CODE (to_addr) == POST_DEC);
2253 if (data.reverse) data.offset = len;
2254 data.len = len;
2255
2256 data.to_struct = MEM_IN_STRUCT_P (to);
2257
2258 /* If copying requires more than two move insns,
2259 copy addresses to registers (to make displacements shorter)
2260 and use post-increment if available. */
2261 if (!data.autinc_to
2262 && move_by_pieces_ninsns (len, align) > 2)
2263 {
2264 /* Determine the main mode we'll be using */
2265 for (tmode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT);
2266 tmode != VOIDmode; tmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (tmode))
2267 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (tmode) < max_size)
2268 mode = tmode;
2269
2270 if (USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (mode) && data.reverse && ! data.autinc_to)
2271 {
2272 data.to_addr = copy_addr_to_reg (plus_constant (to_addr, len));
2273 data.autinc_to = 1;
2274 data.explicit_inc_to = -1;
2275 }
2276 if (USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (mode) && ! data.reverse && ! data.autinc_to)
2277 {
2278 data.to_addr = copy_addr_to_reg (to_addr);
2279 data.autinc_to = 1;
2280 data.explicit_inc_to = 1;
2281 }
2282 if (!data.autinc_to && CONSTANT_P (to_addr))
2283 data.to_addr = copy_addr_to_reg (to_addr);
2284 }
2285
2286 if (! SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS
2287 || align > MOVE_MAX || align >= BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT / BITS_PER_UNIT)
2288 align = MOVE_MAX;
2289
2290 /* First move what we can in the largest integer mode, then go to
2291 successively smaller modes. */
2292
2293 while (max_size > 1)
2294 {
2295 for (tmode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT);
2296 tmode != VOIDmode; tmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (tmode))
2297 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (tmode) < max_size)
2298 mode = tmode;
2299
2300 if (mode == VOIDmode)
2301 break;
2302
2303 icode = mov_optab->handlers[(int) mode].insn_code;
2304 if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing
2305 && align >= MIN (BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT / BITS_PER_UNIT,
2306 GET_MODE_SIZE (mode)))
2307 clear_by_pieces_1 (GEN_FCN (icode), mode, &data);
2308
2309 max_size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
2310 }
2311
2312 /* The code above should have handled everything. */
2313 if (data.len != 0)
2314 abort ();
2315 }
2316
2317 /* Subroutine of clear_by_pieces. Clear as many bytes as appropriate
2318 with move instructions for mode MODE. GENFUN is the gen_... function
2319 to make a move insn for that mode. DATA has all the other info. */
2320
2321 static void
2322 clear_by_pieces_1 (genfun, mode, data)
2323 rtx (*genfun) PROTO ((rtx, ...));
2324 enum machine_mode mode;
2325 struct clear_by_pieces *data;
2326 {
2327 register int size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
2328 register rtx to1;
2329
2330 while (data->len >= size)
2331 {
2332 if (data->reverse) data->offset -= size;
2333
2334 to1 = (data->autinc_to
2335 ? gen_rtx_MEM (mode, data->to_addr)
2336 : copy_rtx (change_address (data->to, mode,
2337 plus_constant (data->to_addr,
2338 data->offset))));
2339 MEM_IN_STRUCT_P (to1) = data->to_struct;
2340
2341 if (HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT && data->explicit_inc_to < 0)
2342 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (data->to_addr, GEN_INT (-size)));
2343
2344 emit_insn ((*genfun) (to1, const0_rtx));
2345 if (HAVE_POST_INCREMENT && data->explicit_inc_to > 0)
2346 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (data->to_addr, GEN_INT (size)));
2347
2348 if (! data->reverse) data->offset += size;
2349
2350 data->len -= size;
2351 }
2352 }
2353 \f
2354 /* Write zeros through the storage of OBJECT.
2355 If OBJECT has BLKmode, SIZE is its length in bytes and ALIGN is
2356 the maximum alignment we can is has, measured in bytes.
2357
2358 If we call a function that returns the length of the block, return it. */
2359
2360 rtx
2361 clear_storage (object, size, align)
2362 rtx object;
2363 rtx size;
2364 int align;
2365 {
2366 #ifdef TARGET_MEM_FUNCTIONS
2367 static tree fn;
2368 tree call_expr, arg_list;
2369 #endif
2370 rtx retval = 0;
2371
2372 if (GET_MODE (object) == BLKmode)
2373 {
2374 object = protect_from_queue (object, 1);
2375 size = protect_from_queue (size, 0);
2376
2377 if (GET_CODE (size) == CONST_INT
2378 && MOVE_BY_PIECES_P (INTVAL (size), align))
2379 clear_by_pieces (object, INTVAL (size), align);
2380
2381 else
2382 {
2383 /* Try the most limited insn first, because there's no point
2384 including more than one in the machine description unless
2385 the more limited one has some advantage. */
2386
2387 rtx opalign = GEN_INT (align);
2388 enum machine_mode mode;
2389
2390 for (mode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT); mode != VOIDmode;
2391 mode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (mode))
2392 {
2393 enum insn_code code = clrstr_optab[(int) mode];
2394 insn_operand_predicate_fn pred;
2395
2396 if (code != CODE_FOR_nothing
2397 /* We don't need MODE to be narrower than
2398 BITS_PER_HOST_WIDE_INT here because if SIZE is less than
2399 the mode mask, as it is returned by the macro, it will
2400 definitely be less than the actual mode mask. */
2401 && ((GET_CODE (size) == CONST_INT
2402 && ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (size)
2403 <= (GET_MODE_MASK (mode) >> 1)))
2404 || GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) >= BITS_PER_WORD)
2405 && ((pred = insn_data[(int) code].operand[0].predicate) == 0
2406 || (*pred) (object, BLKmode))
2407 && ((pred = insn_data[(int) code].operand[2].predicate) == 0
2408 || (*pred) (opalign, VOIDmode)))
2409 {
2410 rtx op1;
2411 rtx last = get_last_insn ();
2412 rtx pat;
2413
2414 op1 = convert_to_mode (mode, size, 1);
2415 pred = insn_data[(int) code].operand[1].predicate;
2416 if (pred != 0 && ! (*pred) (op1, mode))
2417 op1 = copy_to_mode_reg (mode, op1);
2418
2419 pat = GEN_FCN ((int) code) (object, op1, opalign);
2420 if (pat)
2421 {
2422 emit_insn (pat);
2423 return 0;
2424 }
2425 else
2426 delete_insns_since (last);
2427 }
2428 }
2429
2430 /* OBJECT or SIZE may have been passed through protect_from_queue.
2431
2432 It is unsafe to save the value generated by protect_from_queue
2433 and reuse it later. Consider what happens if emit_queue is
2434 called before the return value from protect_from_queue is used.
2435
2436 Expansion of the CALL_EXPR below will call emit_queue before
2437 we are finished emitting RTL for argument setup. So if we are
2438 not careful we could get the wrong value for an argument.
2439
2440 To avoid this problem we go ahead and emit code to copy OBJECT
2441 and SIZE into new pseudos. We can then place those new pseudos
2442 into an RTL_EXPR and use them later, even after a call to
2443 emit_queue.
2444
2445 Note this is not strictly needed for library calls since they
2446 do not call emit_queue before loading their arguments. However,
2447 we may need to have library calls call emit_queue in the future
2448 since failing to do so could cause problems for targets which
2449 define SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES and pass arguments in registers. */
2450 object = copy_to_mode_reg (Pmode, XEXP (object, 0));
2451
2452 #ifdef TARGET_MEM_FUNCTIONS
2453 size = copy_to_mode_reg (TYPE_MODE (sizetype), size);
2454 #else
2455 size = convert_to_mode (TYPE_MODE (integer_type_node), size,
2456 TREE_UNSIGNED (integer_type_node));
2457 size = copy_to_mode_reg (TYPE_MODE (integer_type_node), size);
2458 #endif
2459
2460
2461 #ifdef TARGET_MEM_FUNCTIONS
2462 /* It is incorrect to use the libcall calling conventions to call
2463 memset in this context.
2464
2465 This could be a user call to memset and the user may wish to
2466 examine the return value from memset.
2467
2468 For targets where libcalls and normal calls have different
2469 conventions for returning pointers, we could end up generating
2470 incorrect code.
2471
2472 So instead of using a libcall sequence we build up a suitable
2473 CALL_EXPR and expand the call in the normal fashion. */
2474 if (fn == NULL_TREE)
2475 {
2476 tree fntype;
2477
2478 /* This was copied from except.c, I don't know if all this is
2479 necessary in this context or not. */
2480 fn = get_identifier ("memset");
2481 push_obstacks_nochange ();
2482 end_temporary_allocation ();
2483 fntype = build_pointer_type (void_type_node);
2484 fntype = build_function_type (fntype, NULL_TREE);
2485 fn = build_decl (FUNCTION_DECL, fn, fntype);
2486 ggc_add_tree_root (&fn, 1);
2487 DECL_EXTERNAL (fn) = 1;
2488 TREE_PUBLIC (fn) = 1;
2489 DECL_ARTIFICIAL (fn) = 1;
2490 make_decl_rtl (fn, NULL_PTR, 1);
2491 assemble_external (fn);
2492 pop_obstacks ();
2493 }
2494
2495 /* We need to make an argument list for the function call.
2496
2497 memset has three arguments, the first is a void * addresses, the
2498 second a integer with the initialization value, the last is a
2499 size_t byte count for the copy. */
2500 arg_list
2501 = build_tree_list (NULL_TREE,
2502 make_tree (build_pointer_type (void_type_node),
2503 object));
2504 TREE_CHAIN (arg_list)
2505 = build_tree_list (NULL_TREE,
2506 make_tree (integer_type_node, const0_rtx));
2507 TREE_CHAIN (TREE_CHAIN (arg_list))
2508 = build_tree_list (NULL_TREE, make_tree (sizetype, size));
2509 TREE_CHAIN (TREE_CHAIN (TREE_CHAIN (arg_list))) = NULL_TREE;
2510
2511 /* Now we have to build up the CALL_EXPR itself. */
2512 call_expr = build1 (ADDR_EXPR,
2513 build_pointer_type (TREE_TYPE (fn)), fn);
2514 call_expr = build (CALL_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (fn)),
2515 call_expr, arg_list, NULL_TREE);
2516 TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (call_expr) = 1;
2517
2518 retval = expand_expr (call_expr, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
2519 #else
2520 emit_library_call (bzero_libfunc, 0,
2521 VOIDmode, 2, object, Pmode, size,
2522 TYPE_MODE (integer_type_node));
2523 #endif
2524 }
2525 }
2526 else
2527 emit_move_insn (object, CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE (object)));
2528
2529 return retval;
2530 }
2531
2532 /* Generate code to copy Y into X.
2533 Both Y and X must have the same mode, except that
2534 Y can be a constant with VOIDmode.
2535 This mode cannot be BLKmode; use emit_block_move for that.
2536
2537 Return the last instruction emitted. */
2538
2539 rtx
2540 emit_move_insn (x, y)
2541 rtx x, y;
2542 {
2543 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (x);
2544
2545 x = protect_from_queue (x, 1);
2546 y = protect_from_queue (y, 0);
2547
2548 if (mode == BLKmode || (GET_MODE (y) != mode && GET_MODE (y) != VOIDmode))
2549 abort ();
2550
2551 /* Never force constant_p_rtx to memory. */
2552 if (GET_CODE (y) == CONSTANT_P_RTX)
2553 ;
2554 else if (CONSTANT_P (y) && ! LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (y))
2555 y = force_const_mem (mode, y);
2556
2557 /* If X or Y are memory references, verify that their addresses are valid
2558 for the machine. */
2559 if (GET_CODE (x) == MEM
2560 && ((! memory_address_p (GET_MODE (x), XEXP (x, 0))
2561 && ! push_operand (x, GET_MODE (x)))
2562 || (flag_force_addr
2563 && CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (XEXP (x, 0)))))
2564 x = change_address (x, VOIDmode, XEXP (x, 0));
2565
2566 if (GET_CODE (y) == MEM
2567 && (! memory_address_p (GET_MODE (y), XEXP (y, 0))
2568 || (flag_force_addr
2569 && CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (XEXP (y, 0)))))
2570 y = change_address (y, VOIDmode, XEXP (y, 0));
2571
2572 if (mode == BLKmode)
2573 abort ();
2574
2575 return emit_move_insn_1 (x, y);
2576 }
2577
2578 /* Low level part of emit_move_insn.
2579 Called just like emit_move_insn, but assumes X and Y
2580 are basically valid. */
2581
2582 rtx
2583 emit_move_insn_1 (x, y)
2584 rtx x, y;
2585 {
2586 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (x);
2587 enum machine_mode submode;
2588 enum mode_class class = GET_MODE_CLASS (mode);
2589 int i;
2590
2591 if (mode >= MAX_MACHINE_MODE)
2592 abort ();
2593
2594 if (mov_optab->handlers[(int) mode].insn_code != CODE_FOR_nothing)
2595 return
2596 emit_insn (GEN_FCN (mov_optab->handlers[(int) mode].insn_code) (x, y));
2597
2598 /* Expand complex moves by moving real part and imag part, if possible. */
2599 else if ((class == MODE_COMPLEX_FLOAT || class == MODE_COMPLEX_INT)
2600 && BLKmode != (submode = mode_for_size ((GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mode)
2601 * BITS_PER_UNIT),
2602 (class == MODE_COMPLEX_INT
2603 ? MODE_INT : MODE_FLOAT),
2604 0))
2605 && (mov_optab->handlers[(int) submode].insn_code
2606 != CODE_FOR_nothing))
2607 {
2608 /* Don't split destination if it is a stack push. */
2609 int stack = push_operand (x, GET_MODE (x));
2610
2611 /* If this is a stack, push the highpart first, so it
2612 will be in the argument order.
2613
2614 In that case, change_address is used only to convert
2615 the mode, not to change the address. */
2616 if (stack)
2617 {
2618 /* Note that the real part always precedes the imag part in memory
2619 regardless of machine's endianness. */
2620 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
2621 emit_insn (GEN_FCN (mov_optab->handlers[(int) submode].insn_code)
2622 (gen_rtx_MEM (submode, (XEXP (x, 0))),
2623 gen_imagpart (submode, y)));
2624 emit_insn (GEN_FCN (mov_optab->handlers[(int) submode].insn_code)
2625 (gen_rtx_MEM (submode, (XEXP (x, 0))),
2626 gen_realpart (submode, y)));
2627 #else
2628 emit_insn (GEN_FCN (mov_optab->handlers[(int) submode].insn_code)
2629 (gen_rtx_MEM (submode, (XEXP (x, 0))),
2630 gen_realpart (submode, y)));
2631 emit_insn (GEN_FCN (mov_optab->handlers[(int) submode].insn_code)
2632 (gen_rtx_MEM (submode, (XEXP (x, 0))),
2633 gen_imagpart (submode, y)));
2634 #endif
2635 }
2636 else
2637 {
2638 /* If this is a complex value with each part being smaller than a
2639 word, the usual calling sequence will likely pack the pieces into
2640 a single register. Unfortunately, SUBREG of hard registers only
2641 deals in terms of words, so we have a problem converting input
2642 arguments to the CONCAT of two registers that is used elsewhere
2643 for complex values. If this is before reload, we can copy it into
2644 memory and reload. FIXME, we should see about using extract and
2645 insert on integer registers, but complex short and complex char
2646 variables should be rarely used. */
2647 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) < 2*BITS_PER_WORD
2648 && (reload_in_progress | reload_completed) == 0)
2649 {
2650 int packed_dest_p = (REG_P (x) && REGNO (x) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER);
2651 int packed_src_p = (REG_P (y) && REGNO (y) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER);
2652
2653 if (packed_dest_p || packed_src_p)
2654 {
2655 enum mode_class reg_class = ((class == MODE_COMPLEX_FLOAT)
2656 ? MODE_FLOAT : MODE_INT);
2657
2658 enum machine_mode reg_mode =
2659 mode_for_size (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode), reg_class, 1);
2660
2661 if (reg_mode != BLKmode)
2662 {
2663 rtx mem = assign_stack_temp (reg_mode,
2664 GET_MODE_SIZE (mode), 0);
2665
2666 rtx cmem = change_address (mem, mode, NULL_RTX);
2667
2668 current_function->cannot_inline
2669 = "function uses short complex types";
2670
2671 if (packed_dest_p)
2672 {
2673 rtx sreg = gen_rtx_SUBREG (reg_mode, x, 0);
2674 emit_move_insn_1 (cmem, y);
2675 return emit_move_insn_1 (sreg, mem);
2676 }
2677 else
2678 {
2679 rtx sreg = gen_rtx_SUBREG (reg_mode, y, 0);
2680 emit_move_insn_1 (mem, sreg);
2681 return emit_move_insn_1 (x, cmem);
2682 }
2683 }
2684 }
2685 }
2686
2687 /* Show the output dies here. This is necessary for pseudos;
2688 hard regs shouldn't appear here except as return values.
2689 We never want to emit such a clobber after reload. */
2690 if (x != y
2691 && ! (reload_in_progress || reload_completed))
2692 {
2693 emit_insn (gen_rtx_CLOBBER (VOIDmode, x));
2694 }
2695
2696 emit_insn (GEN_FCN (mov_optab->handlers[(int) submode].insn_code)
2697 (gen_realpart (submode, x), gen_realpart (submode, y)));
2698 emit_insn (GEN_FCN (mov_optab->handlers[(int) submode].insn_code)
2699 (gen_imagpart (submode, x), gen_imagpart (submode, y)));
2700 }
2701
2702 return get_last_insn ();
2703 }
2704
2705 /* This will handle any multi-word mode that lacks a move_insn pattern.
2706 However, you will get better code if you define such patterns,
2707 even if they must turn into multiple assembler instructions. */
2708 else if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > UNITS_PER_WORD)
2709 {
2710 rtx last_insn = 0;
2711
2712 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
2713
2714 /* If X is a push on the stack, do the push now and replace
2715 X with a reference to the stack pointer. */
2716 if (push_operand (x, GET_MODE (x)))
2717 {
2718 anti_adjust_stack (GEN_INT (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x))));
2719 x = change_address (x, VOIDmode, stack_pointer_rtx);
2720 }
2721 #endif
2722
2723 /* Show the output dies here. This is necessary for pseudos;
2724 hard regs shouldn't appear here except as return values.
2725 We never want to emit such a clobber after reload. */
2726 if (x != y
2727 && ! (reload_in_progress || reload_completed))
2728 {
2729 emit_insn (gen_rtx_CLOBBER (VOIDmode, x));
2730 }
2731
2732 for (i = 0;
2733 i < (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) + (UNITS_PER_WORD - 1)) / UNITS_PER_WORD;
2734 i++)
2735 {
2736 rtx xpart = operand_subword (x, i, 1, mode);
2737 rtx ypart = operand_subword (y, i, 1, mode);
2738
2739 /* If we can't get a part of Y, put Y into memory if it is a
2740 constant. Otherwise, force it into a register. If we still
2741 can't get a part of Y, abort. */
2742 if (ypart == 0 && CONSTANT_P (y))
2743 {
2744 y = force_const_mem (mode, y);
2745 ypart = operand_subword (y, i, 1, mode);
2746 }
2747 else if (ypart == 0)
2748 ypart = operand_subword_force (y, i, mode);
2749
2750 if (xpart == 0 || ypart == 0)
2751 abort ();
2752
2753 last_insn = emit_move_insn (xpart, ypart);
2754 }
2755
2756 return last_insn;
2757 }
2758 else
2759 abort ();
2760 }
2761 \f
2762 /* Pushing data onto the stack. */
2763
2764 /* Push a block of length SIZE (perhaps variable)
2765 and return an rtx to address the beginning of the block.
2766 Note that it is not possible for the value returned to be a QUEUED.
2767 The value may be virtual_outgoing_args_rtx.
2768
2769 EXTRA is the number of bytes of padding to push in addition to SIZE.
2770 BELOW nonzero means this padding comes at low addresses;
2771 otherwise, the padding comes at high addresses. */
2772
2773 rtx
2774 push_block (size, extra, below)
2775 rtx size;
2776 int extra, below;
2777 {
2778 register rtx temp;
2779
2780 size = convert_modes (Pmode, ptr_mode, size, 1);
2781 if (CONSTANT_P (size))
2782 anti_adjust_stack (plus_constant (size, extra));
2783 else if (GET_CODE (size) == REG && extra == 0)
2784 anti_adjust_stack (size);
2785 else
2786 {
2787 rtx temp = copy_to_mode_reg (Pmode, size);
2788 if (extra != 0)
2789 temp = expand_binop (Pmode, add_optab, temp, GEN_INT (extra),
2790 temp, 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
2791 anti_adjust_stack (temp);
2792 }
2793
2794 #if defined (STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD) \
2795 || (defined (ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD) \
2796 && !defined (ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS))
2797
2798 /* Return the lowest stack address when STACK or ARGS grow downward and
2799 we are not aaccumulating outgoing arguments (the c4x port uses such
2800 conventions). */
2801 temp = virtual_outgoing_args_rtx;
2802 if (extra != 0 && below)
2803 temp = plus_constant (temp, extra);
2804 #else
2805 if (GET_CODE (size) == CONST_INT)
2806 temp = plus_constant (virtual_outgoing_args_rtx,
2807 - INTVAL (size) - (below ? 0 : extra));
2808 else if (extra != 0 && !below)
2809 temp = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, virtual_outgoing_args_rtx,
2810 negate_rtx (Pmode, plus_constant (size, extra)));
2811 else
2812 temp = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, virtual_outgoing_args_rtx,
2813 negate_rtx (Pmode, size));
2814 #endif
2815
2816 return memory_address (GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT), temp);
2817 }
2818
2819 rtx
2820 gen_push_operand ()
2821 {
2822 return gen_rtx_fmt_e (STACK_PUSH_CODE, Pmode, stack_pointer_rtx);
2823 }
2824
2825 /* Return an rtx for the address of the beginning of a as-if-it-was-pushed
2826 block of SIZE bytes. */
2827
2828 static rtx
2829 get_push_address (size)
2830 int size;
2831 {
2832 register rtx temp;
2833
2834 if (STACK_PUSH_CODE == POST_DEC)
2835 temp = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, stack_pointer_rtx, GEN_INT (size));
2836 else if (STACK_PUSH_CODE == POST_INC)
2837 temp = gen_rtx_MINUS (Pmode, stack_pointer_rtx, GEN_INT (size));
2838 else
2839 temp = stack_pointer_rtx;
2840
2841 return copy_to_reg (temp);
2842 }
2843
2844 /* Generate code to push X onto the stack, assuming it has mode MODE and
2845 type TYPE.
2846 MODE is redundant except when X is a CONST_INT (since they don't
2847 carry mode info).
2848 SIZE is an rtx for the size of data to be copied (in bytes),
2849 needed only if X is BLKmode.
2850
2851 ALIGN (in bytes) is maximum alignment we can assume.
2852
2853 If PARTIAL and REG are both nonzero, then copy that many of the first
2854 words of X into registers starting with REG, and push the rest of X.
2855 The amount of space pushed is decreased by PARTIAL words,
2856 rounded *down* to a multiple of PARM_BOUNDARY.
2857 REG must be a hard register in this case.
2858 If REG is zero but PARTIAL is not, take any all others actions for an
2859 argument partially in registers, but do not actually load any
2860 registers.
2861
2862 EXTRA is the amount in bytes of extra space to leave next to this arg.
2863 This is ignored if an argument block has already been allocated.
2864
2865 On a machine that lacks real push insns, ARGS_ADDR is the address of
2866 the bottom of the argument block for this call. We use indexing off there
2867 to store the arg. On machines with push insns, ARGS_ADDR is 0 when a
2868 argument block has not been preallocated.
2869
2870 ARGS_SO_FAR is the size of args previously pushed for this call.
2871
2872 REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE is nonzero if functions require stack space
2873 for arguments passed in registers. If nonzero, it will be the number
2874 of bytes required. */
2875
2876 void
2877 emit_push_insn (x, mode, type, size, align, partial, reg, extra,
2878 args_addr, args_so_far, reg_parm_stack_space,
2879 alignment_pad)
2880 register rtx x;
2881 enum machine_mode mode;
2882 tree type;
2883 rtx size;
2884 int align;
2885 int partial;
2886 rtx reg;
2887 int extra;
2888 rtx args_addr;
2889 rtx args_so_far;
2890 int reg_parm_stack_space;
2891 rtx alignment_pad;
2892 {
2893 rtx xinner;
2894 enum direction stack_direction
2895 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
2896 = downward;
2897 #else
2898 = upward;
2899 #endif
2900
2901 /* Decide where to pad the argument: `downward' for below,
2902 `upward' for above, or `none' for don't pad it.
2903 Default is below for small data on big-endian machines; else above. */
2904 enum direction where_pad = FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (mode, type);
2905
2906 /* Invert direction if stack is post-update. */
2907 if (STACK_PUSH_CODE == POST_INC || STACK_PUSH_CODE == POST_DEC)
2908 if (where_pad != none)
2909 where_pad = (where_pad == downward ? upward : downward);
2910
2911 xinner = x = protect_from_queue (x, 0);
2912
2913 if (mode == BLKmode)
2914 {
2915 /* Copy a block into the stack, entirely or partially. */
2916
2917 register rtx temp;
2918 int used = partial * UNITS_PER_WORD;
2919 int offset = used % (PARM_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT);
2920 int skip;
2921
2922 if (size == 0)
2923 abort ();
2924
2925 used -= offset;
2926
2927 /* USED is now the # of bytes we need not copy to the stack
2928 because registers will take care of them. */
2929
2930 if (partial != 0)
2931 xinner = change_address (xinner, BLKmode,
2932 plus_constant (XEXP (xinner, 0), used));
2933
2934 /* If the partial register-part of the arg counts in its stack size,
2935 skip the part of stack space corresponding to the registers.
2936 Otherwise, start copying to the beginning of the stack space,
2937 by setting SKIP to 0. */
2938 skip = (reg_parm_stack_space == 0) ? 0 : used;
2939
2940 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
2941 /* Do it with several push insns if that doesn't take lots of insns
2942 and if there is no difficulty with push insns that skip bytes
2943 on the stack for alignment purposes. */
2944 if (args_addr == 0
2945 && GET_CODE (size) == CONST_INT
2946 && skip == 0
2947 && (MOVE_BY_PIECES_P ((unsigned) INTVAL (size) - used, align))
2948 /* Here we avoid the case of a structure whose weak alignment
2949 forces many pushes of a small amount of data,
2950 and such small pushes do rounding that causes trouble. */
2951 && ((! SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS)
2952 || align >= BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT / BITS_PER_UNIT
2953 || PUSH_ROUNDING (align) == align)
2954 && PUSH_ROUNDING (INTVAL (size)) == INTVAL (size))
2955 {
2956 /* Push padding now if padding above and stack grows down,
2957 or if padding below and stack grows up.
2958 But if space already allocated, this has already been done. */
2959 if (extra && args_addr == 0
2960 && where_pad != none && where_pad != stack_direction)
2961 anti_adjust_stack (GEN_INT (extra));
2962
2963 move_by_pieces (gen_rtx_MEM (BLKmode, gen_push_operand ()), xinner,
2964 INTVAL (size) - used, align);
2965
2966 if (current_function_check_memory_usage && ! in_check_memory_usage)
2967 {
2968 rtx temp;
2969
2970 in_check_memory_usage = 1;
2971 temp = get_push_address (INTVAL(size) - used);
2972 if (GET_CODE (x) == MEM && type && AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (type))
2973 emit_library_call (chkr_copy_bitmap_libfunc, 1, VOIDmode, 3,
2974 temp, Pmode,
2975 XEXP (xinner, 0), Pmode,
2976 GEN_INT (INTVAL(size) - used),
2977 TYPE_MODE (sizetype));
2978 else
2979 emit_library_call (chkr_set_right_libfunc, 1, VOIDmode, 3,
2980 temp, Pmode,
2981 GEN_INT (INTVAL(size) - used),
2982 TYPE_MODE (sizetype),
2983 GEN_INT (MEMORY_USE_RW),
2984 TYPE_MODE (integer_type_node));
2985 in_check_memory_usage = 0;
2986 }
2987 }
2988 else
2989 #endif /* PUSH_ROUNDING */
2990 {
2991 /* Otherwise make space on the stack and copy the data
2992 to the address of that space. */
2993
2994 /* Deduct words put into registers from the size we must copy. */
2995 if (partial != 0)
2996 {
2997 if (GET_CODE (size) == CONST_INT)
2998 size = GEN_INT (INTVAL (size) - used);
2999 else
3000 size = expand_binop (GET_MODE (size), sub_optab, size,
3001 GEN_INT (used), NULL_RTX, 0,
3002 OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
3003 }
3004
3005 /* Get the address of the stack space.
3006 In this case, we do not deal with EXTRA separately.
3007 A single stack adjust will do. */
3008 if (! args_addr)
3009 {
3010 temp = push_block (size, extra, where_pad == downward);
3011 extra = 0;
3012 }
3013 else if (GET_CODE (args_so_far) == CONST_INT)
3014 temp = memory_address (BLKmode,
3015 plus_constant (args_addr,
3016 skip + INTVAL (args_so_far)));
3017 else
3018 temp = memory_address (BLKmode,
3019 plus_constant (gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode,
3020 args_addr,
3021 args_so_far),
3022 skip));
3023 if (current_function_check_memory_usage && ! in_check_memory_usage)
3024 {
3025 rtx target;
3026
3027 in_check_memory_usage = 1;
3028 target = copy_to_reg (temp);
3029 if (GET_CODE (x) == MEM && type && AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (type))
3030 emit_library_call (chkr_copy_bitmap_libfunc, 1, VOIDmode, 3,
3031 target, Pmode,
3032 XEXP (xinner, 0), Pmode,
3033 size, TYPE_MODE (sizetype));
3034 else
3035 emit_library_call (chkr_set_right_libfunc, 1, VOIDmode, 3,
3036 target, Pmode,
3037 size, TYPE_MODE (sizetype),
3038 GEN_INT (MEMORY_USE_RW),
3039 TYPE_MODE (integer_type_node));
3040 in_check_memory_usage = 0;
3041 }
3042
3043 /* TEMP is the address of the block. Copy the data there. */
3044 if (GET_CODE (size) == CONST_INT
3045 && (MOVE_BY_PIECES_P ((unsigned) INTVAL (size), align)))
3046 {
3047 move_by_pieces (gen_rtx_MEM (BLKmode, temp), xinner,
3048 INTVAL (size), align);
3049 goto ret;
3050 }
3051 else
3052 {
3053 rtx opalign = GEN_INT (align);
3054 enum machine_mode mode;
3055 rtx target = gen_rtx_MEM (BLKmode, temp);
3056
3057 for (mode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT);
3058 mode != VOIDmode;
3059 mode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (mode))
3060 {
3061 enum insn_code code = movstr_optab[(int) mode];
3062 insn_operand_predicate_fn pred;
3063
3064 if (code != CODE_FOR_nothing
3065 && ((GET_CODE (size) == CONST_INT
3066 && ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (size)
3067 <= (GET_MODE_MASK (mode) >> 1)))
3068 || GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) >= BITS_PER_WORD)
3069 && (!(pred = insn_data[(int) code].operand[0].predicate)
3070 || ((*pred) (target, BLKmode)))
3071 && (!(pred = insn_data[(int) code].operand[1].predicate)
3072 || ((*pred) (xinner, BLKmode)))
3073 && (!(pred = insn_data[(int) code].operand[3].predicate)
3074 || ((*pred) (opalign, VOIDmode))))
3075 {
3076 rtx op2 = convert_to_mode (mode, size, 1);
3077 rtx last = get_last_insn ();
3078 rtx pat;
3079
3080 pred = insn_data[(int) code].operand[2].predicate;
3081 if (pred != 0 && ! (*pred) (op2, mode))
3082 op2 = copy_to_mode_reg (mode, op2);
3083
3084 pat = GEN_FCN ((int) code) (target, xinner,
3085 op2, opalign);
3086 if (pat)
3087 {
3088 emit_insn (pat);
3089 goto ret;
3090 }
3091 else
3092 delete_insns_since (last);
3093 }
3094 }
3095 }
3096
3097 #ifndef ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS
3098 /* If the source is referenced relative to the stack pointer,
3099 copy it to another register to stabilize it. We do not need
3100 to do this if we know that we won't be changing sp. */
3101
3102 if (reg_mentioned_p (virtual_stack_dynamic_rtx, temp)
3103 || reg_mentioned_p (virtual_outgoing_args_rtx, temp))
3104 temp = copy_to_reg (temp);
3105 #endif
3106
3107 /* Make inhibit_defer_pop nonzero around the library call
3108 to force it to pop the bcopy-arguments right away. */
3109 NO_DEFER_POP;
3110 #ifdef TARGET_MEM_FUNCTIONS
3111 emit_library_call (memcpy_libfunc, 0,
3112 VOIDmode, 3, temp, Pmode, XEXP (xinner, 0), Pmode,
3113 convert_to_mode (TYPE_MODE (sizetype),
3114 size, TREE_UNSIGNED (sizetype)),
3115 TYPE_MODE (sizetype));
3116 #else
3117 emit_library_call (bcopy_libfunc, 0,
3118 VOIDmode, 3, XEXP (xinner, 0), Pmode, temp, Pmode,
3119 convert_to_mode (TYPE_MODE (integer_type_node),
3120 size,
3121 TREE_UNSIGNED (integer_type_node)),
3122 TYPE_MODE (integer_type_node));
3123 #endif
3124 OK_DEFER_POP;
3125 }
3126 }
3127 else if (partial > 0)
3128 {
3129 /* Scalar partly in registers. */
3130
3131 int size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) / UNITS_PER_WORD;
3132 int i;
3133 int not_stack;
3134 /* # words of start of argument
3135 that we must make space for but need not store. */
3136 int offset = partial % (PARM_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_WORD);
3137 int args_offset = INTVAL (args_so_far);
3138 int skip;
3139
3140 /* Push padding now if padding above and stack grows down,
3141 or if padding below and stack grows up.
3142 But if space already allocated, this has already been done. */
3143 if (extra && args_addr == 0
3144 && where_pad != none && where_pad != stack_direction)
3145 anti_adjust_stack (GEN_INT (extra));
3146
3147 /* If we make space by pushing it, we might as well push
3148 the real data. Otherwise, we can leave OFFSET nonzero
3149 and leave the space uninitialized. */
3150 if (args_addr == 0)
3151 offset = 0;
3152
3153 /* Now NOT_STACK gets the number of words that we don't need to
3154 allocate on the stack. */
3155 not_stack = partial - offset;
3156
3157 /* If the partial register-part of the arg counts in its stack size,
3158 skip the part of stack space corresponding to the registers.
3159 Otherwise, start copying to the beginning of the stack space,
3160 by setting SKIP to 0. */
3161 skip = (reg_parm_stack_space == 0) ? 0 : not_stack;
3162
3163 if (CONSTANT_P (x) && ! LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (x))
3164 x = validize_mem (force_const_mem (mode, x));
3165
3166 /* If X is a hard register in a non-integer mode, copy it into a pseudo;
3167 SUBREGs of such registers are not allowed. */
3168 if ((GET_CODE (x) == REG && REGNO (x) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
3169 && GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (x)) != MODE_INT))
3170 x = copy_to_reg (x);
3171
3172 /* Loop over all the words allocated on the stack for this arg. */
3173 /* We can do it by words, because any scalar bigger than a word
3174 has a size a multiple of a word. */
3175 #ifndef PUSH_ARGS_REVERSED
3176 for (i = not_stack; i < size; i++)
3177 #else
3178 for (i = size - 1; i >= not_stack; i--)
3179 #endif
3180 if (i >= not_stack + offset)
3181 emit_push_insn (operand_subword_force (x, i, mode),
3182 word_mode, NULL_TREE, NULL_RTX, align, 0, NULL_RTX,
3183 0, args_addr,
3184 GEN_INT (args_offset + ((i - not_stack + skip)
3185 * UNITS_PER_WORD)),
3186 reg_parm_stack_space, alignment_pad);
3187 }
3188 else
3189 {
3190 rtx addr;
3191 rtx target = NULL_RTX;
3192
3193 /* Push padding now if padding above and stack grows down,
3194 or if padding below and stack grows up.
3195 But if space already allocated, this has already been done. */
3196 if (extra && args_addr == 0
3197 && where_pad != none && where_pad != stack_direction)
3198 anti_adjust_stack (GEN_INT (extra));
3199
3200 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
3201 if (args_addr == 0)
3202 addr = gen_push_operand ();
3203 else
3204 #endif
3205 {
3206 if (GET_CODE (args_so_far) == CONST_INT)
3207 addr
3208 = memory_address (mode,
3209 plus_constant (args_addr,
3210 INTVAL (args_so_far)));
3211 else
3212 addr = memory_address (mode, gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, args_addr,
3213 args_so_far));
3214 target = addr;
3215 }
3216
3217 emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_MEM (mode, addr), x);
3218
3219 if (current_function_check_memory_usage && ! in_check_memory_usage)
3220 {
3221 in_check_memory_usage = 1;
3222 if (target == 0)
3223 target = get_push_address (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
3224
3225 if (GET_CODE (x) == MEM && type && AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (type))
3226 emit_library_call (chkr_copy_bitmap_libfunc, 1, VOIDmode, 3,
3227 target, Pmode,
3228 XEXP (x, 0), Pmode,
3229 GEN_INT (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode)),
3230 TYPE_MODE (sizetype));
3231 else
3232 emit_library_call (chkr_set_right_libfunc, 1, VOIDmode, 3,
3233 target, Pmode,
3234 GEN_INT (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode)),
3235 TYPE_MODE (sizetype),
3236 GEN_INT (MEMORY_USE_RW),
3237 TYPE_MODE (integer_type_node));
3238 in_check_memory_usage = 0;
3239 }
3240 }
3241
3242 ret:
3243 /* If part should go in registers, copy that part
3244 into the appropriate registers. Do this now, at the end,
3245 since mem-to-mem copies above may do function calls. */
3246 if (partial > 0 && reg != 0)
3247 {
3248 /* Handle calls that pass values in multiple non-contiguous locations.
3249 The Irix 6 ABI has examples of this. */
3250 if (GET_CODE (reg) == PARALLEL)
3251 emit_group_load (reg, x, -1, align); /* ??? size? */
3252 else
3253 move_block_to_reg (REGNO (reg), x, partial, mode);
3254 }
3255
3256 if (extra && args_addr == 0 && where_pad == stack_direction)
3257 anti_adjust_stack (GEN_INT (extra));
3258
3259 if (alignment_pad)
3260 anti_adjust_stack (alignment_pad);
3261 }
3262 \f
3263 /* Expand an assignment that stores the value of FROM into TO.
3264 If WANT_VALUE is nonzero, return an rtx for the value of TO.
3265 (This may contain a QUEUED rtx;
3266 if the value is constant, this rtx is a constant.)
3267 Otherwise, the returned value is NULL_RTX.
3268
3269 SUGGEST_REG is no longer actually used.
3270 It used to mean, copy the value through a register
3271 and return that register, if that is possible.
3272 We now use WANT_VALUE to decide whether to do this. */
3273
3274 rtx
3275 expand_assignment (to, from, want_value, suggest_reg)
3276 tree to, from;
3277 int want_value;
3278 int suggest_reg ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
3279 {
3280 register rtx to_rtx = 0;
3281 rtx result;
3282
3283 /* Don't crash if the lhs of the assignment was erroneous. */
3284
3285 if (TREE_CODE (to) == ERROR_MARK)
3286 {
3287 result = expand_expr (from, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
3288 return want_value ? result : NULL_RTX;
3289 }
3290
3291 /* Assignment of a structure component needs special treatment
3292 if the structure component's rtx is not simply a MEM.
3293 Assignment of an array element at a constant index, and assignment of
3294 an array element in an unaligned packed structure field, has the same
3295 problem. */
3296
3297 if (TREE_CODE (to) == COMPONENT_REF || TREE_CODE (to) == BIT_FIELD_REF
3298 || TREE_CODE (to) == ARRAY_REF)
3299 {
3300 enum machine_mode mode1;
3301 int bitsize;
3302 int bitpos;
3303 tree offset;
3304 int unsignedp;
3305 int volatilep = 0;
3306 tree tem;
3307 int alignment;
3308
3309 push_temp_slots ();
3310 tem = get_inner_reference (to, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset, &mode1,
3311 &unsignedp, &volatilep, &alignment);
3312
3313 /* If we are going to use store_bit_field and extract_bit_field,
3314 make sure to_rtx will be safe for multiple use. */
3315
3316 if (mode1 == VOIDmode && want_value)
3317 tem = stabilize_reference (tem);
3318
3319 to_rtx = expand_expr (tem, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_MEMORY_USE_DONT);
3320 if (offset != 0)
3321 {
3322 rtx offset_rtx = expand_expr (offset, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
3323
3324 if (GET_CODE (to_rtx) != MEM)
3325 abort ();
3326
3327 if (GET_MODE (offset_rtx) != ptr_mode)
3328 {
3329 #ifdef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
3330 offset_rtx = convert_memory_address (ptr_mode, offset_rtx);
3331 #else
3332 offset_rtx = convert_to_mode (ptr_mode, offset_rtx, 0);
3333 #endif
3334 }
3335
3336 /* A constant address in TO_RTX can have VOIDmode, we must not try
3337 to call force_reg for that case. Avoid that case. */
3338 if (GET_CODE (to_rtx) == MEM
3339 && GET_MODE (to_rtx) == BLKmode
3340 && GET_MODE (XEXP (to_rtx, 0)) != VOIDmode
3341 && bitsize
3342 && (bitpos % bitsize) == 0
3343 && (bitsize % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode1)) == 0
3344 && (alignment * BITS_PER_UNIT) == GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode1))
3345 {
3346 rtx temp = change_address (to_rtx, mode1,
3347 plus_constant (XEXP (to_rtx, 0),
3348 (bitpos /
3349 BITS_PER_UNIT)));
3350 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (temp, 0)) == REG)
3351 to_rtx = temp;
3352 else
3353 to_rtx = change_address (to_rtx, mode1,
3354 force_reg (GET_MODE (XEXP (temp, 0)),
3355 XEXP (temp, 0)));
3356 bitpos = 0;
3357 }
3358
3359 to_rtx = change_address (to_rtx, VOIDmode,
3360 gen_rtx_PLUS (ptr_mode, XEXP (to_rtx, 0),
3361 force_reg (ptr_mode,
3362 offset_rtx)));
3363 }
3364
3365 if (volatilep)
3366 {
3367 if (GET_CODE (to_rtx) == MEM)
3368 {
3369 /* When the offset is zero, to_rtx is the address of the
3370 structure we are storing into, and hence may be shared.
3371 We must make a new MEM before setting the volatile bit. */
3372 if (offset == 0)
3373 to_rtx = copy_rtx (to_rtx);
3374
3375 MEM_VOLATILE_P (to_rtx) = 1;
3376 }
3377 #if 0 /* This was turned off because, when a field is volatile
3378 in an object which is not volatile, the object may be in a register,
3379 and then we would abort over here. */
3380 else
3381 abort ();
3382 #endif
3383 }
3384
3385 if (TREE_CODE (to) == COMPONENT_REF
3386 && TREE_READONLY (TREE_OPERAND (to, 1)))
3387 {
3388 if (offset == 0)
3389 to_rtx = copy_rtx (to_rtx);
3390
3391 RTX_UNCHANGING_P (to_rtx) = 1;
3392 }
3393
3394 /* Check the access. */
3395 if (current_function_check_memory_usage && GET_CODE (to_rtx) == MEM)
3396 {
3397 rtx to_addr;
3398 int size;
3399 int best_mode_size;
3400 enum machine_mode best_mode;
3401
3402 best_mode = get_best_mode (bitsize, bitpos,
3403 TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (tem)),
3404 mode1, volatilep);
3405 if (best_mode == VOIDmode)
3406 best_mode = QImode;
3407
3408 best_mode_size = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (best_mode);
3409 to_addr = plus_constant (XEXP (to_rtx, 0), (bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT));
3410 size = CEIL ((bitpos % best_mode_size) + bitsize, best_mode_size);
3411 size *= GET_MODE_SIZE (best_mode);
3412
3413 /* Check the access right of the pointer. */
3414 if (size)
3415 emit_library_call (chkr_check_addr_libfunc, 1, VOIDmode, 3,
3416 to_addr, Pmode,
3417 GEN_INT (size), TYPE_MODE (sizetype),
3418 GEN_INT (MEMORY_USE_WO),
3419 TYPE_MODE (integer_type_node));
3420 }
3421
3422 result = store_field (to_rtx, bitsize, bitpos, mode1, from,
3423 (want_value
3424 /* Spurious cast makes HPUX compiler happy. */
3425 ? (enum machine_mode) TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (to))
3426 : VOIDmode),
3427 unsignedp,
3428 /* Required alignment of containing datum. */
3429 alignment,
3430 int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (tem)),
3431 get_alias_set (to));
3432 preserve_temp_slots (result);
3433 free_temp_slots ();
3434 pop_temp_slots ();
3435
3436 /* If the value is meaningful, convert RESULT to the proper mode.
3437 Otherwise, return nothing. */
3438 return (want_value ? convert_modes (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (to)),
3439 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (from)),
3440 result,
3441 TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (to)))
3442 : NULL_RTX);
3443 }
3444
3445 /* If the rhs is a function call and its value is not an aggregate,
3446 call the function before we start to compute the lhs.
3447 This is needed for correct code for cases such as
3448 val = setjmp (buf) on machines where reference to val
3449 requires loading up part of an address in a separate insn.
3450
3451 Don't do this if TO is a VAR_DECL whose DECL_RTL is REG since it might be
3452 a promoted variable where the zero- or sign- extension needs to be done.
3453 Handling this in the normal way is safe because no computation is done
3454 before the call. */
3455 if (TREE_CODE (from) == CALL_EXPR && ! aggregate_value_p (from)
3456 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (from))) == INTEGER_CST
3457 && ! (TREE_CODE (to) == VAR_DECL && GET_CODE (DECL_RTL (to)) == REG))
3458 {
3459 rtx value;
3460
3461 push_temp_slots ();
3462 value = expand_expr (from, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
3463 if (to_rtx == 0)
3464 to_rtx = expand_expr (to, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_MEMORY_USE_WO);
3465
3466 /* Handle calls that return values in multiple non-contiguous locations.
3467 The Irix 6 ABI has examples of this. */
3468 if (GET_CODE (to_rtx) == PARALLEL)
3469 emit_group_load (to_rtx, value, int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (from)),
3470 TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (from)) / BITS_PER_UNIT);
3471 else if (GET_MODE (to_rtx) == BLKmode)
3472 emit_block_move (to_rtx, value, expr_size (from),
3473 TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (from)) / BITS_PER_UNIT);
3474 else
3475 {
3476 #ifdef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
3477 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (to)) == REFERENCE_TYPE
3478 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (to)) == POINTER_TYPE)
3479 value = convert_memory_address (GET_MODE (to_rtx), value);
3480 #endif
3481 emit_move_insn (to_rtx, value);
3482 }
3483 preserve_temp_slots (to_rtx);
3484 free_temp_slots ();
3485 pop_temp_slots ();
3486 return want_value ? to_rtx : NULL_RTX;
3487 }
3488
3489 /* Ordinary treatment. Expand TO to get a REG or MEM rtx.
3490 Don't re-expand if it was expanded already (in COMPONENT_REF case). */
3491
3492 if (to_rtx == 0)
3493 {
3494 to_rtx = expand_expr (to, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_MEMORY_USE_WO);
3495 if (GET_CODE (to_rtx) == MEM)
3496 MEM_ALIAS_SET (to_rtx) = get_alias_set (to);
3497 }
3498
3499 /* Don't move directly into a return register. */
3500 if (TREE_CODE (to) == RESULT_DECL
3501 && (GET_CODE (to_rtx) == REG || GET_CODE (to_rtx) == PARALLEL))
3502 {
3503 rtx temp;
3504
3505 push_temp_slots ();
3506 temp = expand_expr (from, 0, GET_MODE (to_rtx), 0);
3507
3508 if (GET_CODE (to_rtx) == PARALLEL)
3509 emit_group_load (to_rtx, temp, int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (from)),
3510 TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (from)) / BITS_PER_UNIT);
3511 else
3512 emit_move_insn (to_rtx, temp);
3513
3514 preserve_temp_slots (to_rtx);
3515 free_temp_slots ();
3516 pop_temp_slots ();
3517 return want_value ? to_rtx : NULL_RTX;
3518 }
3519
3520 /* In case we are returning the contents of an object which overlaps
3521 the place the value is being stored, use a safe function when copying
3522 a value through a pointer into a structure value return block. */
3523 if (TREE_CODE (to) == RESULT_DECL && TREE_CODE (from) == INDIRECT_REF
3524 && current_function_returns_struct
3525 && !current_function_returns_pcc_struct)
3526 {
3527 rtx from_rtx, size;
3528
3529 push_temp_slots ();
3530 size = expr_size (from);
3531 from_rtx = expand_expr (from, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode,
3532 EXPAND_MEMORY_USE_DONT);
3533
3534 /* Copy the rights of the bitmap. */
3535 if (current_function_check_memory_usage)
3536 emit_library_call (chkr_copy_bitmap_libfunc, 1, VOIDmode, 3,
3537 XEXP (to_rtx, 0), Pmode,
3538 XEXP (from_rtx, 0), Pmode,
3539 convert_to_mode (TYPE_MODE (sizetype),
3540 size, TREE_UNSIGNED (sizetype)),
3541 TYPE_MODE (sizetype));
3542
3543 #ifdef TARGET_MEM_FUNCTIONS
3544 emit_library_call (memcpy_libfunc, 0,
3545 VOIDmode, 3, XEXP (to_rtx, 0), Pmode,
3546 XEXP (from_rtx, 0), Pmode,
3547 convert_to_mode (TYPE_MODE (sizetype),
3548 size, TREE_UNSIGNED (sizetype)),
3549 TYPE_MODE (sizetype));
3550 #else
3551 emit_library_call (bcopy_libfunc, 0,
3552 VOIDmode, 3, XEXP (from_rtx, 0), Pmode,
3553 XEXP (to_rtx, 0), Pmode,
3554 convert_to_mode (TYPE_MODE (integer_type_node),
3555 size, TREE_UNSIGNED (integer_type_node)),
3556 TYPE_MODE (integer_type_node));
3557 #endif
3558
3559 preserve_temp_slots (to_rtx);
3560 free_temp_slots ();
3561 pop_temp_slots ();
3562 return want_value ? to_rtx : NULL_RTX;
3563 }
3564
3565 /* Compute FROM and store the value in the rtx we got. */
3566
3567 push_temp_slots ();
3568 result = store_expr (from, to_rtx, want_value);
3569 preserve_temp_slots (result);
3570 free_temp_slots ();
3571 pop_temp_slots ();
3572 return want_value ? result : NULL_RTX;
3573 }
3574
3575 /* Generate code for computing expression EXP,
3576 and storing the value into TARGET.
3577 TARGET may contain a QUEUED rtx.
3578
3579 If WANT_VALUE is nonzero, return a copy of the value
3580 not in TARGET, so that we can be sure to use the proper
3581 value in a containing expression even if TARGET has something
3582 else stored in it. If possible, we copy the value through a pseudo
3583 and return that pseudo. Or, if the value is constant, we try to
3584 return the constant. In some cases, we return a pseudo
3585 copied *from* TARGET.
3586
3587 If the mode is BLKmode then we may return TARGET itself.
3588 It turns out that in BLKmode it doesn't cause a problem.
3589 because C has no operators that could combine two different
3590 assignments into the same BLKmode object with different values
3591 with no sequence point. Will other languages need this to
3592 be more thorough?
3593
3594 If WANT_VALUE is 0, we return NULL, to make sure
3595 to catch quickly any cases where the caller uses the value
3596 and fails to set WANT_VALUE. */
3597
3598 rtx
3599 store_expr (exp, target, want_value)
3600 register tree exp;
3601 register rtx target;
3602 int want_value;
3603 {
3604 register rtx temp;
3605 int dont_return_target = 0;
3606
3607 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == COMPOUND_EXPR)
3608 {
3609 /* Perform first part of compound expression, then assign from second
3610 part. */
3611 expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), const0_rtx, VOIDmode, 0);
3612 emit_queue ();
3613 return store_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), target, want_value);
3614 }
3615 else if (TREE_CODE (exp) == COND_EXPR && GET_MODE (target) == BLKmode)
3616 {
3617 /* For conditional expression, get safe form of the target. Then
3618 test the condition, doing the appropriate assignment on either
3619 side. This avoids the creation of unnecessary temporaries.
3620 For non-BLKmode, it is more efficient not to do this. */
3621
3622 rtx lab1 = gen_label_rtx (), lab2 = gen_label_rtx ();
3623
3624 emit_queue ();
3625 target = protect_from_queue (target, 1);
3626
3627 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
3628 NO_DEFER_POP;
3629 jumpifnot (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), lab1);
3630 start_cleanup_deferral ();
3631 store_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), target, 0);
3632 end_cleanup_deferral ();
3633 emit_queue ();
3634 emit_jump_insn (gen_jump (lab2));
3635 emit_barrier ();
3636 emit_label (lab1);
3637 start_cleanup_deferral ();
3638 store_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2), target, 0);
3639 end_cleanup_deferral ();
3640 emit_queue ();
3641 emit_label (lab2);
3642 OK_DEFER_POP;
3643
3644 return want_value ? target : NULL_RTX;
3645 }
3646 else if (queued_subexp_p (target))
3647 /* If target contains a postincrement, let's not risk
3648 using it as the place to generate the rhs. */
3649 {
3650 if (GET_MODE (target) != BLKmode && GET_MODE (target) != VOIDmode)
3651 {
3652 /* Expand EXP into a new pseudo. */
3653 temp = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (target));
3654 temp = expand_expr (exp, temp, GET_MODE (target), 0);
3655 }
3656 else
3657 temp = expand_expr (exp, NULL_RTX, GET_MODE (target), 0);
3658
3659 /* If target is volatile, ANSI requires accessing the value
3660 *from* the target, if it is accessed. So make that happen.
3661 In no case return the target itself. */
3662 if (! MEM_VOLATILE_P (target) && want_value)
3663 dont_return_target = 1;
3664 }
3665 else if (want_value && GET_CODE (target) == MEM && ! MEM_VOLATILE_P (target)
3666 && GET_MODE (target) != BLKmode)
3667 /* If target is in memory and caller wants value in a register instead,
3668 arrange that. Pass TARGET as target for expand_expr so that,
3669 if EXP is another assignment, WANT_VALUE will be nonzero for it.
3670 We know expand_expr will not use the target in that case.
3671 Don't do this if TARGET is volatile because we are supposed
3672 to write it and then read it. */
3673 {
3674 temp = expand_expr (exp, target, GET_MODE (target), 0);
3675 if (GET_MODE (temp) != BLKmode && GET_MODE (temp) != VOIDmode)
3676 temp = copy_to_reg (temp);
3677 dont_return_target = 1;
3678 }
3679 else if (GET_CODE (target) == SUBREG && SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (target))
3680 /* If this is an scalar in a register that is stored in a wider mode
3681 than the declared mode, compute the result into its declared mode
3682 and then convert to the wider mode. Our value is the computed
3683 expression. */
3684 {
3685 /* If we don't want a value, we can do the conversion inside EXP,
3686 which will often result in some optimizations. Do the conversion
3687 in two steps: first change the signedness, if needed, then
3688 the extend. But don't do this if the type of EXP is a subtype
3689 of something else since then the conversion might involve
3690 more than just converting modes. */
3691 if (! want_value && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (exp))
3692 && TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (exp)) == 0)
3693 {
3694 if (TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (exp))
3695 != SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (target))
3696 exp
3697 = convert
3698 (signed_or_unsigned_type (SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (target),
3699 TREE_TYPE (exp)),
3700 exp);
3701
3702 exp = convert (type_for_mode (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (target)),
3703 SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (target)),
3704 exp);
3705 }
3706
3707 temp = expand_expr (exp, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
3708
3709 /* If TEMP is a volatile MEM and we want a result value, make
3710 the access now so it gets done only once. Likewise if
3711 it contains TARGET. */
3712 if (GET_CODE (temp) == MEM && want_value
3713 && (MEM_VOLATILE_P (temp)
3714 || reg_mentioned_p (SUBREG_REG (target), XEXP (temp, 0))))
3715 temp = copy_to_reg (temp);
3716
3717 /* If TEMP is a VOIDmode constant, use convert_modes to make
3718 sure that we properly convert it. */
3719 if (CONSTANT_P (temp) && GET_MODE (temp) == VOIDmode)
3720 temp = convert_modes (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (target)),
3721 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)), temp,
3722 SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (target));
3723
3724 convert_move (SUBREG_REG (target), temp,
3725 SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (target));
3726
3727 /* If we promoted a constant, change the mode back down to match
3728 target. Otherwise, the caller might get confused by a result whose
3729 mode is larger than expected. */
3730
3731 if (want_value && GET_MODE (temp) != GET_MODE (target)
3732 && GET_MODE (temp) != VOIDmode)
3733 {
3734 temp = gen_rtx_SUBREG (GET_MODE (target), temp, 0);
3735 SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (temp) = 1;
3736 SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (temp)
3737 = SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (target);
3738 }
3739
3740 return want_value ? temp : NULL_RTX;
3741 }
3742 else
3743 {
3744 temp = expand_expr (exp, target, GET_MODE (target), 0);
3745 /* Return TARGET if it's a specified hardware register.
3746 If TARGET is a volatile mem ref, either return TARGET
3747 or return a reg copied *from* TARGET; ANSI requires this.
3748
3749 Otherwise, if TEMP is not TARGET, return TEMP
3750 if it is constant (for efficiency),
3751 or if we really want the correct value. */
3752 if (!(target && GET_CODE (target) == REG
3753 && REGNO (target) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
3754 && !(GET_CODE (target) == MEM && MEM_VOLATILE_P (target))
3755 && ! rtx_equal_p (temp, target)
3756 && (CONSTANT_P (temp) || want_value))
3757 dont_return_target = 1;
3758 }
3759
3760 /* If TEMP is a VOIDmode constant and the mode of the type of EXP is not
3761 the same as that of TARGET, adjust the constant. This is needed, for
3762 example, in case it is a CONST_DOUBLE and we want only a word-sized
3763 value. */
3764 if (CONSTANT_P (temp) && GET_MODE (temp) == VOIDmode
3765 && TREE_CODE (exp) != ERROR_MARK
3766 && GET_MODE (target) != TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
3767 temp = convert_modes (GET_MODE (target), TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)),
3768 temp, TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
3769
3770 if (current_function_check_memory_usage
3771 && GET_CODE (target) == MEM
3772 && AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
3773 {
3774 if (GET_CODE (temp) == MEM)
3775 emit_library_call (chkr_copy_bitmap_libfunc, 1, VOIDmode, 3,
3776 XEXP (target, 0), Pmode,
3777 XEXP (temp, 0), Pmode,
3778 expr_size (exp), TYPE_MODE (sizetype));
3779 else
3780 emit_library_call (chkr_check_addr_libfunc, 1, VOIDmode, 3,
3781 XEXP (target, 0), Pmode,
3782 expr_size (exp), TYPE_MODE (sizetype),
3783 GEN_INT (MEMORY_USE_WO),
3784 TYPE_MODE (integer_type_node));
3785 }
3786
3787 /* If value was not generated in the target, store it there.
3788 Convert the value to TARGET's type first if nec. */
3789 /* If TEMP and TARGET compare equal according to rtx_equal_p, but
3790 one or both of them are volatile memory refs, we have to distinguish
3791 two cases:
3792 - expand_expr has used TARGET. In this case, we must not generate
3793 another copy. This can be detected by TARGET being equal according
3794 to == .
3795 - expand_expr has not used TARGET - that means that the source just
3796 happens to have the same RTX form. Since temp will have been created
3797 by expand_expr, it will compare unequal according to == .
3798 We must generate a copy in this case, to reach the correct number
3799 of volatile memory references. */
3800
3801 if ((! rtx_equal_p (temp, target)
3802 || (temp != target && (side_effects_p (temp)
3803 || side_effects_p (target))))
3804 && TREE_CODE (exp) != ERROR_MARK)
3805 {
3806 target = protect_from_queue (target, 1);
3807 if (GET_MODE (temp) != GET_MODE (target)
3808 && GET_MODE (temp) != VOIDmode)
3809 {
3810 int unsignedp = TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (exp));
3811 if (dont_return_target)
3812 {
3813 /* In this case, we will return TEMP,
3814 so make sure it has the proper mode.
3815 But don't forget to store the value into TARGET. */
3816 temp = convert_to_mode (GET_MODE (target), temp, unsignedp);
3817 emit_move_insn (target, temp);
3818 }
3819 else
3820 convert_move (target, temp, unsignedp);
3821 }
3822
3823 else if (GET_MODE (temp) == BLKmode && TREE_CODE (exp) == STRING_CST)
3824 {
3825 /* Handle copying a string constant into an array.
3826 The string constant may be shorter than the array.
3827 So copy just the string's actual length, and clear the rest. */
3828 rtx size;
3829 rtx addr;
3830
3831 /* Get the size of the data type of the string,
3832 which is actually the size of the target. */
3833 size = expr_size (exp);
3834 if (GET_CODE (size) == CONST_INT
3835 && INTVAL (size) < TREE_STRING_LENGTH (exp))
3836 emit_block_move (target, temp, size,
3837 TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (exp)) / BITS_PER_UNIT);
3838 else
3839 {
3840 /* Compute the size of the data to copy from the string. */
3841 tree copy_size
3842 = size_binop (MIN_EXPR,
3843 make_tree (sizetype, size),
3844 convert (sizetype,
3845 build_int_2 (TREE_STRING_LENGTH (exp), 0)));
3846 rtx copy_size_rtx = expand_expr (copy_size, NULL_RTX,
3847 VOIDmode, 0);
3848 rtx label = 0;
3849
3850 /* Copy that much. */
3851 emit_block_move (target, temp, copy_size_rtx,
3852 TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (exp)) / BITS_PER_UNIT);
3853
3854 /* Figure out how much is left in TARGET that we have to clear.
3855 Do all calculations in ptr_mode. */
3856
3857 addr = XEXP (target, 0);
3858 addr = convert_modes (ptr_mode, Pmode, addr, 1);
3859
3860 if (GET_CODE (copy_size_rtx) == CONST_INT)
3861 {
3862 addr = plus_constant (addr, TREE_STRING_LENGTH (exp));
3863 size = plus_constant (size, - TREE_STRING_LENGTH (exp));
3864 }
3865 else
3866 {
3867 addr = force_reg (ptr_mode, addr);
3868 addr = expand_binop (ptr_mode, add_optab, addr,
3869 copy_size_rtx, NULL_RTX, 0,
3870 OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
3871
3872 size = expand_binop (ptr_mode, sub_optab, size,
3873 copy_size_rtx, NULL_RTX, 0,
3874 OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
3875
3876 label = gen_label_rtx ();
3877 emit_cmp_and_jump_insns (size, const0_rtx, LT, NULL_RTX,
3878 GET_MODE (size), 0, 0, label);
3879 }
3880
3881 if (size != const0_rtx)
3882 {
3883 /* Be sure we can write on ADDR. */
3884 if (current_function_check_memory_usage)
3885 emit_library_call (chkr_check_addr_libfunc, 1, VOIDmode, 3,
3886 addr, Pmode,
3887 size, TYPE_MODE (sizetype),
3888 GEN_INT (MEMORY_USE_WO),
3889 TYPE_MODE (integer_type_node));
3890 #ifdef TARGET_MEM_FUNCTIONS
3891 emit_library_call (memset_libfunc, 0, VOIDmode, 3,
3892 addr, ptr_mode,
3893 const0_rtx, TYPE_MODE (integer_type_node),
3894 convert_to_mode (TYPE_MODE (sizetype),
3895 size,
3896 TREE_UNSIGNED (sizetype)),
3897 TYPE_MODE (sizetype));
3898 #else
3899 emit_library_call (bzero_libfunc, 0, VOIDmode, 2,
3900 addr, ptr_mode,
3901 convert_to_mode (TYPE_MODE (integer_type_node),
3902 size,
3903 TREE_UNSIGNED (integer_type_node)),
3904 TYPE_MODE (integer_type_node));
3905 #endif
3906 }
3907
3908 if (label)
3909 emit_label (label);
3910 }
3911 }
3912 /* Handle calls that return values in multiple non-contiguous locations.
3913 The Irix 6 ABI has examples of this. */
3914 else if (GET_CODE (target) == PARALLEL)
3915 emit_group_load (target, temp, int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (exp)),
3916 TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (exp)) / BITS_PER_UNIT);
3917 else if (GET_MODE (temp) == BLKmode)
3918 emit_block_move (target, temp, expr_size (exp),
3919 TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (exp)) / BITS_PER_UNIT);
3920 else
3921 emit_move_insn (target, temp);
3922 }
3923
3924 /* If we don't want a value, return NULL_RTX. */
3925 if (! want_value)
3926 return NULL_RTX;
3927
3928 /* If we are supposed to return TEMP, do so as long as it isn't a MEM.
3929 ??? The latter test doesn't seem to make sense. */
3930 else if (dont_return_target && GET_CODE (temp) != MEM)
3931 return temp;
3932
3933 /* Return TARGET itself if it is a hard register. */
3934 else if (want_value && GET_MODE (target) != BLKmode
3935 && ! (GET_CODE (target) == REG
3936 && REGNO (target) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER))
3937 return copy_to_reg (target);
3938
3939 else
3940 return target;
3941 }
3942 \f
3943 /* Return 1 if EXP just contains zeros. */
3944
3945 static int
3946 is_zeros_p (exp)
3947 tree exp;
3948 {
3949 tree elt;
3950
3951 switch (TREE_CODE (exp))
3952 {
3953 case CONVERT_EXPR:
3954 case NOP_EXPR:
3955 case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
3956 return is_zeros_p (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
3957
3958 case INTEGER_CST:
3959 return TREE_INT_CST_LOW (exp) == 0 && TREE_INT_CST_HIGH (exp) == 0;
3960
3961 case COMPLEX_CST:
3962 return
3963 is_zeros_p (TREE_REALPART (exp)) && is_zeros_p (TREE_IMAGPART (exp));
3964
3965 case REAL_CST:
3966 return REAL_VALUES_IDENTICAL (TREE_REAL_CST (exp), dconst0);
3967
3968 case CONSTRUCTOR:
3969 if (TREE_TYPE (exp) && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)) == SET_TYPE)
3970 return CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp) == NULL_TREE;
3971 for (elt = CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp); elt; elt = TREE_CHAIN (elt))
3972 if (! is_zeros_p (TREE_VALUE (elt)))
3973 return 0;
3974
3975 return 1;
3976
3977 default:
3978 return 0;
3979 }
3980 }
3981
3982 /* Return 1 if EXP contains mostly (3/4) zeros. */
3983
3984 static int
3985 mostly_zeros_p (exp)
3986 tree exp;
3987 {
3988 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == CONSTRUCTOR)
3989 {
3990 int elts = 0, zeros = 0;
3991 tree elt = CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp);
3992 if (TREE_TYPE (exp) && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)) == SET_TYPE)
3993 {
3994 /* If there are no ranges of true bits, it is all zero. */
3995 return elt == NULL_TREE;
3996 }
3997 for (; elt; elt = TREE_CHAIN (elt))
3998 {
3999 /* We do not handle the case where the index is a RANGE_EXPR,
4000 so the statistic will be somewhat inaccurate.
4001 We do make a more accurate count in store_constructor itself,
4002 so since this function is only used for nested array elements,
4003 this should be close enough. */
4004 if (mostly_zeros_p (TREE_VALUE (elt)))
4005 zeros++;
4006 elts++;
4007 }
4008
4009 return 4 * zeros >= 3 * elts;
4010 }
4011
4012 return is_zeros_p (exp);
4013 }
4014 \f
4015 /* Helper function for store_constructor.
4016 TARGET, BITSIZE, BITPOS, MODE, EXP are as for store_field.
4017 TYPE is the type of the CONSTRUCTOR, not the element type.
4018 ALIGN and CLEARED are as for store_constructor.
4019
4020 This provides a recursive shortcut back to store_constructor when it isn't
4021 necessary to go through store_field. This is so that we can pass through
4022 the cleared field to let store_constructor know that we may not have to
4023 clear a substructure if the outer structure has already been cleared. */
4024
4025 static void
4026 store_constructor_field (target, bitsize, bitpos,
4027 mode, exp, type, align, cleared)
4028 rtx target;
4029 int bitsize, bitpos;
4030 enum machine_mode mode;
4031 tree exp, type;
4032 int align;
4033 int cleared;
4034 {
4035 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == CONSTRUCTOR
4036 && bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT == 0
4037 /* If we have a non-zero bitpos for a register target, then we just
4038 let store_field do the bitfield handling. This is unlikely to
4039 generate unnecessary clear instructions anyways. */
4040 && (bitpos == 0 || GET_CODE (target) == MEM))
4041 {
4042 if (bitpos != 0)
4043 target
4044 = change_address (target,
4045 GET_MODE (target) == BLKmode
4046 || 0 != (bitpos
4047 % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (GET_MODE (target)))
4048 ? BLKmode : VOIDmode,
4049 plus_constant (XEXP (target, 0),
4050 bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT));
4051 store_constructor (exp, target, align, cleared);
4052 }
4053 else
4054 store_field (target, bitsize, bitpos, mode, exp, VOIDmode, 0,
4055 (align + BITS_PER_UNIT - 1) / BITS_PER_UNIT,
4056 int_size_in_bytes (type), cleared);
4057 }
4058
4059 /* Store the value of constructor EXP into the rtx TARGET.
4060 TARGET is either a REG or a MEM.
4061 ALIGN is the maximum known alignment for TARGET, in bits.
4062 CLEARED is true if TARGET is known to have been zero'd. */
4063
4064 static void
4065 store_constructor (exp, target, align, cleared)
4066 tree exp;
4067 rtx target;
4068 int align;
4069 int cleared;
4070 {
4071 tree type = TREE_TYPE (exp);
4072 #ifdef WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
4073 rtx exp_size = expr_size (exp);
4074 #endif
4075
4076 /* We know our target cannot conflict, since safe_from_p has been called. */
4077 #if 0
4078 /* Don't try copying piece by piece into a hard register
4079 since that is vulnerable to being clobbered by EXP.
4080 Instead, construct in a pseudo register and then copy it all. */
4081 if (GET_CODE (target) == REG && REGNO (target) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
4082 {
4083 rtx temp = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (target));
4084 store_constructor (exp, temp, 0);
4085 emit_move_insn (target, temp);
4086 return;
4087 }
4088 #endif
4089
4090 if (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE || TREE_CODE (type) == UNION_TYPE
4091 || TREE_CODE (type) == QUAL_UNION_TYPE)
4092 {
4093 register tree elt;
4094
4095 /* Inform later passes that the whole union value is dead. */
4096 if ((TREE_CODE (type) == UNION_TYPE
4097 || TREE_CODE (type) == QUAL_UNION_TYPE)
4098 && ! cleared)
4099 {
4100 emit_insn (gen_rtx_CLOBBER (VOIDmode, target));
4101
4102 /* If the constructor is empty, clear the union. */
4103 if (! CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp) && ! cleared)
4104 clear_storage (target, expr_size (exp),
4105 TYPE_ALIGN (type) / BITS_PER_UNIT);
4106 }
4107
4108 /* If we are building a static constructor into a register,
4109 set the initial value as zero so we can fold the value into
4110 a constant. But if more than one register is involved,
4111 this probably loses. */
4112 else if (GET_CODE (target) == REG && TREE_STATIC (exp)
4113 && GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (target)) <= UNITS_PER_WORD)
4114 {
4115 if (! cleared)
4116 emit_move_insn (target, CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE (target)));
4117
4118 cleared = 1;
4119 }
4120
4121 /* If the constructor has fewer fields than the structure
4122 or if we are initializing the structure to mostly zeros,
4123 clear the whole structure first. */
4124 else if ((list_length (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp))
4125 != list_length (TYPE_FIELDS (type)))
4126 || mostly_zeros_p (exp))
4127 {
4128 if (! cleared)
4129 clear_storage (target, expr_size (exp),
4130 (align + BITS_PER_UNIT - 1) / BITS_PER_UNIT);
4131
4132 cleared = 1;
4133 }
4134 else if (! cleared)
4135 /* Inform later passes that the old value is dead. */
4136 emit_insn (gen_rtx_CLOBBER (VOIDmode, target));
4137
4138 /* Store each element of the constructor into
4139 the corresponding field of TARGET. */
4140
4141 for (elt = CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp); elt; elt = TREE_CHAIN (elt))
4142 {
4143 register tree field = TREE_PURPOSE (elt);
4144 #ifdef WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
4145 tree value = TREE_VALUE (elt);
4146 #endif
4147 register enum machine_mode mode;
4148 int bitsize;
4149 int bitpos = 0;
4150 int unsignedp;
4151 tree pos, constant = 0, offset = 0;
4152 rtx to_rtx = target;
4153
4154 /* Just ignore missing fields.
4155 We cleared the whole structure, above,
4156 if any fields are missing. */
4157 if (field == 0)
4158 continue;
4159
4160 if (cleared && is_zeros_p (TREE_VALUE (elt)))
4161 continue;
4162
4163 if (TREE_CODE (DECL_SIZE (field)) == INTEGER_CST)
4164 bitsize = TREE_INT_CST_LOW (DECL_SIZE (field));
4165 else
4166 bitsize = -1;
4167
4168 unsignedp = TREE_UNSIGNED (field);
4169 mode = DECL_MODE (field);
4170 if (DECL_BIT_FIELD (field))
4171 mode = VOIDmode;
4172
4173 pos = DECL_FIELD_BITPOS (field);
4174 if (TREE_CODE (pos) == INTEGER_CST)
4175 constant = pos;
4176 else if (TREE_CODE (pos) == PLUS_EXPR
4177 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (pos, 1)) == INTEGER_CST)
4178 constant = TREE_OPERAND (pos, 1), offset = TREE_OPERAND (pos, 0);
4179 else
4180 offset = pos;
4181
4182 if (constant)
4183 bitpos = TREE_INT_CST_LOW (constant);
4184
4185 if (offset)
4186 {
4187 rtx offset_rtx;
4188
4189 if (contains_placeholder_p (offset))
4190 offset = build (WITH_RECORD_EXPR, sizetype,
4191 offset, make_tree (TREE_TYPE (exp), target));
4192
4193 offset = size_binop (EXACT_DIV_EXPR, offset,
4194 size_int (BITS_PER_UNIT));
4195
4196 offset_rtx = expand_expr (offset, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
4197 if (GET_CODE (to_rtx) != MEM)
4198 abort ();
4199
4200 if (GET_MODE (offset_rtx) != ptr_mode)
4201 {
4202 #ifdef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
4203 offset_rtx = convert_memory_address (ptr_mode, offset_rtx);
4204 #else
4205 offset_rtx = convert_to_mode (ptr_mode, offset_rtx, 0);
4206 #endif
4207 }
4208
4209 to_rtx
4210 = change_address (to_rtx, VOIDmode,
4211 gen_rtx_PLUS (ptr_mode, XEXP (to_rtx, 0),
4212 force_reg (ptr_mode,
4213 offset_rtx)));
4214 }
4215
4216 if (TREE_READONLY (field))
4217 {
4218 if (GET_CODE (to_rtx) == MEM)
4219 to_rtx = copy_rtx (to_rtx);
4220
4221 RTX_UNCHANGING_P (to_rtx) = 1;
4222 }
4223
4224 #ifdef WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
4225 /* If this initializes a field that is smaller than a word, at the
4226 start of a word, try to widen it to a full word.
4227 This special case allows us to output C++ member function
4228 initializations in a form that the optimizers can understand. */
4229 if (constant
4230 && GET_CODE (target) == REG
4231 && bitsize < BITS_PER_WORD
4232 && bitpos % BITS_PER_WORD == 0
4233 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
4234 && TREE_CODE (value) == INTEGER_CST
4235 && GET_CODE (exp_size) == CONST_INT
4236 && bitpos + BITS_PER_WORD <= INTVAL (exp_size) * BITS_PER_UNIT)
4237 {
4238 tree type = TREE_TYPE (value);
4239 if (TYPE_PRECISION (type) < BITS_PER_WORD)
4240 {
4241 type = type_for_size (BITS_PER_WORD, TREE_UNSIGNED (type));
4242 value = convert (type, value);
4243 }
4244 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
4245 value
4246 = fold (build (LSHIFT_EXPR, type, value,
4247 build_int_2 (BITS_PER_WORD - bitsize, 0)));
4248 bitsize = BITS_PER_WORD;
4249 mode = word_mode;
4250 }
4251 #endif
4252 store_constructor_field (to_rtx, bitsize, bitpos, mode,
4253 TREE_VALUE (elt), type,
4254 MIN (align,
4255 DECL_ALIGN (TREE_PURPOSE (elt))),
4256 cleared);
4257 }
4258 }
4259 else if (TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
4260 {
4261 register tree elt;
4262 register int i;
4263 int need_to_clear;
4264 tree domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (type);
4265 HOST_WIDE_INT minelt = TREE_INT_CST_LOW (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain));
4266 HOST_WIDE_INT maxelt = TREE_INT_CST_LOW (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain));
4267 tree elttype = TREE_TYPE (type);
4268
4269 /* If the constructor has fewer elements than the array,
4270 clear the whole array first. Similarly if this is
4271 static constructor of a non-BLKmode object. */
4272 if (cleared || (GET_CODE (target) == REG && TREE_STATIC (exp)))
4273 need_to_clear = 1;
4274 else
4275 {
4276 HOST_WIDE_INT count = 0, zero_count = 0;
4277 need_to_clear = 0;
4278 /* This loop is a more accurate version of the loop in
4279 mostly_zeros_p (it handles RANGE_EXPR in an index).
4280 It is also needed to check for missing elements. */
4281 for (elt = CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp);
4282 elt != NULL_TREE;
4283 elt = TREE_CHAIN (elt))
4284 {
4285 tree index = TREE_PURPOSE (elt);
4286 HOST_WIDE_INT this_node_count;
4287 if (index != NULL_TREE && TREE_CODE (index) == RANGE_EXPR)
4288 {
4289 tree lo_index = TREE_OPERAND (index, 0);
4290 tree hi_index = TREE_OPERAND (index, 1);
4291 if (TREE_CODE (lo_index) != INTEGER_CST
4292 || TREE_CODE (hi_index) != INTEGER_CST)
4293 {
4294 need_to_clear = 1;
4295 break;
4296 }
4297 this_node_count = TREE_INT_CST_LOW (hi_index)
4298 - TREE_INT_CST_LOW (lo_index) + 1;
4299 }
4300 else
4301 this_node_count = 1;
4302 count += this_node_count;
4303 if (mostly_zeros_p (TREE_VALUE (elt)))
4304 zero_count += this_node_count;
4305 }
4306 /* Clear the entire array first if there are any missing elements,
4307 or if the incidence of zero elements is >= 75%. */
4308 if (count < maxelt - minelt + 1
4309 || 4 * zero_count >= 3 * count)
4310 need_to_clear = 1;
4311 }
4312 if (need_to_clear)
4313 {
4314 if (! cleared)
4315 clear_storage (target, expr_size (exp),
4316 (align + BITS_PER_UNIT - 1) / BITS_PER_UNIT);
4317 cleared = 1;
4318 }
4319 else
4320 /* Inform later passes that the old value is dead. */
4321 emit_insn (gen_rtx_CLOBBER (VOIDmode, target));
4322
4323 /* Store each element of the constructor into
4324 the corresponding element of TARGET, determined
4325 by counting the elements. */
4326 for (elt = CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp), i = 0;
4327 elt;
4328 elt = TREE_CHAIN (elt), i++)
4329 {
4330 register enum machine_mode mode;
4331 int bitsize;
4332 int bitpos;
4333 int unsignedp;
4334 tree value = TREE_VALUE (elt);
4335 int align = TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (value));
4336 tree index = TREE_PURPOSE (elt);
4337 rtx xtarget = target;
4338
4339 if (cleared && is_zeros_p (value))
4340 continue;
4341
4342 unsignedp = TREE_UNSIGNED (elttype);
4343 mode = TYPE_MODE (elttype);
4344 if (mode == BLKmode)
4345 {
4346 if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (elttype)) == INTEGER_CST
4347 && TREE_INT_CST_HIGH (TYPE_SIZE (elttype)) == 0)
4348 bitsize = TREE_INT_CST_LOW (TYPE_SIZE (elttype));
4349 else
4350 bitsize = -1;
4351 }
4352 else
4353 bitsize = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode);
4354
4355 if (index != NULL_TREE && TREE_CODE (index) == RANGE_EXPR)
4356 {
4357 tree lo_index = TREE_OPERAND (index, 0);
4358 tree hi_index = TREE_OPERAND (index, 1);
4359 rtx index_r, pos_rtx, addr, hi_r, loop_top, loop_end;
4360 struct nesting *loop;
4361 HOST_WIDE_INT lo, hi, count;
4362 tree position;
4363
4364 /* If the range is constant and "small", unroll the loop. */
4365 if (TREE_CODE (lo_index) == INTEGER_CST
4366 && TREE_CODE (hi_index) == INTEGER_CST
4367 && (lo = TREE_INT_CST_LOW (lo_index),
4368 hi = TREE_INT_CST_LOW (hi_index),
4369 count = hi - lo + 1,
4370 (GET_CODE (target) != MEM
4371 || count <= 2
4372 || (TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (elttype)) == INTEGER_CST
4373 && TREE_INT_CST_LOW (TYPE_SIZE (elttype)) * count
4374 <= 40 * 8))))
4375 {
4376 lo -= minelt; hi -= minelt;
4377 for (; lo <= hi; lo++)
4378 {
4379 bitpos = lo * TREE_INT_CST_LOW (TYPE_SIZE (elttype));
4380 store_constructor_field (target, bitsize, bitpos, mode,
4381 value, type, align, cleared);
4382 }
4383 }
4384 else
4385 {
4386 hi_r = expand_expr (hi_index, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
4387 loop_top = gen_label_rtx ();
4388 loop_end = gen_label_rtx ();
4389
4390 unsignedp = TREE_UNSIGNED (domain);
4391
4392 index = build_decl (VAR_DECL, NULL_TREE, domain);
4393
4394 DECL_RTL (index) = index_r
4395 = gen_reg_rtx (promote_mode (domain, DECL_MODE (index),
4396 &unsignedp, 0));
4397
4398 if (TREE_CODE (value) == SAVE_EXPR
4399 && SAVE_EXPR_RTL (value) == 0)
4400 {
4401 /* Make sure value gets expanded once before the
4402 loop. */
4403 expand_expr (value, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, 0);
4404 emit_queue ();
4405 }
4406 store_expr (lo_index, index_r, 0);
4407 loop = expand_start_loop (0);
4408
4409 /* Assign value to element index. */
4410 position = size_binop (EXACT_DIV_EXPR, TYPE_SIZE (elttype),
4411 size_int (BITS_PER_UNIT));
4412 position = size_binop (MULT_EXPR,
4413 size_binop (MINUS_EXPR, index,
4414 TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain)),
4415 position);
4416 pos_rtx = expand_expr (position, 0, VOIDmode, 0);
4417 addr = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, XEXP (target, 0), pos_rtx);
4418 xtarget = change_address (target, mode, addr);
4419 if (TREE_CODE (value) == CONSTRUCTOR)
4420 store_constructor (value, xtarget, align, cleared);
4421 else
4422 store_expr (value, xtarget, 0);
4423
4424 expand_exit_loop_if_false (loop,
4425 build (LT_EXPR, integer_type_node,
4426 index, hi_index));
4427
4428 expand_increment (build (PREINCREMENT_EXPR,
4429 TREE_TYPE (index),
4430 index, integer_one_node), 0, 0);
4431 expand_end_loop ();
4432 emit_label (loop_end);
4433
4434 /* Needed by stupid register allocation. to extend the
4435 lifetime of pseudo-regs used by target past the end
4436 of the loop. */
4437 emit_insn (gen_rtx_USE (GET_MODE (target), target));
4438 }
4439 }
4440 else if ((index != 0 && TREE_CODE (index) != INTEGER_CST)
4441 || TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (elttype)) != INTEGER_CST)
4442 {
4443 rtx pos_rtx, addr;
4444 tree position;
4445
4446 if (index == 0)
4447 index = size_int (i);
4448
4449 if (minelt)
4450 index = size_binop (MINUS_EXPR, index,
4451 TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain));
4452 position = size_binop (EXACT_DIV_EXPR, TYPE_SIZE (elttype),
4453 size_int (BITS_PER_UNIT));
4454 position = size_binop (MULT_EXPR, index, position);
4455 pos_rtx = expand_expr (position, 0, VOIDmode, 0);
4456 addr = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, XEXP (target, 0), pos_rtx);
4457 xtarget = change_address (target, mode, addr);
4458 store_expr (value, xtarget, 0);
4459 }
4460 else
4461 {
4462 if (index != 0)
4463 bitpos = ((TREE_INT_CST_LOW (index) - minelt)
4464 * TREE_INT_CST_LOW (TYPE_SIZE (elttype)));
4465 else
4466 bitpos = (i * TREE_INT_CST_LOW (TYPE_SIZE (elttype)));
4467 store_constructor_field (target, bitsize, bitpos, mode, value,
4468 type, align, cleared);
4469 }
4470 }
4471 }
4472 /* set constructor assignments */
4473 else if (TREE_CODE (type) == SET_TYPE)
4474 {
4475 tree elt = CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp);
4476 int nbytes = int_size_in_bytes (type), nbits;
4477 tree domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (type);
4478 tree domain_min, domain_max, bitlength;
4479
4480 /* The default implementation strategy is to extract the constant
4481 parts of the constructor, use that to initialize the target,
4482 and then "or" in whatever non-constant ranges we need in addition.
4483
4484 If a large set is all zero or all ones, it is
4485 probably better to set it using memset (if available) or bzero.
4486 Also, if a large set has just a single range, it may also be
4487 better to first clear all the first clear the set (using
4488 bzero/memset), and set the bits we want. */
4489
4490 /* Check for all zeros. */
4491 if (elt == NULL_TREE)
4492 {
4493 if (!cleared)
4494 clear_storage (target, expr_size (exp),
4495 TYPE_ALIGN (type) / BITS_PER_UNIT);
4496 return;
4497 }
4498
4499 domain_min = convert (sizetype, TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain));
4500 domain_max = convert (sizetype, TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain));
4501 bitlength = size_binop (PLUS_EXPR,
4502 size_binop (MINUS_EXPR, domain_max, domain_min),
4503 size_one_node);
4504
4505 if (nbytes < 0 || TREE_CODE (bitlength) != INTEGER_CST)
4506 abort ();
4507 nbits = TREE_INT_CST_LOW (bitlength);
4508
4509 /* For "small" sets, or "medium-sized" (up to 32 bytes) sets that
4510 are "complicated" (more than one range), initialize (the
4511 constant parts) by copying from a constant. */
4512 if (GET_MODE (target) != BLKmode || nbits <= 2 * BITS_PER_WORD
4513 || (nbytes <= 32 && TREE_CHAIN (elt) != NULL_TREE))
4514 {
4515 int set_word_size = TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (exp));
4516 enum machine_mode mode = mode_for_size (set_word_size, MODE_INT, 1);
4517 char *bit_buffer = (char *) alloca (nbits);
4518 HOST_WIDE_INT word = 0;
4519 int bit_pos = 0;
4520 int ibit = 0;
4521 int offset = 0; /* In bytes from beginning of set. */
4522 elt = get_set_constructor_bits (exp, bit_buffer, nbits);
4523 for (;;)
4524 {
4525 if (bit_buffer[ibit])
4526 {
4527 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
4528 word |= (1 << (set_word_size - 1 - bit_pos));
4529 else
4530 word |= 1 << bit_pos;
4531 }
4532 bit_pos++; ibit++;
4533 if (bit_pos >= set_word_size || ibit == nbits)
4534 {
4535 if (word != 0 || ! cleared)
4536 {
4537 rtx datum = GEN_INT (word);
4538 rtx to_rtx;
4539 /* The assumption here is that it is safe to use
4540 XEXP if the set is multi-word, but not if
4541 it's single-word. */
4542 if (GET_CODE (target) == MEM)
4543 {
4544 to_rtx = plus_constant (XEXP (target, 0), offset);
4545 to_rtx = change_address (target, mode, to_rtx);
4546 }
4547 else if (offset == 0)
4548 to_rtx = target;
4549 else
4550 abort ();
4551 emit_move_insn (to_rtx, datum);
4552 }
4553 if (ibit == nbits)
4554 break;
4555 word = 0;
4556 bit_pos = 0;
4557 offset += set_word_size / BITS_PER_UNIT;
4558 }
4559 }
4560 }
4561 else if (!cleared)
4562 {
4563 /* Don't bother clearing storage if the set is all ones. */
4564 if (TREE_CHAIN (elt) != NULL_TREE
4565 || (TREE_PURPOSE (elt) == NULL_TREE
4566 ? nbits != 1
4567 : (TREE_CODE (TREE_VALUE (elt)) != INTEGER_CST
4568 || TREE_CODE (TREE_PURPOSE (elt)) != INTEGER_CST
4569 || (TREE_INT_CST_LOW (TREE_VALUE (elt))
4570 - TREE_INT_CST_LOW (TREE_PURPOSE (elt)) + 1
4571 != nbits))))
4572 clear_storage (target, expr_size (exp),
4573 TYPE_ALIGN (type) / BITS_PER_UNIT);
4574 }
4575
4576 for (; elt != NULL_TREE; elt = TREE_CHAIN (elt))
4577 {
4578 /* start of range of element or NULL */
4579 tree startbit = TREE_PURPOSE (elt);
4580 /* end of range of element, or element value */
4581 tree endbit = TREE_VALUE (elt);
4582 #ifdef TARGET_MEM_FUNCTIONS
4583 HOST_WIDE_INT startb, endb;
4584 #endif
4585 rtx bitlength_rtx, startbit_rtx, endbit_rtx, targetx;
4586
4587 bitlength_rtx = expand_expr (bitlength,
4588 NULL_RTX, MEM, EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS);
4589
4590 /* handle non-range tuple element like [ expr ] */
4591 if (startbit == NULL_TREE)
4592 {
4593 startbit = save_expr (endbit);
4594 endbit = startbit;
4595 }
4596 startbit = convert (sizetype, startbit);
4597 endbit = convert (sizetype, endbit);
4598 if (! integer_zerop (domain_min))
4599 {
4600 startbit = size_binop (MINUS_EXPR, startbit, domain_min);
4601 endbit = size_binop (MINUS_EXPR, endbit, domain_min);
4602 }
4603 startbit_rtx = expand_expr (startbit, NULL_RTX, MEM,
4604 EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS);
4605 endbit_rtx = expand_expr (endbit, NULL_RTX, MEM,
4606 EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS);
4607
4608 if (REG_P (target))
4609 {
4610 targetx = assign_stack_temp (GET_MODE (target),
4611 GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (target)),
4612 0);
4613 emit_move_insn (targetx, target);
4614 }
4615 else if (GET_CODE (target) == MEM)
4616 targetx = target;
4617 else
4618 abort ();
4619
4620 #ifdef TARGET_MEM_FUNCTIONS
4621 /* Optimization: If startbit and endbit are
4622 constants divisible by BITS_PER_UNIT,
4623 call memset instead. */
4624 if (TREE_CODE (startbit) == INTEGER_CST
4625 && TREE_CODE (endbit) == INTEGER_CST
4626 && (startb = TREE_INT_CST_LOW (startbit)) % BITS_PER_UNIT == 0
4627 && (endb = TREE_INT_CST_LOW (endbit) + 1) % BITS_PER_UNIT == 0)
4628 {
4629 emit_library_call (memset_libfunc, 0,
4630 VOIDmode, 3,
4631 plus_constant (XEXP (targetx, 0),
4632 startb / BITS_PER_UNIT),
4633 Pmode,
4634 constm1_rtx, TYPE_MODE (integer_type_node),
4635 GEN_INT ((endb - startb) / BITS_PER_UNIT),
4636 TYPE_MODE (sizetype));
4637 }
4638 else
4639 #endif
4640 {
4641 emit_library_call (gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, "__setbits"),
4642 0, VOIDmode, 4, XEXP (targetx, 0), Pmode,
4643 bitlength_rtx, TYPE_MODE (sizetype),
4644 startbit_rtx, TYPE_MODE (sizetype),
4645 endbit_rtx, TYPE_MODE (sizetype));
4646 }
4647 if (REG_P (target))
4648 emit_move_insn (target, targetx);
4649 }
4650 }
4651
4652 else
4653 abort ();
4654 }
4655
4656 /* Store the value of EXP (an expression tree)
4657 into a subfield of TARGET which has mode MODE and occupies
4658 BITSIZE bits, starting BITPOS bits from the start of TARGET.
4659 If MODE is VOIDmode, it means that we are storing into a bit-field.
4660
4661 If VALUE_MODE is VOIDmode, return nothing in particular.
4662 UNSIGNEDP is not used in this case.
4663
4664 Otherwise, return an rtx for the value stored. This rtx
4665 has mode VALUE_MODE if that is convenient to do.
4666 In this case, UNSIGNEDP must be nonzero if the value is an unsigned type.
4667
4668 ALIGN is the alignment that TARGET is known to have, measured in bytes.
4669 TOTAL_SIZE is the size in bytes of the structure, or -1 if varying.
4670
4671 ALIAS_SET is the alias set for the destination. This value will
4672 (in general) be different from that for TARGET, since TARGET is a
4673 reference to the containing structure. */
4674
4675 static rtx
4676 store_field (target, bitsize, bitpos, mode, exp, value_mode,
4677 unsignedp, align, total_size, alias_set)
4678 rtx target;
4679 int bitsize, bitpos;
4680 enum machine_mode mode;
4681 tree exp;
4682 enum machine_mode value_mode;
4683 int unsignedp;
4684 int align;
4685 int total_size;
4686 int alias_set;
4687 {
4688 HOST_WIDE_INT width_mask = 0;
4689
4690 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == ERROR_MARK)
4691 return const0_rtx;
4692
4693 if (bitsize < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
4694 width_mask = ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << bitsize) - 1;
4695
4696 /* If we are storing into an unaligned field of an aligned union that is
4697 in a register, we may have the mode of TARGET being an integer mode but
4698 MODE == BLKmode. In that case, get an aligned object whose size and
4699 alignment are the same as TARGET and store TARGET into it (we can avoid
4700 the store if the field being stored is the entire width of TARGET). Then
4701 call ourselves recursively to store the field into a BLKmode version of
4702 that object. Finally, load from the object into TARGET. This is not
4703 very efficient in general, but should only be slightly more expensive
4704 than the otherwise-required unaligned accesses. Perhaps this can be
4705 cleaned up later. */
4706
4707 if (mode == BLKmode
4708 && (GET_CODE (target) == REG || GET_CODE (target) == SUBREG))
4709 {
4710 rtx object = assign_stack_temp (GET_MODE (target),
4711 GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (target)), 0);
4712 rtx blk_object = copy_rtx (object);
4713
4714 MEM_SET_IN_STRUCT_P (object, 1);
4715 MEM_SET_IN_STRUCT_P (blk_object, 1);
4716 PUT_MODE (blk_object, BLKmode);
4717
4718 if (bitsize != GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (target)))
4719 emit_move_insn (object, target);
4720
4721 store_field (blk_object, bitsize, bitpos, mode, exp, VOIDmode, 0,
4722 align, total_size, alias_set);
4723
4724 /* Even though we aren't returning target, we need to
4725 give it the updated value. */
4726 emit_move_insn (target, object);
4727
4728 return blk_object;
4729 }
4730
4731 /* If the structure is in a register or if the component
4732 is a bit field, we cannot use addressing to access it.
4733 Use bit-field techniques or SUBREG to store in it. */
4734
4735 if (mode == VOIDmode
4736 || (mode != BLKmode && ! direct_store[(int) mode]
4737 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_COMPLEX_INT
4738 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_COMPLEX_FLOAT)
4739 || GET_CODE (target) == REG
4740 || GET_CODE (target) == SUBREG
4741 /* If the field isn't aligned enough to store as an ordinary memref,
4742 store it as a bit field. */
4743 || (mode != BLKmode && SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS
4744 && (align * BITS_PER_UNIT < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode)
4745 || bitpos % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode)))
4746 || (mode == BLKmode && SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS
4747 && (TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (exp)) > align * BITS_PER_UNIT
4748 || bitpos % TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (exp)) != 0))
4749 /* If the RHS and field are a constant size and the size of the
4750 RHS isn't the same size as the bitfield, we must use bitfield
4751 operations. */
4752 || ((bitsize >= 0
4753 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp))) == INTEGER_CST)
4754 && (TREE_INT_CST_HIGH (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp))) != 0
4755 || TREE_INT_CST_LOW (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp))) != bitsize)))
4756 {
4757 rtx temp = expand_expr (exp, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
4758
4759 /* If BITSIZE is narrower than the size of the type of EXP
4760 we will be narrowing TEMP. Normally, what's wanted are the
4761 low-order bits. However, if EXP's type is a record and this is
4762 big-endian machine, we want the upper BITSIZE bits. */
4763 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN && GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (temp)) == MODE_INT
4764 && bitsize < GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (temp))
4765 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)) == RECORD_TYPE)
4766 temp = expand_shift (RSHIFT_EXPR, GET_MODE (temp), temp,
4767 size_int (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (temp))
4768 - bitsize),
4769 temp, 1);
4770
4771 /* Unless MODE is VOIDmode or BLKmode, convert TEMP to
4772 MODE. */
4773 if (mode != VOIDmode && mode != BLKmode
4774 && mode != TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
4775 temp = convert_modes (mode, TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)), temp, 1);
4776
4777 /* If the modes of TARGET and TEMP are both BLKmode, both
4778 must be in memory and BITPOS must be aligned on a byte
4779 boundary. If so, we simply do a block copy. */
4780 if (GET_MODE (target) == BLKmode && GET_MODE (temp) == BLKmode)
4781 {
4782 if (GET_CODE (target) != MEM || GET_CODE (temp) != MEM
4783 || bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0)
4784 abort ();
4785
4786 target = change_address (target, VOIDmode,
4787 plus_constant (XEXP (target, 0),
4788 bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT));
4789
4790 /* Find an alignment that is consistent with the bit position. */
4791 while ((bitpos % (align * BITS_PER_UNIT)) != 0)
4792 align >>= 1;
4793
4794 emit_block_move (target, temp,
4795 GEN_INT ((bitsize + BITS_PER_UNIT - 1)
4796 / BITS_PER_UNIT),
4797 align);
4798
4799 return value_mode == VOIDmode ? const0_rtx : target;
4800 }
4801
4802 /* Store the value in the bitfield. */
4803 store_bit_field (target, bitsize, bitpos, mode, temp, align, total_size);
4804 if (value_mode != VOIDmode)
4805 {
4806 /* The caller wants an rtx for the value. */
4807 /* If possible, avoid refetching from the bitfield itself. */
4808 if (width_mask != 0
4809 && ! (GET_CODE (target) == MEM && MEM_VOLATILE_P (target)))
4810 {
4811 tree count;
4812 enum machine_mode tmode;
4813
4814 if (unsignedp)
4815 return expand_and (temp, GEN_INT (width_mask), NULL_RTX);
4816 tmode = GET_MODE (temp);
4817 if (tmode == VOIDmode)
4818 tmode = value_mode;
4819 count = build_int_2 (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (tmode) - bitsize, 0);
4820 temp = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, tmode, temp, count, 0, 0);
4821 return expand_shift (RSHIFT_EXPR, tmode, temp, count, 0, 0);
4822 }
4823 return extract_bit_field (target, bitsize, bitpos, unsignedp,
4824 NULL_RTX, value_mode, 0, align,
4825 total_size);
4826 }
4827 return const0_rtx;
4828 }
4829 else
4830 {
4831 rtx addr = XEXP (target, 0);
4832 rtx to_rtx;
4833
4834 /* If a value is wanted, it must be the lhs;
4835 so make the address stable for multiple use. */
4836
4837 if (value_mode != VOIDmode && GET_CODE (addr) != REG
4838 && ! CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (addr)
4839 /* A frame-pointer reference is already stable. */
4840 && ! (GET_CODE (addr) == PLUS
4841 && GET_CODE (XEXP (addr, 1)) == CONST_INT
4842 && (XEXP (addr, 0) == virtual_incoming_args_rtx
4843 || XEXP (addr, 0) == virtual_stack_vars_rtx)))
4844 addr = copy_to_reg (addr);
4845
4846 /* Now build a reference to just the desired component. */
4847
4848 to_rtx = copy_rtx (change_address (target, mode,
4849 plus_constant (addr,
4850 (bitpos
4851 / BITS_PER_UNIT))));
4852 MEM_SET_IN_STRUCT_P (to_rtx, 1);
4853 MEM_ALIAS_SET (to_rtx) = alias_set;
4854
4855 return store_expr (exp, to_rtx, value_mode != VOIDmode);
4856 }
4857 }
4858 \f
4859 /* Given an expression EXP that may be a COMPONENT_REF, a BIT_FIELD_REF,
4860 or an ARRAY_REF, look for nested COMPONENT_REFs, BIT_FIELD_REFs, or
4861 ARRAY_REFs and find the ultimate containing object, which we return.
4862
4863 We set *PBITSIZE to the size in bits that we want, *PBITPOS to the
4864 bit position, and *PUNSIGNEDP to the signedness of the field.
4865 If the position of the field is variable, we store a tree
4866 giving the variable offset (in units) in *POFFSET.
4867 This offset is in addition to the bit position.
4868 If the position is not variable, we store 0 in *POFFSET.
4869 We set *PALIGNMENT to the alignment in bytes of the address that will be
4870 computed. This is the alignment of the thing we return if *POFFSET
4871 is zero, but can be more less strictly aligned if *POFFSET is nonzero.
4872
4873 If any of the extraction expressions is volatile,
4874 we store 1 in *PVOLATILEP. Otherwise we don't change that.
4875
4876 If the field is a bit-field, *PMODE is set to VOIDmode. Otherwise, it
4877 is a mode that can be used to access the field. In that case, *PBITSIZE
4878 is redundant.
4879
4880 If the field describes a variable-sized object, *PMODE is set to
4881 VOIDmode and *PBITSIZE is set to -1. An access cannot be made in
4882 this case, but the address of the object can be found. */
4883
4884 tree
4885 get_inner_reference (exp, pbitsize, pbitpos, poffset, pmode,
4886 punsignedp, pvolatilep, palignment)
4887 tree exp;
4888 int *pbitsize;
4889 int *pbitpos;
4890 tree *poffset;
4891 enum machine_mode *pmode;
4892 int *punsignedp;
4893 int *pvolatilep;
4894 int *palignment;
4895 {
4896 tree orig_exp = exp;
4897 tree size_tree = 0;
4898 enum machine_mode mode = VOIDmode;
4899 tree offset = integer_zero_node;
4900 unsigned int alignment = BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT;
4901
4902 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == COMPONENT_REF)
4903 {
4904 size_tree = DECL_SIZE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1));
4905 if (! DECL_BIT_FIELD (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)))
4906 mode = DECL_MODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1));
4907 *punsignedp = TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1));
4908 }
4909 else if (TREE_CODE (exp) == BIT_FIELD_REF)
4910 {
4911 size_tree = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
4912 *punsignedp = TREE_UNSIGNED (exp);
4913 }
4914 else
4915 {
4916 mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp));
4917 if (mode == BLKmode)
4918 size_tree = TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp));
4919
4920 *pbitsize = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode);
4921 *punsignedp = TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (exp));
4922 }
4923
4924 if (size_tree)
4925 {
4926 if (TREE_CODE (size_tree) != INTEGER_CST)
4927 mode = BLKmode, *pbitsize = -1;
4928 else
4929 *pbitsize = TREE_INT_CST_LOW (size_tree);
4930 }
4931
4932 /* Compute cumulative bit-offset for nested component-refs and array-refs,
4933 and find the ultimate containing object. */
4934
4935 *pbitpos = 0;
4936
4937 while (1)
4938 {
4939 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == COMPONENT_REF || TREE_CODE (exp) == BIT_FIELD_REF)
4940 {
4941 tree pos = (TREE_CODE (exp) == COMPONENT_REF
4942 ? DECL_FIELD_BITPOS (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1))
4943 : TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2));
4944 tree constant = integer_zero_node, var = pos;
4945
4946 /* If this field hasn't been filled in yet, don't go
4947 past it. This should only happen when folding expressions
4948 made during type construction. */
4949 if (pos == 0)
4950 break;
4951
4952 /* Assume here that the offset is a multiple of a unit.
4953 If not, there should be an explicitly added constant. */
4954 if (TREE_CODE (pos) == PLUS_EXPR
4955 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (pos, 1)) == INTEGER_CST)
4956 constant = TREE_OPERAND (pos, 1), var = TREE_OPERAND (pos, 0);
4957 else if (TREE_CODE (pos) == INTEGER_CST)
4958 constant = pos, var = integer_zero_node;
4959
4960 *pbitpos += TREE_INT_CST_LOW (constant);
4961 offset = size_binop (PLUS_EXPR, offset,
4962 size_binop (EXACT_DIV_EXPR, var,
4963 size_int (BITS_PER_UNIT)));
4964 }
4965
4966 else if (TREE_CODE (exp) == ARRAY_REF)
4967 {
4968 /* This code is based on the code in case ARRAY_REF in expand_expr
4969 below. We assume here that the size of an array element is
4970 always an integral multiple of BITS_PER_UNIT. */
4971
4972 tree index = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
4973 tree domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)));
4974 tree low_bound
4975 = domain ? TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain) : integer_zero_node;
4976 tree index_type = TREE_TYPE (index);
4977 tree xindex;
4978
4979 if (TYPE_PRECISION (index_type) != TYPE_PRECISION (sizetype))
4980 {
4981 index = convert (type_for_size (TYPE_PRECISION (sizetype), 0),
4982 index);
4983 index_type = TREE_TYPE (index);
4984 }
4985
4986 /* Optimize the special-case of a zero lower bound.
4987
4988 We convert the low_bound to sizetype to avoid some problems
4989 with constant folding. (E.g. suppose the lower bound is 1,
4990 and its mode is QI. Without the conversion, (ARRAY
4991 +(INDEX-(unsigned char)1)) becomes ((ARRAY+(-(unsigned char)1))
4992 +INDEX), which becomes (ARRAY+255+INDEX). Oops!)
4993
4994 But sizetype isn't quite right either (especially if
4995 the lowbound is negative). FIXME */
4996
4997 if (! integer_zerop (low_bound))
4998 index = fold (build (MINUS_EXPR, index_type, index,
4999 convert (sizetype, low_bound)));
5000
5001 if (TREE_CODE (index) == INTEGER_CST)
5002 {
5003 index = convert (sbitsizetype, index);
5004 index_type = TREE_TYPE (index);
5005 }
5006
5007 xindex = fold (build (MULT_EXPR, sbitsizetype, index,
5008 convert (sbitsizetype,
5009 TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp)))));
5010
5011 if (TREE_CODE (xindex) == INTEGER_CST
5012 && TREE_INT_CST_HIGH (xindex) == 0)
5013 *pbitpos += TREE_INT_CST_LOW (xindex);
5014 else
5015 {
5016 /* Either the bit offset calculated above is not constant, or
5017 it overflowed. In either case, redo the multiplication
5018 against the size in units. This is especially important
5019 in the non-constant case to avoid a division at runtime. */
5020 xindex = fold (build (MULT_EXPR, ssizetype, index,
5021 convert (ssizetype,
5022 TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (TREE_TYPE (exp)))));
5023
5024 if (contains_placeholder_p (xindex))
5025 xindex = build (WITH_RECORD_EXPR, sizetype, xindex, exp);
5026
5027 offset = size_binop (PLUS_EXPR, offset, xindex);
5028 }
5029 }
5030 else if (TREE_CODE (exp) != NON_LVALUE_EXPR
5031 && ! ((TREE_CODE (exp) == NOP_EXPR
5032 || TREE_CODE (exp) == CONVERT_EXPR)
5033 && (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp))
5034 == TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))))))
5035 break;
5036
5037 /* If any reference in the chain is volatile, the effect is volatile. */
5038 if (TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (exp))
5039 *pvolatilep = 1;
5040
5041 /* If the offset is non-constant already, then we can't assume any
5042 alignment more than the alignment here. */
5043 if (! integer_zerop (offset))
5044 alignment = MIN (alignment, TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
5045
5046 exp = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
5047 }
5048
5049 if (TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (exp)) == 'd')
5050 alignment = MIN (alignment, DECL_ALIGN (exp));
5051 else if (TREE_TYPE (exp) != 0)
5052 alignment = MIN (alignment, TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
5053
5054 if (integer_zerop (offset))
5055 offset = 0;
5056
5057 if (offset != 0 && contains_placeholder_p (offset))
5058 offset = build (WITH_RECORD_EXPR, sizetype, offset, orig_exp);
5059
5060 *pmode = mode;
5061 *poffset = offset;
5062 *palignment = alignment / BITS_PER_UNIT;
5063 return exp;
5064 }
5065
5066 /* Subroutine of expand_exp: compute memory_usage from modifier. */
5067 static enum memory_use_mode
5068 get_memory_usage_from_modifier (modifier)
5069 enum expand_modifier modifier;
5070 {
5071 switch (modifier)
5072 {
5073 case EXPAND_NORMAL:
5074 case EXPAND_SUM:
5075 return MEMORY_USE_RO;
5076 break;
5077 case EXPAND_MEMORY_USE_WO:
5078 return MEMORY_USE_WO;
5079 break;
5080 case EXPAND_MEMORY_USE_RW:
5081 return MEMORY_USE_RW;
5082 break;
5083 case EXPAND_MEMORY_USE_DONT:
5084 /* EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS and EXPAND_INITIALIZER are converted into
5085 MEMORY_USE_DONT, because they are modifiers to a call of
5086 expand_expr in the ADDR_EXPR case of expand_expr. */
5087 case EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS:
5088 case EXPAND_INITIALIZER:
5089 return MEMORY_USE_DONT;
5090 case EXPAND_MEMORY_USE_BAD:
5091 default:
5092 abort ();
5093 }
5094 }
5095 \f
5096 /* Given an rtx VALUE that may contain additions and multiplications,
5097 return an equivalent value that just refers to a register or memory.
5098 This is done by generating instructions to perform the arithmetic
5099 and returning a pseudo-register containing the value.
5100
5101 The returned value may be a REG, SUBREG, MEM or constant. */
5102
5103 rtx
5104 force_operand (value, target)
5105 rtx value, target;
5106 {
5107 register optab binoptab = 0;
5108 /* Use a temporary to force order of execution of calls to
5109 `force_operand'. */
5110 rtx tmp;
5111 register rtx op2;
5112 /* Use subtarget as the target for operand 0 of a binary operation. */
5113 register rtx subtarget = (target != 0 && GET_CODE (target) == REG ? target : 0);
5114
5115 /* Check for a PIC address load. */
5116 if (flag_pic
5117 && (GET_CODE (value) == PLUS || GET_CODE (value) == MINUS)
5118 && XEXP (value, 0) == pic_offset_table_rtx
5119 && (GET_CODE (XEXP (value, 1)) == SYMBOL_REF
5120 || GET_CODE (XEXP (value, 1)) == LABEL_REF
5121 || GET_CODE (XEXP (value, 1)) == CONST))
5122 {
5123 if (!subtarget)
5124 subtarget = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (value));
5125 emit_move_insn (subtarget, value);
5126 return subtarget;
5127 }
5128
5129 if (GET_CODE (value) == PLUS)
5130 binoptab = add_optab;
5131 else if (GET_CODE (value) == MINUS)
5132 binoptab = sub_optab;
5133 else if (GET_CODE (value) == MULT)
5134 {
5135 op2 = XEXP (value, 1);
5136 if (!CONSTANT_P (op2)
5137 && !(GET_CODE (op2) == REG && op2 != subtarget))
5138 subtarget = 0;
5139 tmp = force_operand (XEXP (value, 0), subtarget);
5140 return expand_mult (GET_MODE (value), tmp,
5141 force_operand (op2, NULL_RTX),
5142 target, 0);
5143 }
5144
5145 if (binoptab)
5146 {
5147 op2 = XEXP (value, 1);
5148 if (!CONSTANT_P (op2)
5149 && !(GET_CODE (op2) == REG && op2 != subtarget))
5150 subtarget = 0;
5151 if (binoptab == sub_optab && GET_CODE (op2) == CONST_INT)
5152 {
5153 binoptab = add_optab;
5154 op2 = negate_rtx (GET_MODE (value), op2);
5155 }
5156
5157 /* Check for an addition with OP2 a constant integer and our first
5158 operand a PLUS of a virtual register and something else. In that
5159 case, we want to emit the sum of the virtual register and the
5160 constant first and then add the other value. This allows virtual
5161 register instantiation to simply modify the constant rather than
5162 creating another one around this addition. */
5163 if (binoptab == add_optab && GET_CODE (op2) == CONST_INT
5164 && GET_CODE (XEXP (value, 0)) == PLUS
5165 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (value, 0), 0)) == REG
5166 && REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (value, 0), 0)) >= FIRST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER
5167 && REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (value, 0), 0)) <= LAST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER)
5168 {
5169 rtx temp = expand_binop (GET_MODE (value), binoptab,
5170 XEXP (XEXP (value, 0), 0), op2,
5171 subtarget, 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
5172 return expand_binop (GET_MODE (value), binoptab, temp,
5173 force_operand (XEXP (XEXP (value, 0), 1), 0),
5174 target, 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
5175 }
5176
5177 tmp = force_operand (XEXP (value, 0), subtarget);
5178 return expand_binop (GET_MODE (value), binoptab, tmp,
5179 force_operand (op2, NULL_RTX),
5180 target, 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
5181 /* We give UNSIGNEDP = 0 to expand_binop
5182 because the only operations we are expanding here are signed ones. */
5183 }
5184 return value;
5185 }
5186 \f
5187 /* Subroutine of expand_expr:
5188 save the non-copied parts (LIST) of an expr (LHS), and return a list
5189 which can restore these values to their previous values,
5190 should something modify their storage. */
5191
5192 static tree
5193 save_noncopied_parts (lhs, list)
5194 tree lhs;
5195 tree list;
5196 {
5197 tree tail;
5198 tree parts = 0;
5199
5200 for (tail = list; tail; tail = TREE_CHAIN (tail))
5201 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_VALUE (tail)) == TREE_LIST)
5202 parts = chainon (parts, save_noncopied_parts (lhs, TREE_VALUE (tail)));
5203 else
5204 {
5205 tree part = TREE_VALUE (tail);
5206 tree part_type = TREE_TYPE (part);
5207 tree to_be_saved = build (COMPONENT_REF, part_type, lhs, part);
5208 rtx target = assign_temp (part_type, 0, 1, 1);
5209 if (! memory_address_p (TYPE_MODE (part_type), XEXP (target, 0)))
5210 target = change_address (target, TYPE_MODE (part_type), NULL_RTX);
5211 parts = tree_cons (to_be_saved,
5212 build (RTL_EXPR, part_type, NULL_TREE,
5213 (tree) target),
5214 parts);
5215 store_expr (TREE_PURPOSE (parts), RTL_EXPR_RTL (TREE_VALUE (parts)), 0);
5216 }
5217 return parts;
5218 }
5219
5220 /* Subroutine of expand_expr:
5221 record the non-copied parts (LIST) of an expr (LHS), and return a list
5222 which specifies the initial values of these parts. */
5223
5224 static tree
5225 init_noncopied_parts (lhs, list)
5226 tree lhs;
5227 tree list;
5228 {
5229 tree tail;
5230 tree parts = 0;
5231
5232 for (tail = list; tail; tail = TREE_CHAIN (tail))
5233 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_VALUE (tail)) == TREE_LIST)
5234 parts = chainon (parts, init_noncopied_parts (lhs, TREE_VALUE (tail)));
5235 else if (TREE_PURPOSE (tail))
5236 {
5237 tree part = TREE_VALUE (tail);
5238 tree part_type = TREE_TYPE (part);
5239 tree to_be_initialized = build (COMPONENT_REF, part_type, lhs, part);
5240 parts = tree_cons (TREE_PURPOSE (tail), to_be_initialized, parts);
5241 }
5242 return parts;
5243 }
5244
5245 /* Subroutine of expand_expr: return nonzero iff there is no way that
5246 EXP can reference X, which is being modified. TOP_P is nonzero if this
5247 call is going to be used to determine whether we need a temporary
5248 for EXP, as opposed to a recursive call to this function.
5249
5250 It is always safe for this routine to return zero since it merely
5251 searches for optimization opportunities. */
5252
5253 static int
5254 safe_from_p (x, exp, top_p)
5255 rtx x;
5256 tree exp;
5257 int top_p;
5258 {
5259 rtx exp_rtl = 0;
5260 int i, nops;
5261 static int save_expr_count;
5262 static int save_expr_size = 0;
5263 static tree *save_expr_rewritten;
5264 static tree save_expr_trees[256];
5265
5266 if (x == 0
5267 /* If EXP has varying size, we MUST use a target since we currently
5268 have no way of allocating temporaries of variable size
5269 (except for arrays that have TYPE_ARRAY_MAX_SIZE set).
5270 So we assume here that something at a higher level has prevented a
5271 clash. This is somewhat bogus, but the best we can do. Only
5272 do this when X is BLKmode and when we are at the top level. */
5273 || (top_p && TREE_TYPE (exp) != 0 && TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp)) != 0
5274 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp))) != INTEGER_CST
5275 && (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)) != ARRAY_TYPE
5276 || TYPE_ARRAY_MAX_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp)) == NULL_TREE
5277 || TREE_CODE (TYPE_ARRAY_MAX_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
5278 != INTEGER_CST)
5279 && GET_MODE (x) == BLKmode))
5280 return 1;
5281
5282 if (top_p && save_expr_size == 0)
5283 {
5284 int rtn;
5285
5286 save_expr_count = 0;
5287 save_expr_size = sizeof (save_expr_trees) / sizeof (save_expr_trees[0]);
5288 save_expr_rewritten = &save_expr_trees[0];
5289
5290 rtn = safe_from_p (x, exp, 1);
5291
5292 for (i = 0; i < save_expr_count; ++i)
5293 {
5294 if (TREE_CODE (save_expr_trees[i]) != ERROR_MARK)
5295 abort ();
5296 TREE_SET_CODE (save_expr_trees[i], SAVE_EXPR);
5297 }
5298
5299 save_expr_size = 0;
5300
5301 return rtn;
5302 }
5303
5304 /* If this is a subreg of a hard register, declare it unsafe, otherwise,
5305 find the underlying pseudo. */
5306 if (GET_CODE (x) == SUBREG)
5307 {
5308 x = SUBREG_REG (x);
5309 if (GET_CODE (x) == REG && REGNO (x) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
5310 return 0;
5311 }
5312
5313 /* If X is a location in the outgoing argument area, it is always safe. */
5314 if (GET_CODE (x) == MEM
5315 && (XEXP (x, 0) == virtual_outgoing_args_rtx
5316 || (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == PLUS
5317 && XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0) == virtual_outgoing_args_rtx)))
5318 return 1;
5319
5320 switch (TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (exp)))
5321 {
5322 case 'd':
5323 exp_rtl = DECL_RTL (exp);
5324 break;
5325
5326 case 'c':
5327 return 1;
5328
5329 case 'x':
5330 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == TREE_LIST)
5331 return ((TREE_VALUE (exp) == 0
5332 || safe_from_p (x, TREE_VALUE (exp), 0))
5333 && (TREE_CHAIN (exp) == 0
5334 || safe_from_p (x, TREE_CHAIN (exp), 0)));
5335 else if (TREE_CODE (exp) == ERROR_MARK)
5336 return 1; /* An already-visited SAVE_EXPR? */
5337 else
5338 return 0;
5339
5340 case '1':
5341 return safe_from_p (x, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0);
5342
5343 case '2':
5344 case '<':
5345 return (safe_from_p (x, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0)
5346 && safe_from_p (x, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 0));
5347
5348 case 'e':
5349 case 'r':
5350 /* Now do code-specific tests. EXP_RTL is set to any rtx we find in
5351 the expression. If it is set, we conflict iff we are that rtx or
5352 both are in memory. Otherwise, we check all operands of the
5353 expression recursively. */
5354
5355 switch (TREE_CODE (exp))
5356 {
5357 case ADDR_EXPR:
5358 return (staticp (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))
5359 || safe_from_p (x, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0)
5360 || TREE_STATIC (exp));
5361
5362 case INDIRECT_REF:
5363 if (GET_CODE (x) == MEM)
5364 return 0;
5365 break;
5366
5367 case CALL_EXPR:
5368 exp_rtl = CALL_EXPR_RTL (exp);
5369 if (exp_rtl == 0)
5370 {
5371 /* Assume that the call will clobber all hard registers and
5372 all of memory. */
5373 if ((GET_CODE (x) == REG && REGNO (x) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
5374 || GET_CODE (x) == MEM)
5375 return 0;
5376 }
5377
5378 break;
5379
5380 case RTL_EXPR:
5381 /* If a sequence exists, we would have to scan every instruction
5382 in the sequence to see if it was safe. This is probably not
5383 worthwhile. */
5384 if (RTL_EXPR_SEQUENCE (exp))
5385 return 0;
5386
5387 exp_rtl = RTL_EXPR_RTL (exp);
5388 break;
5389
5390 case WITH_CLEANUP_EXPR:
5391 exp_rtl = RTL_EXPR_RTL (exp);
5392 break;
5393
5394 case CLEANUP_POINT_EXPR:
5395 return safe_from_p (x, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0);
5396
5397 case SAVE_EXPR:
5398 exp_rtl = SAVE_EXPR_RTL (exp);
5399 if (exp_rtl)
5400 break;
5401
5402 /* This SAVE_EXPR might appear many times in the top-level
5403 safe_from_p() expression, and if it has a complex
5404 subexpression, examining it multiple times could result
5405 in a combinatorial explosion. E.g. on an Alpha
5406 running at least 200MHz, a Fortran test case compiled with
5407 optimization took about 28 minutes to compile -- even though
5408 it was only a few lines long, and the complicated line causing
5409 so much time to be spent in the earlier version of safe_from_p()
5410 had only 293 or so unique nodes.
5411
5412 So, turn this SAVE_EXPR into an ERROR_MARK for now, but remember
5413 where it is so we can turn it back in the top-level safe_from_p()
5414 when we're done. */
5415
5416 /* For now, don't bother re-sizing the array. */
5417 if (save_expr_count >= save_expr_size)
5418 return 0;
5419 save_expr_rewritten[save_expr_count++] = exp;
5420
5421 nops = tree_code_length[(int) SAVE_EXPR];
5422 for (i = 0; i < nops; i++)
5423 {
5424 tree operand = TREE_OPERAND (exp, i);
5425 if (operand == NULL_TREE)
5426 continue;
5427 TREE_SET_CODE (exp, ERROR_MARK);
5428 if (!safe_from_p (x, operand, 0))
5429 return 0;
5430 TREE_SET_CODE (exp, SAVE_EXPR);
5431 }
5432 TREE_SET_CODE (exp, ERROR_MARK);
5433 return 1;
5434
5435 case BIND_EXPR:
5436 /* The only operand we look at is operand 1. The rest aren't
5437 part of the expression. */
5438 return safe_from_p (x, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 0);
5439
5440 case METHOD_CALL_EXPR:
5441 /* This takes a rtx argument, but shouldn't appear here. */
5442 abort ();
5443
5444 default:
5445 break;
5446 }
5447
5448 /* If we have an rtx, we do not need to scan our operands. */
5449 if (exp_rtl)
5450 break;
5451
5452 nops = tree_code_length[(int) TREE_CODE (exp)];
5453 for (i = 0; i < nops; i++)
5454 if (TREE_OPERAND (exp, i) != 0
5455 && ! safe_from_p (x, TREE_OPERAND (exp, i), 0))
5456 return 0;
5457 }
5458
5459 /* If we have an rtl, find any enclosed object. Then see if we conflict
5460 with it. */
5461 if (exp_rtl)
5462 {
5463 if (GET_CODE (exp_rtl) == SUBREG)
5464 {
5465 exp_rtl = SUBREG_REG (exp_rtl);
5466 if (GET_CODE (exp_rtl) == REG
5467 && REGNO (exp_rtl) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
5468 return 0;
5469 }
5470
5471 /* If the rtl is X, then it is not safe. Otherwise, it is unless both
5472 are memory and EXP is not readonly. */
5473 return ! (rtx_equal_p (x, exp_rtl)
5474 || (GET_CODE (x) == MEM && GET_CODE (exp_rtl) == MEM
5475 && ! TREE_READONLY (exp)));
5476 }
5477
5478 /* If we reach here, it is safe. */
5479 return 1;
5480 }
5481
5482 /* Subroutine of expand_expr: return nonzero iff EXP is an
5483 expression whose type is statically determinable. */
5484
5485 static int
5486 fixed_type_p (exp)
5487 tree exp;
5488 {
5489 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == PARM_DECL
5490 || TREE_CODE (exp) == VAR_DECL
5491 || TREE_CODE (exp) == CALL_EXPR || TREE_CODE (exp) == TARGET_EXPR
5492 || TREE_CODE (exp) == COMPONENT_REF
5493 || TREE_CODE (exp) == ARRAY_REF)
5494 return 1;
5495 return 0;
5496 }
5497
5498 /* Subroutine of expand_expr: return rtx if EXP is a
5499 variable or parameter; else return 0. */
5500
5501 static rtx
5502 var_rtx (exp)
5503 tree exp;
5504 {
5505 STRIP_NOPS (exp);
5506 switch (TREE_CODE (exp))
5507 {
5508 case PARM_DECL:
5509 case VAR_DECL:
5510 return DECL_RTL (exp);
5511 default:
5512 return 0;
5513 }
5514 }
5515
5516 #ifdef MAX_INTEGER_COMPUTATION_MODE
5517 void
5518 check_max_integer_computation_mode (exp)
5519 tree exp;
5520 {
5521 enum tree_code code;
5522 enum machine_mode mode;
5523
5524 /* Strip any NOPs that don't change the mode. */
5525 STRIP_NOPS (exp);
5526 code = TREE_CODE (exp);
5527
5528 /* We must allow conversions of constants to MAX_INTEGER_COMPUTATION_MODE. */
5529 if (code == NOP_EXPR
5530 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)) == INTEGER_CST)
5531 return;
5532
5533 /* First check the type of the overall operation. We need only look at
5534 unary, binary and relational operations. */
5535 if (TREE_CODE_CLASS (code) == '1'
5536 || TREE_CODE_CLASS (code) == '2'
5537 || TREE_CODE_CLASS (code) == '<')
5538 {
5539 mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp));
5540 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
5541 && mode > MAX_INTEGER_COMPUTATION_MODE)
5542 fatal ("unsupported wide integer operation");
5543 }
5544
5545 /* Check operand of a unary op. */
5546 if (TREE_CODE_CLASS (code) == '1')
5547 {
5548 mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)));
5549 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
5550 && mode > MAX_INTEGER_COMPUTATION_MODE)
5551 fatal ("unsupported wide integer operation");
5552 }
5553
5554 /* Check operands of a binary/comparison op. */
5555 if (TREE_CODE_CLASS (code) == '2' || TREE_CODE_CLASS (code) == '<')
5556 {
5557 mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)));
5558 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
5559 && mode > MAX_INTEGER_COMPUTATION_MODE)
5560 fatal ("unsupported wide integer operation");
5561
5562 mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)));
5563 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
5564 && mode > MAX_INTEGER_COMPUTATION_MODE)
5565 fatal ("unsupported wide integer operation");
5566 }
5567 }
5568 #endif
5569
5570 \f
5571 /* Utility function used by expand_expr to see if TYPE, a RECORD_TYPE,
5572 has any readonly fields. If any of the fields have types that
5573 contain readonly fields, return true as well. */
5574
5575 static int
5576 readonly_fields_p (type)
5577 tree type;
5578 {
5579 tree field;
5580
5581 for (field = TYPE_FIELDS (type); field != 0; field = TREE_CHAIN (field))
5582 if (TREE_CODE (field) == FIELD_DECL
5583 && (TREE_READONLY (field)
5584 || (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (field)) == RECORD_TYPE
5585 && readonly_fields_p (TREE_TYPE (field)))))
5586 return 1;
5587
5588 return 0;
5589 }
5590 \f
5591 /* expand_expr: generate code for computing expression EXP.
5592 An rtx for the computed value is returned. The value is never null.
5593 In the case of a void EXP, const0_rtx is returned.
5594
5595 The value may be stored in TARGET if TARGET is nonzero.
5596 TARGET is just a suggestion; callers must assume that
5597 the rtx returned may not be the same as TARGET.
5598
5599 If TARGET is CONST0_RTX, it means that the value will be ignored.
5600
5601 If TMODE is not VOIDmode, it suggests generating the
5602 result in mode TMODE. But this is done only when convenient.
5603 Otherwise, TMODE is ignored and the value generated in its natural mode.
5604 TMODE is just a suggestion; callers must assume that
5605 the rtx returned may not have mode TMODE.
5606
5607 Note that TARGET may have neither TMODE nor MODE. In that case, it
5608 probably will not be used.
5609
5610 If MODIFIER is EXPAND_SUM then when EXP is an addition
5611 we can return an rtx of the form (MULT (REG ...) (CONST_INT ...))
5612 or a nest of (PLUS ...) and (MINUS ...) where the terms are
5613 products as above, or REG or MEM, or constant.
5614 Ordinarily in such cases we would output mul or add instructions
5615 and then return a pseudo reg containing the sum.
5616
5617 EXPAND_INITIALIZER is much like EXPAND_SUM except that
5618 it also marks a label as absolutely required (it can't be dead).
5619 It also makes a ZERO_EXTEND or SIGN_EXTEND instead of emitting extend insns.
5620 This is used for outputting expressions used in initializers.
5621
5622 EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS says that it is okay to return a MEM
5623 with a constant address even if that address is not normally legitimate.
5624 EXPAND_INITIALIZER and EXPAND_SUM also have this effect. */
5625
5626 rtx
5627 expand_expr (exp, target, tmode, modifier)
5628 register tree exp;
5629 rtx target;
5630 enum machine_mode tmode;
5631 enum expand_modifier modifier;
5632 {
5633 register rtx op0, op1, temp;
5634 tree type = TREE_TYPE (exp);
5635 int unsignedp = TREE_UNSIGNED (type);
5636 register enum machine_mode mode;
5637 register enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (exp);
5638 optab this_optab;
5639 rtx subtarget, original_target;
5640 int ignore;
5641 tree context;
5642 /* Used by check-memory-usage to make modifier read only. */
5643 enum expand_modifier ro_modifier;
5644
5645 /* Handle ERROR_MARK before anybody tries to access its type. */
5646 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == ERROR_MARK)
5647 {
5648 op0 = CONST0_RTX (tmode);
5649 if (op0 != 0)
5650 return op0;
5651 return const0_rtx;
5652 }
5653
5654 mode = TYPE_MODE (type);
5655 /* Use subtarget as the target for operand 0 of a binary operation. */
5656 subtarget = (target != 0 && GET_CODE (target) == REG ? target : 0);
5657 original_target = target;
5658 ignore = (target == const0_rtx
5659 || ((code == NON_LVALUE_EXPR || code == NOP_EXPR
5660 || code == CONVERT_EXPR || code == REFERENCE_EXPR
5661 || code == COND_EXPR)
5662 && TREE_CODE (type) == VOID_TYPE));
5663
5664 /* Make a read-only version of the modifier. */
5665 if (modifier == EXPAND_NORMAL || modifier == EXPAND_SUM
5666 || modifier == EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
5667 ro_modifier = modifier;
5668 else
5669 ro_modifier = EXPAND_NORMAL;
5670
5671 /* Don't use hard regs as subtargets, because the combiner
5672 can only handle pseudo regs. */
5673 if (subtarget && REGNO (subtarget) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
5674 subtarget = 0;
5675 /* Avoid subtargets inside loops,
5676 since they hide some invariant expressions. */
5677 if (preserve_subexpressions_p ())
5678 subtarget = 0;
5679
5680 /* If we are going to ignore this result, we need only do something
5681 if there is a side-effect somewhere in the expression. If there
5682 is, short-circuit the most common cases here. Note that we must
5683 not call expand_expr with anything but const0_rtx in case this
5684 is an initial expansion of a size that contains a PLACEHOLDER_EXPR. */
5685
5686 if (ignore)
5687 {
5688 if (! TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (exp))
5689 return const0_rtx;
5690
5691 /* Ensure we reference a volatile object even if value is ignored, but
5692 don't do this if all we are doing is taking its address. */
5693 if (TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (exp)
5694 && TREE_CODE (exp) != FUNCTION_DECL
5695 && mode != VOIDmode && mode != BLKmode
5696 && modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS)
5697 {
5698 temp = expand_expr (exp, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, ro_modifier);
5699 if (GET_CODE (temp) == MEM)
5700 temp = copy_to_reg (temp);
5701 return const0_rtx;
5702 }
5703
5704 if (TREE_CODE_CLASS (code) == '1' || code == COMPONENT_REF
5705 || code == INDIRECT_REF || code == BUFFER_REF)
5706 return expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), const0_rtx,
5707 VOIDmode, ro_modifier);
5708 else if (TREE_CODE_CLASS (code) == '2' || TREE_CODE_CLASS (code) == '<'
5709 || code == ARRAY_REF)
5710 {
5711 expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), const0_rtx, VOIDmode, ro_modifier);
5712 expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), const0_rtx, VOIDmode, ro_modifier);
5713 return const0_rtx;
5714 }
5715 else if ((code == TRUTH_ANDIF_EXPR || code == TRUTH_ORIF_EXPR)
5716 && ! TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)))
5717 /* If the second operand has no side effects, just evaluate
5718 the first. */
5719 return expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), const0_rtx,
5720 VOIDmode, ro_modifier);
5721 else if (code == BIT_FIELD_REF)
5722 {
5723 expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), const0_rtx, VOIDmode, ro_modifier);
5724 expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), const0_rtx, VOIDmode, ro_modifier);
5725 expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2), const0_rtx, VOIDmode, ro_modifier);
5726 return const0_rtx;
5727 }
5728 ;
5729 target = 0;
5730 }
5731
5732 #ifdef MAX_INTEGER_COMPUTATION_MODE
5733 /* Only check stuff here if the mode we want is different from the mode
5734 of the expression; if it's the same, check_max_integer_computiation_mode
5735 will handle it. Do we really need to check this stuff at all? */
5736
5737 if (target
5738 && GET_MODE (target) != mode
5739 && TREE_CODE (exp) != INTEGER_CST
5740 && TREE_CODE (exp) != PARM_DECL
5741 && TREE_CODE (exp) != ARRAY_REF
5742 && TREE_CODE (exp) != COMPONENT_REF
5743 && TREE_CODE (exp) != BIT_FIELD_REF
5744 && TREE_CODE (exp) != INDIRECT_REF
5745 && TREE_CODE (exp) != CALL_EXPR
5746 && TREE_CODE (exp) != VAR_DECL
5747 && TREE_CODE (exp) != RTL_EXPR)
5748 {
5749 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (target);
5750
5751 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
5752 && mode > MAX_INTEGER_COMPUTATION_MODE)
5753 fatal ("unsupported wide integer operation");
5754 }
5755
5756 if (tmode != mode
5757 && TREE_CODE (exp) != INTEGER_CST
5758 && TREE_CODE (exp) != PARM_DECL
5759 && TREE_CODE (exp) != ARRAY_REF
5760 && TREE_CODE (exp) != COMPONENT_REF
5761 && TREE_CODE (exp) != BIT_FIELD_REF
5762 && TREE_CODE (exp) != INDIRECT_REF
5763 && TREE_CODE (exp) != VAR_DECL
5764 && TREE_CODE (exp) != CALL_EXPR
5765 && TREE_CODE (exp) != RTL_EXPR
5766 && GET_MODE_CLASS (tmode) == MODE_INT
5767 && tmode > MAX_INTEGER_COMPUTATION_MODE)
5768 fatal ("unsupported wide integer operation");
5769
5770 check_max_integer_computation_mode (exp);
5771 #endif
5772
5773 /* If will do cse, generate all results into pseudo registers
5774 since 1) that allows cse to find more things
5775 and 2) otherwise cse could produce an insn the machine
5776 cannot support. */
5777
5778 if (! cse_not_expected && mode != BLKmode && target
5779 && (GET_CODE (target) != REG || REGNO (target) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER))
5780 target = subtarget;
5781
5782 switch (code)
5783 {
5784 case LABEL_DECL:
5785 {
5786 tree function = decl_function_context (exp);
5787 /* Handle using a label in a containing function. */
5788 if (function != current_function_decl
5789 && function != inline_function_decl && function != 0)
5790 {
5791 struct function *p = find_function_data (function);
5792 /* Allocate in the memory associated with the function
5793 that the label is in. */
5794 push_obstacks (p->function_obstack,
5795 p->function_maybepermanent_obstack);
5796
5797 p->expr->x_forced_labels
5798 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, label_rtx (exp),
5799 p->expr->x_forced_labels);
5800 pop_obstacks ();
5801 }
5802 else
5803 {
5804 if (modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
5805 forced_labels = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode,
5806 label_rtx (exp),
5807 forced_labels);
5808 }
5809
5810 temp = gen_rtx_MEM (FUNCTION_MODE,
5811 gen_rtx_LABEL_REF (Pmode, label_rtx (exp)));
5812 if (function != current_function_decl
5813 && function != inline_function_decl && function != 0)
5814 LABEL_REF_NONLOCAL_P (XEXP (temp, 0)) = 1;
5815 return temp;
5816 }
5817
5818 case PARM_DECL:
5819 if (DECL_RTL (exp) == 0)
5820 {
5821 error_with_decl (exp, "prior parameter's size depends on `%s'");
5822 return CONST0_RTX (mode);
5823 }
5824
5825 /* ... fall through ... */
5826
5827 case VAR_DECL:
5828 /* If a static var's type was incomplete when the decl was written,
5829 but the type is complete now, lay out the decl now. */
5830 if (DECL_SIZE (exp) == 0 && TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp)) != 0
5831 && (TREE_STATIC (exp) || DECL_EXTERNAL (exp)))
5832 {
5833 push_obstacks_nochange ();
5834 end_temporary_allocation ();
5835 layout_decl (exp, 0);
5836 PUT_MODE (DECL_RTL (exp), DECL_MODE (exp));
5837 pop_obstacks ();
5838 }
5839
5840 /* Although static-storage variables start off initialized, according to
5841 ANSI C, a memcpy could overwrite them with uninitialized values. So
5842 we check them too. This also lets us check for read-only variables
5843 accessed via a non-const declaration, in case it won't be detected
5844 any other way (e.g., in an embedded system or OS kernel without
5845 memory protection).
5846
5847 Aggregates are not checked here; they're handled elsewhere. */
5848 if (current_function && current_function_check_memory_usage
5849 && code == VAR_DECL
5850 && GET_CODE (DECL_RTL (exp)) == MEM
5851 && ! AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
5852 {
5853 enum memory_use_mode memory_usage;
5854 memory_usage = get_memory_usage_from_modifier (modifier);
5855
5856 if (memory_usage != MEMORY_USE_DONT)
5857 emit_library_call (chkr_check_addr_libfunc, 1, VOIDmode, 3,
5858 XEXP (DECL_RTL (exp), 0), Pmode,
5859 GEN_INT (int_size_in_bytes (type)),
5860 TYPE_MODE (sizetype),
5861 GEN_INT (memory_usage),
5862 TYPE_MODE (integer_type_node));
5863 }
5864
5865 /* ... fall through ... */
5866
5867 case FUNCTION_DECL:
5868 case RESULT_DECL:
5869 if (DECL_RTL (exp) == 0)
5870 abort ();
5871
5872 /* Ensure variable marked as used even if it doesn't go through
5873 a parser. If it hasn't be used yet, write out an external
5874 definition. */
5875 if (! TREE_USED (exp))
5876 {
5877 assemble_external (exp);
5878 TREE_USED (exp) = 1;
5879 }
5880
5881 /* Show we haven't gotten RTL for this yet. */
5882 temp = 0;
5883
5884 /* Handle variables inherited from containing functions. */
5885 context = decl_function_context (exp);
5886
5887 /* We treat inline_function_decl as an alias for the current function
5888 because that is the inline function whose vars, types, etc.
5889 are being merged into the current function.
5890 See expand_inline_function. */
5891
5892 if (context != 0 && context != current_function_decl
5893 && context != inline_function_decl
5894 /* If var is static, we don't need a static chain to access it. */
5895 && ! (GET_CODE (DECL_RTL (exp)) == MEM
5896 && CONSTANT_P (XEXP (DECL_RTL (exp), 0))))
5897 {
5898 rtx addr;
5899
5900 /* Mark as non-local and addressable. */
5901 DECL_NONLOCAL (exp) = 1;
5902 if (DECL_NO_STATIC_CHAIN (current_function_decl))
5903 abort ();
5904 mark_addressable (exp);
5905 if (GET_CODE (DECL_RTL (exp)) != MEM)
5906 abort ();
5907 addr = XEXP (DECL_RTL (exp), 0);
5908 if (GET_CODE (addr) == MEM)
5909 addr = gen_rtx_MEM (Pmode,
5910 fix_lexical_addr (XEXP (addr, 0), exp));
5911 else
5912 addr = fix_lexical_addr (addr, exp);
5913 temp = change_address (DECL_RTL (exp), mode, addr);
5914 }
5915
5916 /* This is the case of an array whose size is to be determined
5917 from its initializer, while the initializer is still being parsed.
5918 See expand_decl. */
5919
5920 else if (GET_CODE (DECL_RTL (exp)) == MEM
5921 && GET_CODE (XEXP (DECL_RTL (exp), 0)) == REG)
5922 temp = change_address (DECL_RTL (exp), GET_MODE (DECL_RTL (exp)),
5923 XEXP (DECL_RTL (exp), 0));
5924
5925 /* If DECL_RTL is memory, we are in the normal case and either
5926 the address is not valid or it is not a register and -fforce-addr
5927 is specified, get the address into a register. */
5928
5929 else if (GET_CODE (DECL_RTL (exp)) == MEM
5930 && modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
5931 && modifier != EXPAND_SUM
5932 && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
5933 && (! memory_address_p (DECL_MODE (exp),
5934 XEXP (DECL_RTL (exp), 0))
5935 || (flag_force_addr
5936 && GET_CODE (XEXP (DECL_RTL (exp), 0)) != REG)))
5937 temp = change_address (DECL_RTL (exp), VOIDmode,
5938 copy_rtx (XEXP (DECL_RTL (exp), 0)));
5939
5940 /* If we got something, return it. But first, set the alignment
5941 the address is a register. */
5942 if (temp != 0)
5943 {
5944 if (GET_CODE (temp) == MEM && GET_CODE (XEXP (temp, 0)) == REG)
5945 mark_reg_pointer (XEXP (temp, 0),
5946 DECL_ALIGN (exp) / BITS_PER_UNIT);
5947
5948 return temp;
5949 }
5950
5951 /* If the mode of DECL_RTL does not match that of the decl, it
5952 must be a promoted value. We return a SUBREG of the wanted mode,
5953 but mark it so that we know that it was already extended. */
5954
5955 if (GET_CODE (DECL_RTL (exp)) == REG
5956 && GET_MODE (DECL_RTL (exp)) != mode)
5957 {
5958 /* Get the signedness used for this variable. Ensure we get the
5959 same mode we got when the variable was declared. */
5960 if (GET_MODE (DECL_RTL (exp))
5961 != promote_mode (type, DECL_MODE (exp), &unsignedp, 0))
5962 abort ();
5963
5964 temp = gen_rtx_SUBREG (mode, DECL_RTL (exp), 0);
5965 SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (temp) = 1;
5966 SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (temp) = unsignedp;
5967 return temp;
5968 }
5969
5970 return DECL_RTL (exp);
5971
5972 case INTEGER_CST:
5973 return immed_double_const (TREE_INT_CST_LOW (exp),
5974 TREE_INT_CST_HIGH (exp),
5975 mode);
5976
5977 case CONST_DECL:
5978 return expand_expr (DECL_INITIAL (exp), target, VOIDmode,
5979 EXPAND_MEMORY_USE_BAD);
5980
5981 case REAL_CST:
5982 /* If optimized, generate immediate CONST_DOUBLE
5983 which will be turned into memory by reload if necessary.
5984
5985 We used to force a register so that loop.c could see it. But
5986 this does not allow gen_* patterns to perform optimizations with
5987 the constants. It also produces two insns in cases like "x = 1.0;".
5988 On most machines, floating-point constants are not permitted in
5989 many insns, so we'd end up copying it to a register in any case.
5990
5991 Now, we do the copying in expand_binop, if appropriate. */
5992 return immed_real_const (exp);
5993
5994 case COMPLEX_CST:
5995 case STRING_CST:
5996 if (! TREE_CST_RTL (exp))
5997 output_constant_def (exp);
5998
5999 /* TREE_CST_RTL probably contains a constant address.
6000 On RISC machines where a constant address isn't valid,
6001 make some insns to get that address into a register. */
6002 if (GET_CODE (TREE_CST_RTL (exp)) == MEM
6003 && modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
6004 && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
6005 && modifier != EXPAND_SUM
6006 && (! memory_address_p (mode, XEXP (TREE_CST_RTL (exp), 0))
6007 || (flag_force_addr
6008 && GET_CODE (XEXP (TREE_CST_RTL (exp), 0)) != REG)))
6009 return change_address (TREE_CST_RTL (exp), VOIDmode,
6010 copy_rtx (XEXP (TREE_CST_RTL (exp), 0)));
6011 return TREE_CST_RTL (exp);
6012
6013 case EXPR_WITH_FILE_LOCATION:
6014 {
6015 rtx to_return;
6016 char *saved_input_filename = input_filename;
6017 int saved_lineno = lineno;
6018 input_filename = EXPR_WFL_FILENAME (exp);
6019 lineno = EXPR_WFL_LINENO (exp);
6020 if (EXPR_WFL_EMIT_LINE_NOTE (exp))
6021 emit_line_note (input_filename, lineno);
6022 /* Possibly avoid switching back and force here */
6023 to_return = expand_expr (EXPR_WFL_NODE (exp), target, tmode, modifier);
6024 input_filename = saved_input_filename;
6025 lineno = saved_lineno;
6026 return to_return;
6027 }
6028
6029 case SAVE_EXPR:
6030 context = decl_function_context (exp);
6031
6032 /* If this SAVE_EXPR was at global context, assume we are an
6033 initialization function and move it into our context. */
6034 if (context == 0)
6035 SAVE_EXPR_CONTEXT (exp) = current_function_decl;
6036
6037 /* We treat inline_function_decl as an alias for the current function
6038 because that is the inline function whose vars, types, etc.
6039 are being merged into the current function.
6040 See expand_inline_function. */
6041 if (context == current_function_decl || context == inline_function_decl)
6042 context = 0;
6043
6044 /* If this is non-local, handle it. */
6045 if (context)
6046 {
6047 /* The following call just exists to abort if the context is
6048 not of a containing function. */
6049 find_function_data (context);
6050
6051 temp = SAVE_EXPR_RTL (exp);
6052 if (temp && GET_CODE (temp) == REG)
6053 {
6054 put_var_into_stack (exp);
6055 temp = SAVE_EXPR_RTL (exp);
6056 }
6057 if (temp == 0 || GET_CODE (temp) != MEM)
6058 abort ();
6059 return change_address (temp, mode,
6060 fix_lexical_addr (XEXP (temp, 0), exp));
6061 }
6062 if (SAVE_EXPR_RTL (exp) == 0)
6063 {
6064 if (mode == VOIDmode)
6065 temp = const0_rtx;
6066 else
6067 temp = assign_temp (type, 3, 0, 0);
6068
6069 SAVE_EXPR_RTL (exp) = temp;
6070 if (!optimize && GET_CODE (temp) == REG)
6071 save_expr_regs = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, temp,
6072 save_expr_regs);
6073
6074 /* If the mode of TEMP does not match that of the expression, it
6075 must be a promoted value. We pass store_expr a SUBREG of the
6076 wanted mode but mark it so that we know that it was already
6077 extended. Note that `unsignedp' was modified above in
6078 this case. */
6079
6080 if (GET_CODE (temp) == REG && GET_MODE (temp) != mode)
6081 {
6082 temp = gen_rtx_SUBREG (mode, SAVE_EXPR_RTL (exp), 0);
6083 SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (temp) = 1;
6084 SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (temp) = unsignedp;
6085 }
6086
6087 if (temp == const0_rtx)
6088 expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), const0_rtx, VOIDmode,
6089 EXPAND_MEMORY_USE_BAD);
6090 else
6091 store_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), temp, 0);
6092
6093 TREE_USED (exp) = 1;
6094 }
6095
6096 /* If the mode of SAVE_EXPR_RTL does not match that of the expression, it
6097 must be a promoted value. We return a SUBREG of the wanted mode,
6098 but mark it so that we know that it was already extended. */
6099
6100 if (GET_CODE (SAVE_EXPR_RTL (exp)) == REG
6101 && GET_MODE (SAVE_EXPR_RTL (exp)) != mode)
6102 {
6103 /* Compute the signedness and make the proper SUBREG. */
6104 promote_mode (type, mode, &unsignedp, 0);
6105 temp = gen_rtx_SUBREG (mode, SAVE_EXPR_RTL (exp), 0);
6106 SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (temp) = 1;
6107 SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (temp) = unsignedp;
6108 return temp;
6109 }
6110
6111 return SAVE_EXPR_RTL (exp);
6112
6113 case UNSAVE_EXPR:
6114 {
6115 rtx temp;
6116 temp = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), target, tmode, modifier);
6117 TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0) = unsave_expr_now (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
6118 return temp;
6119 }
6120
6121 case PLACEHOLDER_EXPR:
6122 {
6123 tree placeholder_expr;
6124
6125 /* If there is an object on the head of the placeholder list,
6126 see if some object in it of type TYPE or a pointer to it. For
6127 further information, see tree.def. */
6128 for (placeholder_expr = placeholder_list;
6129 placeholder_expr != 0;
6130 placeholder_expr = TREE_CHAIN (placeholder_expr))
6131 {
6132 tree need_type = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
6133 tree object = 0;
6134 tree old_list = placeholder_list;
6135 tree elt;
6136
6137 /* Find the outermost reference that is of the type we want.
6138 If none, see if any object has a type that is a pointer to
6139 the type we want. */
6140 for (elt = TREE_PURPOSE (placeholder_expr);
6141 elt != 0 && object == 0;
6142 elt
6143 = ((TREE_CODE (elt) == COMPOUND_EXPR
6144 || TREE_CODE (elt) == COND_EXPR)
6145 ? TREE_OPERAND (elt, 1)
6146 : (TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (elt)) == 'r'
6147 || TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (elt)) == '1'
6148 || TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (elt)) == '2'
6149 || TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (elt)) == 'e')
6150 ? TREE_OPERAND (elt, 0) : 0))
6151 if (TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (TREE_TYPE (elt)) == need_type)
6152 object = elt;
6153
6154 for (elt = TREE_PURPOSE (placeholder_expr);
6155 elt != 0 && object == 0;
6156 elt
6157 = ((TREE_CODE (elt) == COMPOUND_EXPR
6158 || TREE_CODE (elt) == COND_EXPR)
6159 ? TREE_OPERAND (elt, 1)
6160 : (TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (elt)) == 'r'
6161 || TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (elt)) == '1'
6162 || TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (elt)) == '2'
6163 || TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (elt)) == 'e')
6164 ? TREE_OPERAND (elt, 0) : 0))
6165 if (POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (elt))
6166 && (TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (elt)))
6167 == need_type))
6168 object = build1 (INDIRECT_REF, need_type, elt);
6169
6170 if (object != 0)
6171 {
6172 /* Expand this object skipping the list entries before
6173 it was found in case it is also a PLACEHOLDER_EXPR.
6174 In that case, we want to translate it using subsequent
6175 entries. */
6176 placeholder_list = TREE_CHAIN (placeholder_expr);
6177 temp = expand_expr (object, original_target, tmode,
6178 ro_modifier);
6179 placeholder_list = old_list;
6180 return temp;
6181 }
6182 }
6183 }
6184
6185 /* We can't find the object or there was a missing WITH_RECORD_EXPR. */
6186 abort ();
6187
6188 case WITH_RECORD_EXPR:
6189 /* Put the object on the placeholder list, expand our first operand,
6190 and pop the list. */
6191 placeholder_list = tree_cons (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), NULL_TREE,
6192 placeholder_list);
6193 target = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), original_target,
6194 tmode, ro_modifier);
6195 placeholder_list = TREE_CHAIN (placeholder_list);
6196 return target;
6197
6198 case GOTO_EXPR:
6199 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)) == LABEL_DECL)
6200 expand_goto (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
6201 else
6202 expand_computed_goto (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
6203 return const0_rtx;
6204
6205 case EXIT_EXPR:
6206 expand_exit_loop_if_false (NULL_PTR,
6207 invert_truthvalue (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)));
6208 return const0_rtx;
6209
6210 case LABELED_BLOCK_EXPR:
6211 if (LABELED_BLOCK_BODY (exp))
6212 expand_expr_stmt (LABELED_BLOCK_BODY (exp));
6213 emit_label (label_rtx (LABELED_BLOCK_LABEL (exp)));
6214 return const0_rtx;
6215
6216 case EXIT_BLOCK_EXPR:
6217 if (EXIT_BLOCK_RETURN (exp))
6218 sorry ("returned value in block_exit_expr");
6219 expand_goto (LABELED_BLOCK_LABEL (EXIT_BLOCK_LABELED_BLOCK (exp)));
6220 return const0_rtx;
6221
6222 case LOOP_EXPR:
6223 push_temp_slots ();
6224 expand_start_loop (1);
6225 expand_expr_stmt (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
6226 expand_end_loop ();
6227 pop_temp_slots ();
6228
6229 return const0_rtx;
6230
6231 case BIND_EXPR:
6232 {
6233 tree vars = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
6234 int vars_need_expansion = 0;
6235
6236 /* Need to open a binding contour here because
6237 if there are any cleanups they must be contained here. */
6238 expand_start_bindings (2);
6239
6240 /* Mark the corresponding BLOCK for output in its proper place. */
6241 if (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2) != 0
6242 && ! TREE_USED (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2)))
6243 insert_block (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2));
6244
6245 /* If VARS have not yet been expanded, expand them now. */
6246 while (vars)
6247 {
6248 if (DECL_RTL (vars) == 0)
6249 {
6250 vars_need_expansion = 1;
6251 expand_decl (vars);
6252 }
6253 expand_decl_init (vars);
6254 vars = TREE_CHAIN (vars);
6255 }
6256
6257 temp = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), target, tmode, ro_modifier);
6258
6259 expand_end_bindings (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0, 0);
6260
6261 return temp;
6262 }
6263
6264 case RTL_EXPR:
6265 if (RTL_EXPR_SEQUENCE (exp))
6266 {
6267 if (RTL_EXPR_SEQUENCE (exp) == const0_rtx)
6268 abort ();
6269 emit_insns (RTL_EXPR_SEQUENCE (exp));
6270 RTL_EXPR_SEQUENCE (exp) = const0_rtx;
6271 }
6272 preserve_rtl_expr_result (RTL_EXPR_RTL (exp));
6273 free_temps_for_rtl_expr (exp);
6274 return RTL_EXPR_RTL (exp);
6275
6276 case CONSTRUCTOR:
6277 /* If we don't need the result, just ensure we evaluate any
6278 subexpressions. */
6279 if (ignore)
6280 {
6281 tree elt;
6282 for (elt = CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp); elt; elt = TREE_CHAIN (elt))
6283 expand_expr (TREE_VALUE (elt), const0_rtx, VOIDmode,
6284 EXPAND_MEMORY_USE_BAD);
6285 return const0_rtx;
6286 }
6287
6288 /* All elts simple constants => refer to a constant in memory. But
6289 if this is a non-BLKmode mode, let it store a field at a time
6290 since that should make a CONST_INT or CONST_DOUBLE when we
6291 fold. Likewise, if we have a target we can use, it is best to
6292 store directly into the target unless the type is large enough
6293 that memcpy will be used. If we are making an initializer and
6294 all operands are constant, put it in memory as well. */
6295 else if ((TREE_STATIC (exp)
6296 && ((mode == BLKmode
6297 && ! (target != 0 && safe_from_p (target, exp, 1)))
6298 || TREE_ADDRESSABLE (exp)
6299 || (TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (type)) == INTEGER_CST
6300 && (!MOVE_BY_PIECES_P
6301 (TREE_INT_CST_LOW (TYPE_SIZE (type))/BITS_PER_UNIT,
6302 TYPE_ALIGN (type) / BITS_PER_UNIT))
6303 && ! mostly_zeros_p (exp))))
6304 || (modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER && TREE_CONSTANT (exp)))
6305 {
6306 rtx constructor = output_constant_def (exp);
6307 if (modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
6308 && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
6309 && modifier != EXPAND_SUM
6310 && (! memory_address_p (GET_MODE (constructor),
6311 XEXP (constructor, 0))
6312 || (flag_force_addr
6313 && GET_CODE (XEXP (constructor, 0)) != REG)))
6314 constructor = change_address (constructor, VOIDmode,
6315 XEXP (constructor, 0));
6316 return constructor;
6317 }
6318
6319 else
6320 {
6321 /* Handle calls that pass values in multiple non-contiguous
6322 locations. The Irix 6 ABI has examples of this. */
6323 if (target == 0 || ! safe_from_p (target, exp, 1)
6324 || GET_CODE (target) == PARALLEL)
6325 {
6326 if (mode != BLKmode && ! TREE_ADDRESSABLE (exp))
6327 target = gen_reg_rtx (tmode != VOIDmode ? tmode : mode);
6328 else
6329 target = assign_temp (type, 0, 1, 1);
6330 }
6331
6332 if (TREE_READONLY (exp))
6333 {
6334 if (GET_CODE (target) == MEM)
6335 target = copy_rtx (target);
6336
6337 RTX_UNCHANGING_P (target) = 1;
6338 }
6339
6340 store_constructor (exp, target, TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (exp)), 0);
6341 return target;
6342 }
6343
6344 case INDIRECT_REF:
6345 {
6346 tree exp1 = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
6347 tree exp2;
6348 tree index;
6349 tree string = string_constant (exp1, &index);
6350 int i;
6351
6352 /* Try to optimize reads from const strings. */
6353 if (string
6354 && TREE_CODE (string) == STRING_CST
6355 && TREE_CODE (index) == INTEGER_CST
6356 && !TREE_INT_CST_HIGH (index)
6357 && (i = TREE_INT_CST_LOW (index)) < TREE_STRING_LENGTH (string)
6358 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
6359 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == 1
6360 && modifier != EXPAND_MEMORY_USE_WO)
6361 return GEN_INT (TREE_STRING_POINTER (string)[i]);
6362
6363 op0 = expand_expr (exp1, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_SUM);
6364 op0 = memory_address (mode, op0);
6365
6366 if (current_function && current_function_check_memory_usage
6367 && ! AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
6368 {
6369 enum memory_use_mode memory_usage;
6370 memory_usage = get_memory_usage_from_modifier (modifier);
6371
6372 if (memory_usage != MEMORY_USE_DONT)
6373 {
6374 in_check_memory_usage = 1;
6375 emit_library_call (chkr_check_addr_libfunc, 1, VOIDmode, 3,
6376 op0, Pmode,
6377 GEN_INT (int_size_in_bytes (type)),
6378 TYPE_MODE (sizetype),
6379 GEN_INT (memory_usage),
6380 TYPE_MODE (integer_type_node));
6381 in_check_memory_usage = 0;
6382 }
6383 }
6384
6385 temp = gen_rtx_MEM (mode, op0);
6386 /* If address was computed by addition,
6387 mark this as an element of an aggregate. */
6388 if (TREE_CODE (exp1) == PLUS_EXPR
6389 || (TREE_CODE (exp1) == SAVE_EXPR
6390 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp1, 0)) == PLUS_EXPR)
6391 || AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (exp))
6392 || (TREE_CODE (exp1) == ADDR_EXPR
6393 && (exp2 = TREE_OPERAND (exp1, 0))
6394 && AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (exp2))))
6395 MEM_SET_IN_STRUCT_P (temp, 1);
6396
6397 MEM_VOLATILE_P (temp) = TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (exp) | flag_volatile;
6398 MEM_ALIAS_SET (temp) = get_alias_set (exp);
6399
6400 /* It is incorrect to set RTX_UNCHANGING_P from TREE_READONLY
6401 here, because, in C and C++, the fact that a location is accessed
6402 through a pointer to const does not mean that the value there can
6403 never change. Languages where it can never change should
6404 also set TREE_STATIC. */
6405 RTX_UNCHANGING_P (temp) = TREE_READONLY (exp) & TREE_STATIC (exp);
6406
6407 /* If we are writing to this object and its type is a record with
6408 readonly fields, we must mark it as readonly so it will
6409 conflict with readonly references to those fields. */
6410 if (modifier == EXPAND_MEMORY_USE_WO
6411 && TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE && readonly_fields_p (type))
6412 RTX_UNCHANGING_P (temp) = 1;
6413
6414 return temp;
6415 }
6416
6417 case ARRAY_REF:
6418 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))) != ARRAY_TYPE)
6419 abort ();
6420
6421 {
6422 tree array = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
6423 tree domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (TREE_TYPE (array));
6424 tree low_bound = domain ? TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain) : integer_zero_node;
6425 tree index = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
6426 tree index_type = TREE_TYPE (index);
6427 HOST_WIDE_INT i;
6428
6429 /* Optimize the special-case of a zero lower bound.
6430
6431 We convert the low_bound to sizetype to avoid some problems
6432 with constant folding. (E.g. suppose the lower bound is 1,
6433 and its mode is QI. Without the conversion, (ARRAY
6434 +(INDEX-(unsigned char)1)) becomes ((ARRAY+(-(unsigned char)1))
6435 +INDEX), which becomes (ARRAY+255+INDEX). Oops!)
6436
6437 But sizetype isn't quite right either (especially if
6438 the lowbound is negative). FIXME */
6439
6440 if (! integer_zerop (low_bound))
6441 index = fold (build (MINUS_EXPR, index_type, index,
6442 convert (sizetype, low_bound)));
6443
6444 /* Fold an expression like: "foo"[2].
6445 This is not done in fold so it won't happen inside &.
6446 Don't fold if this is for wide characters since it's too
6447 difficult to do correctly and this is a very rare case. */
6448
6449 if (TREE_CODE (array) == STRING_CST
6450 && TREE_CODE (index) == INTEGER_CST
6451 && !TREE_INT_CST_HIGH (index)
6452 && (i = TREE_INT_CST_LOW (index)) < TREE_STRING_LENGTH (array)
6453 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
6454 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == 1)
6455 return GEN_INT (TREE_STRING_POINTER (array)[i]);
6456
6457 /* If this is a constant index into a constant array,
6458 just get the value from the array. Handle both the cases when
6459 we have an explicit constructor and when our operand is a variable
6460 that was declared const. */
6461
6462 if (TREE_CODE (array) == CONSTRUCTOR && ! TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (array))
6463 {
6464 if (TREE_CODE (index) == INTEGER_CST
6465 && TREE_INT_CST_HIGH (index) == 0)
6466 {
6467 tree elem = CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
6468
6469 i = TREE_INT_CST_LOW (index);
6470 while (elem && i--)
6471 elem = TREE_CHAIN (elem);
6472 if (elem)
6473 return expand_expr (fold (TREE_VALUE (elem)), target,
6474 tmode, ro_modifier);
6475 }
6476 }
6477
6478 else if (optimize >= 1
6479 && TREE_READONLY (array) && ! TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (array)
6480 && TREE_CODE (array) == VAR_DECL && DECL_INITIAL (array)
6481 && TREE_CODE (DECL_INITIAL (array)) != ERROR_MARK)
6482 {
6483 if (TREE_CODE (index) == INTEGER_CST)
6484 {
6485 tree init = DECL_INITIAL (array);
6486
6487 i = TREE_INT_CST_LOW (index);
6488 if (TREE_CODE (init) == CONSTRUCTOR)
6489 {
6490 tree elem = CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (init);
6491
6492 while (elem
6493 && !tree_int_cst_equal (TREE_PURPOSE (elem), index))
6494 elem = TREE_CHAIN (elem);
6495 if (elem)
6496 return expand_expr (fold (TREE_VALUE (elem)), target,
6497 tmode, ro_modifier);
6498 }
6499 else if (TREE_CODE (init) == STRING_CST
6500 && TREE_INT_CST_HIGH (index) == 0
6501 && (TREE_INT_CST_LOW (index)
6502 < TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init)))
6503 return (GEN_INT
6504 (TREE_STRING_POINTER
6505 (init)[TREE_INT_CST_LOW (index)]));
6506 }
6507 }
6508 }
6509
6510 /* ... fall through ... */
6511
6512 case COMPONENT_REF:
6513 case BIT_FIELD_REF:
6514 /* If the operand is a CONSTRUCTOR, we can just extract the
6515 appropriate field if it is present. Don't do this if we have
6516 already written the data since we want to refer to that copy
6517 and varasm.c assumes that's what we'll do. */
6518 if (code != ARRAY_REF
6519 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)) == CONSTRUCTOR
6520 && TREE_CST_RTL (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)) == 0)
6521 {
6522 tree elt;
6523
6524 for (elt = CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)); elt;
6525 elt = TREE_CHAIN (elt))
6526 if (TREE_PURPOSE (elt) == TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)
6527 /* We can normally use the value of the field in the
6528 CONSTRUCTOR. However, if this is a bitfield in
6529 an integral mode that we can fit in a HOST_WIDE_INT,
6530 we must mask only the number of bits in the bitfield,
6531 since this is done implicitly by the constructor. If
6532 the bitfield does not meet either of those conditions,
6533 we can't do this optimization. */
6534 && (! DECL_BIT_FIELD (TREE_PURPOSE (elt))
6535 || ((GET_MODE_CLASS (DECL_MODE (TREE_PURPOSE (elt)))
6536 == MODE_INT)
6537 && (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (DECL_MODE (TREE_PURPOSE (elt)))
6538 <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT))))
6539 {
6540 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_VALUE (elt), target, tmode, modifier);
6541 if (DECL_BIT_FIELD (TREE_PURPOSE (elt)))
6542 {
6543 int bitsize = DECL_FIELD_SIZE (TREE_PURPOSE (elt));
6544
6545 if (TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_PURPOSE (elt))))
6546 {
6547 op1 = GEN_INT (((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << bitsize) - 1);
6548 op0 = expand_and (op0, op1, target);
6549 }
6550 else
6551 {
6552 enum machine_mode imode
6553 = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_PURPOSE (elt)));
6554 tree count
6555 = build_int_2 (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (imode) - bitsize,
6556 0);
6557
6558 op0 = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, imode, op0, count,
6559 target, 0);
6560 op0 = expand_shift (RSHIFT_EXPR, imode, op0, count,
6561 target, 0);
6562 }
6563 }
6564
6565 return op0;
6566 }
6567 }
6568
6569 {
6570 enum machine_mode mode1;
6571 int bitsize;
6572 int bitpos;
6573 tree offset;
6574 int volatilep = 0;
6575 int alignment;
6576 tree tem = get_inner_reference (exp, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset,
6577 &mode1, &unsignedp, &volatilep,
6578 &alignment);
6579
6580 /* If we got back the original object, something is wrong. Perhaps
6581 we are evaluating an expression too early. In any event, don't
6582 infinitely recurse. */
6583 if (tem == exp)
6584 abort ();
6585
6586 /* If TEM's type is a union of variable size, pass TARGET to the inner
6587 computation, since it will need a temporary and TARGET is known
6588 to have to do. This occurs in unchecked conversion in Ada. */
6589
6590 op0 = expand_expr (tem,
6591 (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (tem)) == UNION_TYPE
6592 && (TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (tem)))
6593 != INTEGER_CST)
6594 ? target : NULL_RTX),
6595 VOIDmode,
6596 (modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER
6597 || modifier == EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS)
6598 ? modifier : EXPAND_NORMAL);
6599
6600 /* If this is a constant, put it into a register if it is a
6601 legitimate constant and OFFSET is 0 and memory if it isn't. */
6602 if (CONSTANT_P (op0))
6603 {
6604 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (tem));
6605 if (mode != BLKmode && LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (op0)
6606 && offset == 0)
6607 op0 = force_reg (mode, op0);
6608 else
6609 op0 = validize_mem (force_const_mem (mode, op0));
6610 }
6611
6612 if (offset != 0)
6613 {
6614 rtx offset_rtx = expand_expr (offset, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
6615
6616 /* If this object is in memory, put it into a register.
6617 This case can't occur in C, but can in Ada if we have
6618 unchecked conversion of an expression from a scalar type to
6619 an array or record type. */
6620 if (GET_CODE (op0) == REG || GET_CODE (op0) == SUBREG
6621 || GET_CODE (op0) == CONCAT || GET_CODE (op0) == ADDRESSOF)
6622 {
6623 rtx memloc = assign_temp (TREE_TYPE (tem), 1, 1, 1);
6624
6625 mark_temp_addr_taken (memloc);
6626 emit_move_insn (memloc, op0);
6627 op0 = memloc;
6628 }
6629
6630 if (GET_CODE (op0) != MEM)
6631 abort ();
6632
6633 if (GET_MODE (offset_rtx) != ptr_mode)
6634 {
6635 #ifdef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
6636 offset_rtx = convert_memory_address (ptr_mode, offset_rtx);
6637 #else
6638 offset_rtx = convert_to_mode (ptr_mode, offset_rtx, 0);
6639 #endif
6640 }
6641
6642 /* A constant address in OP0 can have VOIDmode, we must not try
6643 to call force_reg for that case. Avoid that case. */
6644 if (GET_CODE (op0) == MEM
6645 && GET_MODE (op0) == BLKmode
6646 && GET_MODE (XEXP (op0, 0)) != VOIDmode
6647 && bitsize != 0
6648 && (bitpos % bitsize) == 0
6649 && (bitsize % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode1)) == 0
6650 && (alignment * BITS_PER_UNIT) == GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode1))
6651 {
6652 rtx temp = change_address (op0, mode1,
6653 plus_constant (XEXP (op0, 0),
6654 (bitpos /
6655 BITS_PER_UNIT)));
6656 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (temp, 0)) == REG)
6657 op0 = temp;
6658 else
6659 op0 = change_address (op0, mode1,
6660 force_reg (GET_MODE (XEXP (temp, 0)),
6661 XEXP (temp, 0)));
6662 bitpos = 0;
6663 }
6664
6665
6666 op0 = change_address (op0, VOIDmode,
6667 gen_rtx_PLUS (ptr_mode, XEXP (op0, 0),
6668 force_reg (ptr_mode,
6669 offset_rtx)));
6670 }
6671
6672 /* Don't forget about volatility even if this is a bitfield. */
6673 if (GET_CODE (op0) == MEM && volatilep && ! MEM_VOLATILE_P (op0))
6674 {
6675 op0 = copy_rtx (op0);
6676 MEM_VOLATILE_P (op0) = 1;
6677 }
6678
6679 /* Check the access. */
6680 if (current_function_check_memory_usage && GET_CODE (op0) == MEM)
6681 {
6682 enum memory_use_mode memory_usage;
6683 memory_usage = get_memory_usage_from_modifier (modifier);
6684
6685 if (memory_usage != MEMORY_USE_DONT)
6686 {
6687 rtx to;
6688 int size;
6689
6690 to = plus_constant (XEXP (op0, 0), (bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT));
6691 size = (bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT) + bitsize + BITS_PER_UNIT - 1;
6692
6693 /* Check the access right of the pointer. */
6694 if (size > BITS_PER_UNIT)
6695 emit_library_call (chkr_check_addr_libfunc, 1, VOIDmode, 3,
6696 to, Pmode,
6697 GEN_INT (size / BITS_PER_UNIT),
6698 TYPE_MODE (sizetype),
6699 GEN_INT (memory_usage),
6700 TYPE_MODE (integer_type_node));
6701 }
6702 }
6703
6704 /* In cases where an aligned union has an unaligned object
6705 as a field, we might be extracting a BLKmode value from
6706 an integer-mode (e.g., SImode) object. Handle this case
6707 by doing the extract into an object as wide as the field
6708 (which we know to be the width of a basic mode), then
6709 storing into memory, and changing the mode to BLKmode.
6710 If we ultimately want the address (EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS or
6711 EXPAND_INITIALIZER), then we must not copy to a temporary. */
6712 if (mode1 == VOIDmode
6713 || GET_CODE (op0) == REG || GET_CODE (op0) == SUBREG
6714 || (modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
6715 && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
6716 && ((mode1 != BLKmode && ! direct_load[(int) mode1]
6717 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_COMPLEX_INT
6718 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_COMPLEX_FLOAT)
6719 /* If the field isn't aligned enough to fetch as a memref,
6720 fetch it as a bit field. */
6721 || (mode1 != BLKmode && SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS
6722 && ((TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (tem))
6723 < (unsigned int) GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
6724 || (bitpos % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode) != 0)))))
6725 || (modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
6726 && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
6727 && mode == BLKmode
6728 && SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS
6729 && (TYPE_ALIGN (type) > alignment * BITS_PER_UNIT
6730 || bitpos % TYPE_ALIGN (type) != 0)))
6731 {
6732 enum machine_mode ext_mode = mode;
6733
6734 if (ext_mode == BLKmode
6735 && ! (target != 0 && GET_CODE (op0) == MEM
6736 && GET_CODE (target) == MEM
6737 && bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT == 0))
6738 ext_mode = mode_for_size (bitsize, MODE_INT, 1);
6739
6740 if (ext_mode == BLKmode)
6741 {
6742 /* In this case, BITPOS must start at a byte boundary and
6743 TARGET, if specified, must be a MEM. */
6744 if (GET_CODE (op0) != MEM
6745 || (target != 0 && GET_CODE (target) != MEM)
6746 || bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0)
6747 abort ();
6748
6749 op0 = change_address (op0, VOIDmode,
6750 plus_constant (XEXP (op0, 0),
6751 bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT));
6752 if (target == 0)
6753 target = assign_temp (type, 0, 1, 1);
6754
6755 emit_block_move (target, op0,
6756 GEN_INT ((bitsize + BITS_PER_UNIT - 1)
6757 / BITS_PER_UNIT),
6758 1);
6759
6760 return target;
6761 }
6762
6763 op0 = validize_mem (op0);
6764
6765 if (GET_CODE (op0) == MEM && GET_CODE (XEXP (op0, 0)) == REG)
6766 mark_reg_pointer (XEXP (op0, 0), alignment);
6767
6768 op0 = extract_bit_field (op0, bitsize, bitpos,
6769 unsignedp, target, ext_mode, ext_mode,
6770 alignment,
6771 int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (tem)));
6772
6773 /* If the result is a record type and BITSIZE is narrower than
6774 the mode of OP0, an integral mode, and this is a big endian
6775 machine, we must put the field into the high-order bits. */
6776 if (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE && BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
6777 && GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (op0)) == MODE_INT
6778 && bitsize < GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (op0)))
6779 op0 = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, GET_MODE (op0), op0,
6780 size_int (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (op0))
6781 - bitsize),
6782 op0, 1);
6783
6784 if (mode == BLKmode)
6785 {
6786 rtx new = assign_stack_temp (ext_mode,
6787 bitsize / BITS_PER_UNIT, 0);
6788
6789 emit_move_insn (new, op0);
6790 op0 = copy_rtx (new);
6791 PUT_MODE (op0, BLKmode);
6792 MEM_SET_IN_STRUCT_P (op0, 1);
6793 }
6794
6795 return op0;
6796 }
6797
6798 /* If the result is BLKmode, use that to access the object
6799 now as well. */
6800 if (mode == BLKmode)
6801 mode1 = BLKmode;
6802
6803 /* Get a reference to just this component. */
6804 if (modifier == EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
6805 || modifier == EXPAND_SUM || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
6806 op0 = gen_rtx_MEM (mode1, plus_constant (XEXP (op0, 0),
6807 (bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT)));
6808 else
6809 op0 = change_address (op0, mode1,
6810 plus_constant (XEXP (op0, 0),
6811 (bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT)));
6812
6813 if (GET_CODE (op0) == MEM)
6814 MEM_ALIAS_SET (op0) = get_alias_set (exp);
6815
6816 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (op0, 0)) == REG)
6817 mark_reg_pointer (XEXP (op0, 0), alignment);
6818
6819 MEM_SET_IN_STRUCT_P (op0, 1);
6820 MEM_VOLATILE_P (op0) |= volatilep;
6821 if (mode == mode1 || mode1 == BLKmode || mode1 == tmode
6822 || modifier == EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
6823 || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
6824 return op0;
6825 else if (target == 0)
6826 target = gen_reg_rtx (tmode != VOIDmode ? tmode : mode);
6827
6828 convert_move (target, op0, unsignedp);
6829 return target;
6830 }
6831
6832 /* Intended for a reference to a buffer of a file-object in Pascal.
6833 But it's not certain that a special tree code will really be
6834 necessary for these. INDIRECT_REF might work for them. */
6835 case BUFFER_REF:
6836 abort ();
6837
6838 case IN_EXPR:
6839 {
6840 /* Pascal set IN expression.
6841
6842 Algorithm:
6843 rlo = set_low - (set_low%bits_per_word);
6844 the_word = set [ (index - rlo)/bits_per_word ];
6845 bit_index = index % bits_per_word;
6846 bitmask = 1 << bit_index;
6847 return !!(the_word & bitmask); */
6848
6849 tree set = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
6850 tree index = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
6851 int iunsignedp = TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (index));
6852 tree set_type = TREE_TYPE (set);
6853 tree set_low_bound = TYPE_MIN_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (set_type));
6854 tree set_high_bound = TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (set_type));
6855 rtx index_val = expand_expr (index, 0, VOIDmode, 0);
6856 rtx lo_r = expand_expr (set_low_bound, 0, VOIDmode, 0);
6857 rtx hi_r = expand_expr (set_high_bound, 0, VOIDmode, 0);
6858 rtx setval = expand_expr (set, 0, VOIDmode, 0);
6859 rtx setaddr = XEXP (setval, 0);
6860 enum machine_mode index_mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (index));
6861 rtx rlow;
6862 rtx diff, quo, rem, addr, bit, result;
6863
6864 preexpand_calls (exp);
6865
6866 /* If domain is empty, answer is no. Likewise if index is constant
6867 and out of bounds. */
6868 if (((TREE_CODE (set_high_bound) == INTEGER_CST
6869 && TREE_CODE (set_low_bound) == INTEGER_CST
6870 && tree_int_cst_lt (set_high_bound, set_low_bound))
6871 || (TREE_CODE (index) == INTEGER_CST
6872 && TREE_CODE (set_low_bound) == INTEGER_CST
6873 && tree_int_cst_lt (index, set_low_bound))
6874 || (TREE_CODE (set_high_bound) == INTEGER_CST
6875 && TREE_CODE (index) == INTEGER_CST
6876 && tree_int_cst_lt (set_high_bound, index))))
6877 return const0_rtx;
6878
6879 if (target == 0)
6880 target = gen_reg_rtx (tmode != VOIDmode ? tmode : mode);
6881
6882 /* If we get here, we have to generate the code for both cases
6883 (in range and out of range). */
6884
6885 op0 = gen_label_rtx ();
6886 op1 = gen_label_rtx ();
6887
6888 if (! (GET_CODE (index_val) == CONST_INT
6889 && GET_CODE (lo_r) == CONST_INT))
6890 {
6891 emit_cmp_and_jump_insns (index_val, lo_r, LT, NULL_RTX,
6892 GET_MODE (index_val), iunsignedp, 0, op1);
6893 }
6894
6895 if (! (GET_CODE (index_val) == CONST_INT
6896 && GET_CODE (hi_r) == CONST_INT))
6897 {
6898 emit_cmp_and_jump_insns (index_val, hi_r, GT, NULL_RTX,
6899 GET_MODE (index_val), iunsignedp, 0, op1);
6900 }
6901
6902 /* Calculate the element number of bit zero in the first word
6903 of the set. */
6904 if (GET_CODE (lo_r) == CONST_INT)
6905 rlow = GEN_INT (INTVAL (lo_r)
6906 & ~ ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << BITS_PER_UNIT));
6907 else
6908 rlow = expand_binop (index_mode, and_optab, lo_r,
6909 GEN_INT (~((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << BITS_PER_UNIT)),
6910 NULL_RTX, iunsignedp, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
6911
6912 diff = expand_binop (index_mode, sub_optab, index_val, rlow,
6913 NULL_RTX, iunsignedp, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
6914
6915 quo = expand_divmod (0, TRUNC_DIV_EXPR, index_mode, diff,
6916 GEN_INT (BITS_PER_UNIT), NULL_RTX, iunsignedp);
6917 rem = expand_divmod (1, TRUNC_MOD_EXPR, index_mode, index_val,
6918 GEN_INT (BITS_PER_UNIT), NULL_RTX, iunsignedp);
6919
6920 addr = memory_address (byte_mode,
6921 expand_binop (index_mode, add_optab, diff,
6922 setaddr, NULL_RTX, iunsignedp,
6923 OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN));
6924
6925 /* Extract the bit we want to examine */
6926 bit = expand_shift (RSHIFT_EXPR, byte_mode,
6927 gen_rtx_MEM (byte_mode, addr),
6928 make_tree (TREE_TYPE (index), rem),
6929 NULL_RTX, 1);
6930 result = expand_binop (byte_mode, and_optab, bit, const1_rtx,
6931 GET_MODE (target) == byte_mode ? target : 0,
6932 1, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
6933
6934 if (result != target)
6935 convert_move (target, result, 1);
6936
6937 /* Output the code to handle the out-of-range case. */
6938 emit_jump (op0);
6939 emit_label (op1);
6940 emit_move_insn (target, const0_rtx);
6941 emit_label (op0);
6942 return target;
6943 }
6944
6945 case WITH_CLEANUP_EXPR:
6946 if (RTL_EXPR_RTL (exp) == 0)
6947 {
6948 RTL_EXPR_RTL (exp)
6949 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), target, tmode, ro_modifier);
6950 expand_decl_cleanup (NULL_TREE, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2));
6951
6952 /* That's it for this cleanup. */
6953 TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2) = 0;
6954 }
6955 return RTL_EXPR_RTL (exp);
6956
6957 case CLEANUP_POINT_EXPR:
6958 {
6959 /* Start a new binding layer that will keep track of all cleanup
6960 actions to be performed. */
6961 expand_start_bindings (2);
6962
6963 target_temp_slot_level = temp_slot_level;
6964
6965 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), target, tmode, ro_modifier);
6966 /* If we're going to use this value, load it up now. */
6967 if (! ignore)
6968 op0 = force_not_mem (op0);
6969 preserve_temp_slots (op0);
6970 expand_end_bindings (NULL_TREE, 0, 0);
6971 }
6972 return op0;
6973
6974 case CALL_EXPR:
6975 /* Check for a built-in function. */
6976 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)) == ADDR_EXPR
6977 && (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0))
6978 == FUNCTION_DECL)
6979 && DECL_BUILT_IN (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0)))
6980 return expand_builtin (exp, target, subtarget, tmode, ignore);
6981
6982 /* If this call was expanded already by preexpand_calls,
6983 just return the result we got. */
6984 if (CALL_EXPR_RTL (exp) != 0)
6985 return CALL_EXPR_RTL (exp);
6986
6987 return expand_call (exp, target, ignore);
6988
6989 case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
6990 case NOP_EXPR:
6991 case CONVERT_EXPR:
6992 case REFERENCE_EXPR:
6993 if (TREE_CODE (type) == UNION_TYPE)
6994 {
6995 tree valtype = TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
6996
6997 /* If both input and output are BLKmode, this conversion
6998 isn't actually doing anything unless we need to make the
6999 alignment stricter. */
7000 if (mode == BLKmode && TYPE_MODE (valtype) == BLKmode
7001 && (TYPE_ALIGN (type) <= TYPE_ALIGN (valtype)
7002 || TYPE_ALIGN (type) >= BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT))
7003 return expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), target, tmode,
7004 modifier);
7005
7006 if (target == 0)
7007 {
7008 if (mode != BLKmode)
7009 target = gen_reg_rtx (tmode != VOIDmode ? tmode : mode);
7010 else
7011 target = assign_temp (type, 0, 1, 1);
7012 }
7013
7014 if (GET_CODE (target) == MEM)
7015 /* Store data into beginning of memory target. */
7016 store_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0),
7017 change_address (target, TYPE_MODE (valtype), 0), 0);
7018
7019 else if (GET_CODE (target) == REG)
7020 /* Store this field into a union of the proper type. */
7021 store_field (target,
7022 MIN ((int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE
7023 (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)))
7024 * BITS_PER_UNIT),
7025 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode)),
7026 0, TYPE_MODE (valtype), TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0),
7027 VOIDmode, 0, 1, int_size_in_bytes (type), 0);
7028 else
7029 abort ();
7030
7031 /* Return the entire union. */
7032 return target;
7033 }
7034
7035 if (mode == TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))))
7036 {
7037 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), target, VOIDmode,
7038 ro_modifier);
7039
7040 /* If the signedness of the conversion differs and OP0 is
7041 a promoted SUBREG, clear that indication since we now
7042 have to do the proper extension. */
7043 if (TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))) != unsignedp
7044 && GET_CODE (op0) == SUBREG)
7045 SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (op0) = 0;
7046
7047 return op0;
7048 }
7049
7050 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), NULL_RTX, mode, 0);
7051 if (GET_MODE (op0) == mode)
7052 return op0;
7053
7054 /* If OP0 is a constant, just convert it into the proper mode. */
7055 if (CONSTANT_P (op0))
7056 return
7057 convert_modes (mode, TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))),
7058 op0, TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))));
7059
7060 if (modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
7061 return gen_rtx_fmt_e (unsignedp ? ZERO_EXTEND : SIGN_EXTEND, mode, op0);
7062
7063 if (target == 0)
7064 return
7065 convert_to_mode (mode, op0,
7066 TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))));
7067 else
7068 convert_move (target, op0,
7069 TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))));
7070 return target;
7071
7072 case PLUS_EXPR:
7073 /* We come here from MINUS_EXPR when the second operand is a
7074 constant. */
7075 plus_expr:
7076 this_optab = add_optab;
7077
7078 /* If we are adding a constant, an RTL_EXPR that is sp, fp, or ap, and
7079 something else, make sure we add the register to the constant and
7080 then to the other thing. This case can occur during strength
7081 reduction and doing it this way will produce better code if the
7082 frame pointer or argument pointer is eliminated.
7083
7084 fold-const.c will ensure that the constant is always in the inner
7085 PLUS_EXPR, so the only case we need to do anything about is if
7086 sp, ap, or fp is our second argument, in which case we must swap
7087 the innermost first argument and our second argument. */
7088
7089 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)) == PLUS_EXPR
7090 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 1)) == INTEGER_CST
7091 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)) == RTL_EXPR
7092 && (RTL_EXPR_RTL (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)) == frame_pointer_rtx
7093 || RTL_EXPR_RTL (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)) == stack_pointer_rtx
7094 || RTL_EXPR_RTL (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)) == arg_pointer_rtx))
7095 {
7096 tree t = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
7097
7098 TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1) = TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0);
7099 TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0) = t;
7100 }
7101
7102 /* If the result is to be ptr_mode and we are adding an integer to
7103 something, we might be forming a constant. So try to use
7104 plus_constant. If it produces a sum and we can't accept it,
7105 use force_operand. This allows P = &ARR[const] to generate
7106 efficient code on machines where a SYMBOL_REF is not a valid
7107 address.
7108
7109 If this is an EXPAND_SUM call, always return the sum. */
7110 if (modifier == EXPAND_SUM || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER
7111 || mode == ptr_mode)
7112 {
7113 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)) == INTEGER_CST
7114 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
7115 && TREE_CONSTANT (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)))
7116 {
7117 rtx constant_part;
7118
7119 op1 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), subtarget, VOIDmode,
7120 EXPAND_SUM);
7121 /* Use immed_double_const to ensure that the constant is
7122 truncated according to the mode of OP1, then sign extended
7123 to a HOST_WIDE_INT. Using the constant directly can result
7124 in non-canonical RTL in a 64x32 cross compile. */
7125 constant_part
7126 = immed_double_const (TREE_INT_CST_LOW (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)),
7127 (HOST_WIDE_INT) 0,
7128 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1))));
7129 op1 = plus_constant (op1, INTVAL (constant_part));
7130 if (modifier != EXPAND_SUM && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
7131 op1 = force_operand (op1, target);
7132 return op1;
7133 }
7134
7135 else if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)) == INTEGER_CST
7136 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_INT
7137 && TREE_CONSTANT (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)))
7138 {
7139 rtx constant_part;
7140
7141 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), subtarget, VOIDmode,
7142 EXPAND_SUM);
7143 if (! CONSTANT_P (op0))
7144 {
7145 op1 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), NULL_RTX,
7146 VOIDmode, modifier);
7147 /* Don't go to both_summands if modifier
7148 says it's not right to return a PLUS. */
7149 if (modifier != EXPAND_SUM && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
7150 goto binop2;
7151 goto both_summands;
7152 }
7153 /* Use immed_double_const to ensure that the constant is
7154 truncated according to the mode of OP1, then sign extended
7155 to a HOST_WIDE_INT. Using the constant directly can result
7156 in non-canonical RTL in a 64x32 cross compile. */
7157 constant_part
7158 = immed_double_const (TREE_INT_CST_LOW (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)),
7159 (HOST_WIDE_INT) 0,
7160 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))));
7161 op0 = plus_constant (op0, INTVAL (constant_part));
7162 if (modifier != EXPAND_SUM && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
7163 op0 = force_operand (op0, target);
7164 return op0;
7165 }
7166 }
7167
7168 /* No sense saving up arithmetic to be done
7169 if it's all in the wrong mode to form part of an address.
7170 And force_operand won't know whether to sign-extend or
7171 zero-extend. */
7172 if ((modifier != EXPAND_SUM && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
7173 || mode != ptr_mode)
7174 goto binop;
7175
7176 preexpand_calls (exp);
7177 if (! safe_from_p (subtarget, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 1))
7178 subtarget = 0;
7179
7180 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), subtarget, VOIDmode, ro_modifier);
7181 op1 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, ro_modifier);
7182
7183 both_summands:
7184 /* Make sure any term that's a sum with a constant comes last. */
7185 if (GET_CODE (op0) == PLUS
7186 && CONSTANT_P (XEXP (op0, 1)))
7187 {
7188 temp = op0;
7189 op0 = op1;
7190 op1 = temp;
7191 }
7192 /* If adding to a sum including a constant,
7193 associate it to put the constant outside. */
7194 if (GET_CODE (op1) == PLUS
7195 && CONSTANT_P (XEXP (op1, 1)))
7196 {
7197 rtx constant_term = const0_rtx;
7198
7199 temp = simplify_binary_operation (PLUS, mode, XEXP (op1, 0), op0);
7200 if (temp != 0)
7201 op0 = temp;
7202 /* Ensure that MULT comes first if there is one. */
7203 else if (GET_CODE (op0) == MULT)
7204 op0 = gen_rtx_PLUS (mode, op0, XEXP (op1, 0));
7205 else
7206 op0 = gen_rtx_PLUS (mode, XEXP (op1, 0), op0);
7207
7208 /* Let's also eliminate constants from op0 if possible. */
7209 op0 = eliminate_constant_term (op0, &constant_term);
7210
7211 /* CONSTANT_TERM and XEXP (op1, 1) are known to be constant, so
7212 their sum should be a constant. Form it into OP1, since the
7213 result we want will then be OP0 + OP1. */
7214
7215 temp = simplify_binary_operation (PLUS, mode, constant_term,
7216 XEXP (op1, 1));
7217 if (temp != 0)
7218 op1 = temp;
7219 else
7220 op1 = gen_rtx_PLUS (mode, constant_term, XEXP (op1, 1));
7221 }
7222
7223 /* Put a constant term last and put a multiplication first. */
7224 if (CONSTANT_P (op0) || GET_CODE (op1) == MULT)
7225 temp = op1, op1 = op0, op0 = temp;
7226
7227 temp = simplify_binary_operation (PLUS, mode, op0, op1);
7228 return temp ? temp : gen_rtx_PLUS (mode, op0, op1);
7229
7230 case MINUS_EXPR:
7231 /* For initializers, we are allowed to return a MINUS of two
7232 symbolic constants. Here we handle all cases when both operands
7233 are constant. */
7234 /* Handle difference of two symbolic constants,
7235 for the sake of an initializer. */
7236 if ((modifier == EXPAND_SUM || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
7237 && really_constant_p (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))
7238 && really_constant_p (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)))
7239 {
7240 rtx op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), NULL_RTX,
7241 VOIDmode, ro_modifier);
7242 rtx op1 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), NULL_RTX,
7243 VOIDmode, ro_modifier);
7244
7245 /* If the last operand is a CONST_INT, use plus_constant of
7246 the negated constant. Else make the MINUS. */
7247 if (GET_CODE (op1) == CONST_INT)
7248 return plus_constant (op0, - INTVAL (op1));
7249 else
7250 return gen_rtx_MINUS (mode, op0, op1);
7251 }
7252 /* Convert A - const to A + (-const). */
7253 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)) == INTEGER_CST)
7254 {
7255 tree negated = fold (build1 (NEGATE_EXPR, type,
7256 TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)));
7257
7258 if (TREE_UNSIGNED (type) || TREE_OVERFLOW (negated))
7259 /* If we can't negate the constant in TYPE, leave it alone and
7260 expand_binop will negate it for us. We used to try to do it
7261 here in the signed version of TYPE, but that doesn't work
7262 on POINTER_TYPEs. */;
7263 else
7264 {
7265 exp = build (PLUS_EXPR, type, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), negated);
7266 goto plus_expr;
7267 }
7268 }
7269 this_optab = sub_optab;
7270 goto binop;
7271
7272 case MULT_EXPR:
7273 preexpand_calls (exp);
7274 /* If first operand is constant, swap them.
7275 Thus the following special case checks need only
7276 check the second operand. */
7277 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)) == INTEGER_CST)
7278 {
7279 register tree t1 = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
7280 TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0) = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
7281 TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1) = t1;
7282 }
7283
7284 /* Attempt to return something suitable for generating an
7285 indexed address, for machines that support that. */
7286
7287 if (modifier == EXPAND_SUM && mode == ptr_mode
7288 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)) == INTEGER_CST
7289 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
7290 {
7291 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), subtarget, VOIDmode,
7292 EXPAND_SUM);
7293
7294 /* Apply distributive law if OP0 is x+c. */
7295 if (GET_CODE (op0) == PLUS
7296 && GET_CODE (XEXP (op0, 1)) == CONST_INT)
7297 return
7298 gen_rtx_PLUS
7299 (mode,
7300 gen_rtx_MULT
7301 (mode, XEXP (op0, 0),
7302 GEN_INT (TREE_INT_CST_LOW (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)))),
7303 GEN_INT (TREE_INT_CST_LOW (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1))
7304 * INTVAL (XEXP (op0, 1))));
7305
7306 if (GET_CODE (op0) != REG)
7307 op0 = force_operand (op0, NULL_RTX);
7308 if (GET_CODE (op0) != REG)
7309 op0 = copy_to_mode_reg (mode, op0);
7310
7311 return
7312 gen_rtx_MULT (mode, op0,
7313 GEN_INT (TREE_INT_CST_LOW (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1))));
7314 }
7315
7316 if (! safe_from_p (subtarget, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 1))
7317 subtarget = 0;
7318
7319 /* Check for multiplying things that have been extended
7320 from a narrower type. If this machine supports multiplying
7321 in that narrower type with a result in the desired type,
7322 do it that way, and avoid the explicit type-conversion. */
7323 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)) == NOP_EXPR
7324 && TREE_CODE (type) == INTEGER_TYPE
7325 && (TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0)))
7326 < TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))))
7327 && ((TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)) == INTEGER_CST
7328 && int_fits_type_p (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1),
7329 TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0)))
7330 /* Don't use a widening multiply if a shift will do. */
7331 && ((GET_MODE_BITSIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1))))
7332 > HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
7333 || exact_log2 (TREE_INT_CST_LOW (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1))) < 0))
7334 ||
7335 (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)) == NOP_EXPR
7336 && (TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 0)))
7337 ==
7338 TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0))))
7339 /* If both operands are extended, they must either both
7340 be zero-extended or both be sign-extended. */
7341 && (TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 0)))
7342 ==
7343 TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0)))))))
7344 {
7345 enum machine_mode innermode
7346 = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0)));
7347 optab other_optab = (TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0)))
7348 ? smul_widen_optab : umul_widen_optab);
7349 this_optab = (TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0)))
7350 ? umul_widen_optab : smul_widen_optab);
7351 if (mode == GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (innermode))
7352 {
7353 if (this_optab->handlers[(int) mode].insn_code != CODE_FOR_nothing)
7354 {
7355 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0),
7356 NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
7357 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)) == INTEGER_CST)
7358 op1 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), NULL_RTX,
7359 VOIDmode, 0);
7360 else
7361 op1 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 0),
7362 NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
7363 goto binop2;
7364 }
7365 else if (other_optab->handlers[(int) mode].insn_code != CODE_FOR_nothing
7366 && innermode == word_mode)
7367 {
7368 rtx htem;
7369 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0),
7370 NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
7371 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)) == INTEGER_CST)
7372 op1 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), NULL_RTX,
7373 VOIDmode, 0);
7374 else
7375 op1 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 0),
7376 NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
7377 temp = expand_binop (mode, other_optab, op0, op1, target,
7378 unsignedp, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
7379 htem = expand_mult_highpart_adjust (innermode,
7380 gen_highpart (innermode, temp),
7381 op0, op1,
7382 gen_highpart (innermode, temp),
7383 unsignedp);
7384 emit_move_insn (gen_highpart (innermode, temp), htem);
7385 return temp;
7386 }
7387 }
7388 }
7389 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), subtarget, VOIDmode, 0);
7390 op1 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
7391 return expand_mult (mode, op0, op1, target, unsignedp);
7392
7393 case TRUNC_DIV_EXPR:
7394 case FLOOR_DIV_EXPR:
7395 case CEIL_DIV_EXPR:
7396 case ROUND_DIV_EXPR:
7397 case EXACT_DIV_EXPR:
7398 preexpand_calls (exp);
7399 if (! safe_from_p (subtarget, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 1))
7400 subtarget = 0;
7401 /* Possible optimization: compute the dividend with EXPAND_SUM
7402 then if the divisor is constant can optimize the case
7403 where some terms of the dividend have coeffs divisible by it. */
7404 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), subtarget, VOIDmode, 0);
7405 op1 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
7406 return expand_divmod (0, code, mode, op0, op1, target, unsignedp);
7407
7408 case RDIV_EXPR:
7409 this_optab = flodiv_optab;
7410 goto binop;
7411
7412 case TRUNC_MOD_EXPR:
7413 case FLOOR_MOD_EXPR:
7414 case CEIL_MOD_EXPR:
7415 case ROUND_MOD_EXPR:
7416 preexpand_calls (exp);
7417 if (! safe_from_p (subtarget, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 1))
7418 subtarget = 0;
7419 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), subtarget, VOIDmode, 0);
7420 op1 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
7421 return expand_divmod (1, code, mode, op0, op1, target, unsignedp);
7422
7423 case FIX_ROUND_EXPR:
7424 case FIX_FLOOR_EXPR:
7425 case FIX_CEIL_EXPR:
7426 abort (); /* Not used for C. */
7427
7428 case FIX_TRUNC_EXPR:
7429 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
7430 if (target == 0)
7431 target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
7432 expand_fix (target, op0, unsignedp);
7433 return target;
7434
7435 case FLOAT_EXPR:
7436 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
7437 if (target == 0)
7438 target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
7439 /* expand_float can't figure out what to do if FROM has VOIDmode.
7440 So give it the correct mode. With -O, cse will optimize this. */
7441 if (GET_MODE (op0) == VOIDmode)
7442 op0 = copy_to_mode_reg (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))),
7443 op0);
7444 expand_float (target, op0,
7445 TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))));
7446 return target;
7447
7448 case NEGATE_EXPR:
7449 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), subtarget, VOIDmode, 0);
7450 temp = expand_unop (mode, neg_optab, op0, target, 0);
7451 if (temp == 0)
7452 abort ();
7453 return temp;
7454
7455 case ABS_EXPR:
7456 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), subtarget, VOIDmode, 0);
7457
7458 /* Handle complex values specially. */
7459 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_COMPLEX_INT
7460 || GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_COMPLEX_FLOAT)
7461 return expand_complex_abs (mode, op0, target, unsignedp);
7462
7463 /* Unsigned abs is simply the operand. Testing here means we don't
7464 risk generating incorrect code below. */
7465 if (TREE_UNSIGNED (type))
7466 return op0;
7467
7468 return expand_abs (mode, op0, target,
7469 safe_from_p (target, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 1));
7470
7471 case MAX_EXPR:
7472 case MIN_EXPR:
7473 target = original_target;
7474 if (target == 0 || ! safe_from_p (target, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 1)
7475 || (GET_CODE (target) == MEM && MEM_VOLATILE_P (target))
7476 || GET_MODE (target) != mode
7477 || (GET_CODE (target) == REG
7478 && REGNO (target) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER))
7479 target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
7480 op1 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
7481 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), target, VOIDmode, 0);
7482
7483 /* First try to do it with a special MIN or MAX instruction.
7484 If that does not win, use a conditional jump to select the proper
7485 value. */
7486 this_optab = (TREE_UNSIGNED (type)
7487 ? (code == MIN_EXPR ? umin_optab : umax_optab)
7488 : (code == MIN_EXPR ? smin_optab : smax_optab));
7489
7490 temp = expand_binop (mode, this_optab, op0, op1, target, unsignedp,
7491 OPTAB_WIDEN);
7492 if (temp != 0)
7493 return temp;
7494
7495 /* At this point, a MEM target is no longer useful; we will get better
7496 code without it. */
7497
7498 if (GET_CODE (target) == MEM)
7499 target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
7500
7501 if (target != op0)
7502 emit_move_insn (target, op0);
7503
7504 op0 = gen_label_rtx ();
7505
7506 /* If this mode is an integer too wide to compare properly,
7507 compare word by word. Rely on cse to optimize constant cases. */
7508 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT && ! can_compare_p (mode, ccp_jump))
7509 {
7510 if (code == MAX_EXPR)
7511 do_jump_by_parts_greater_rtx (mode, TREE_UNSIGNED (type),
7512 target, op1, NULL_RTX, op0);
7513 else
7514 do_jump_by_parts_greater_rtx (mode, TREE_UNSIGNED (type),
7515 op1, target, NULL_RTX, op0);
7516 }
7517 else
7518 {
7519 int unsignedp = TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)));
7520 do_compare_rtx_and_jump (target, op1, code == MAX_EXPR ? GE : LE,
7521 unsignedp, mode, NULL_RTX, 0, NULL_RTX,
7522 op0);
7523 }
7524 emit_move_insn (target, op1);
7525 emit_label (op0);
7526 return target;
7527
7528 case BIT_NOT_EXPR:
7529 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), subtarget, VOIDmode, 0);
7530 temp = expand_unop (mode, one_cmpl_optab, op0, target, 1);
7531 if (temp == 0)
7532 abort ();
7533 return temp;
7534
7535 case FFS_EXPR:
7536 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), subtarget, VOIDmode, 0);
7537 temp = expand_unop (mode, ffs_optab, op0, target, 1);
7538 if (temp == 0)
7539 abort ();
7540 return temp;
7541
7542 /* ??? Can optimize bitwise operations with one arg constant.
7543 Can optimize (a bitwise1 n) bitwise2 (a bitwise3 b)
7544 and (a bitwise1 b) bitwise2 b (etc)
7545 but that is probably not worth while. */
7546
7547 /* BIT_AND_EXPR is for bitwise anding. TRUTH_AND_EXPR is for anding two
7548 boolean values when we want in all cases to compute both of them. In
7549 general it is fastest to do TRUTH_AND_EXPR by computing both operands
7550 as actual zero-or-1 values and then bitwise anding. In cases where
7551 there cannot be any side effects, better code would be made by
7552 treating TRUTH_AND_EXPR like TRUTH_ANDIF_EXPR; but the question is
7553 how to recognize those cases. */
7554
7555 case TRUTH_AND_EXPR:
7556 case BIT_AND_EXPR:
7557 this_optab = and_optab;
7558 goto binop;
7559
7560 case TRUTH_OR_EXPR:
7561 case BIT_IOR_EXPR:
7562 this_optab = ior_optab;
7563 goto binop;
7564
7565 case TRUTH_XOR_EXPR:
7566 case BIT_XOR_EXPR:
7567 this_optab = xor_optab;
7568 goto binop;
7569
7570 case LSHIFT_EXPR:
7571 case RSHIFT_EXPR:
7572 case LROTATE_EXPR:
7573 case RROTATE_EXPR:
7574 preexpand_calls (exp);
7575 if (! safe_from_p (subtarget, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 1))
7576 subtarget = 0;
7577 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), subtarget, VOIDmode, 0);
7578 return expand_shift (code, mode, op0, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), target,
7579 unsignedp);
7580
7581 /* Could determine the answer when only additive constants differ. Also,
7582 the addition of one can be handled by changing the condition. */
7583 case LT_EXPR:
7584 case LE_EXPR:
7585 case GT_EXPR:
7586 case GE_EXPR:
7587 case EQ_EXPR:
7588 case NE_EXPR:
7589 preexpand_calls (exp);
7590 temp = do_store_flag (exp, target, tmode != VOIDmode ? tmode : mode, 0);
7591 if (temp != 0)
7592 return temp;
7593
7594 /* For foo != 0, load foo, and if it is nonzero load 1 instead. */
7595 if (code == NE_EXPR && integer_zerop (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1))
7596 && original_target
7597 && GET_CODE (original_target) == REG
7598 && (GET_MODE (original_target)
7599 == TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)))))
7600 {
7601 temp = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), original_target,
7602 VOIDmode, 0);
7603
7604 if (temp != original_target)
7605 temp = copy_to_reg (temp);
7606
7607 op1 = gen_label_rtx ();
7608 emit_cmp_and_jump_insns (temp, const0_rtx, EQ, NULL_RTX,
7609 GET_MODE (temp), unsignedp, 0, op1);
7610 emit_move_insn (temp, const1_rtx);
7611 emit_label (op1);
7612 return temp;
7613 }
7614
7615 /* If no set-flag instruction, must generate a conditional
7616 store into a temporary variable. Drop through
7617 and handle this like && and ||. */
7618
7619 case TRUTH_ANDIF_EXPR:
7620 case TRUTH_ORIF_EXPR:
7621 if (! ignore
7622 && (target == 0 || ! safe_from_p (target, exp, 1)
7623 /* Make sure we don't have a hard reg (such as function's return
7624 value) live across basic blocks, if not optimizing. */
7625 || (!optimize && GET_CODE (target) == REG
7626 && REGNO (target) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)))
7627 target = gen_reg_rtx (tmode != VOIDmode ? tmode : mode);
7628
7629 if (target)
7630 emit_clr_insn (target);
7631
7632 op1 = gen_label_rtx ();
7633 jumpifnot (exp, op1);
7634
7635 if (target)
7636 emit_0_to_1_insn (target);
7637
7638 emit_label (op1);
7639 return ignore ? const0_rtx : target;
7640
7641 case TRUTH_NOT_EXPR:
7642 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), target, VOIDmode, 0);
7643 /* The parser is careful to generate TRUTH_NOT_EXPR
7644 only with operands that are always zero or one. */
7645 temp = expand_binop (mode, xor_optab, op0, const1_rtx,
7646 target, 1, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
7647 if (temp == 0)
7648 abort ();
7649 return temp;
7650
7651 case COMPOUND_EXPR:
7652 expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), const0_rtx, VOIDmode, 0);
7653 emit_queue ();
7654 return expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1),
7655 (ignore ? const0_rtx : target),
7656 VOIDmode, 0);
7657
7658 case COND_EXPR:
7659 /* If we would have a "singleton" (see below) were it not for a
7660 conversion in each arm, bring that conversion back out. */
7661 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)) == NOP_EXPR
7662 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2)) == NOP_EXPR
7663 && (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 0))
7664 == TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2), 0))))
7665 {
7666 tree true = TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 0);
7667 tree false = TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2), 0);
7668
7669 if ((TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (true)) == '2'
7670 && operand_equal_p (false, TREE_OPERAND (true, 0), 0))
7671 || (TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (false)) == '2'
7672 && operand_equal_p (true, TREE_OPERAND (false, 0), 0))
7673 || (TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (true)) == '1'
7674 && operand_equal_p (false, TREE_OPERAND (true, 0), 0))
7675 || (TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (false)) == '1'
7676 && operand_equal_p (true, TREE_OPERAND (false, 0), 0)))
7677 return expand_expr (build1 (NOP_EXPR, type,
7678 build (COND_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (true),
7679 TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0),
7680 true, false)),
7681 target, tmode, modifier);
7682 }
7683
7684 {
7685 /* Note that COND_EXPRs whose type is a structure or union
7686 are required to be constructed to contain assignments of
7687 a temporary variable, so that we can evaluate them here
7688 for side effect only. If type is void, we must do likewise. */
7689
7690 /* If an arm of the branch requires a cleanup,
7691 only that cleanup is performed. */
7692
7693 tree singleton = 0;
7694 tree binary_op = 0, unary_op = 0;
7695
7696 /* If this is (A ? 1 : 0) and A is a condition, just evaluate it and
7697 convert it to our mode, if necessary. */
7698 if (integer_onep (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1))
7699 && integer_zerop (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2))
7700 && TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))) == '<')
7701 {
7702 if (ignore)
7703 {
7704 expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), const0_rtx, VOIDmode,
7705 ro_modifier);
7706 return const0_rtx;
7707 }
7708
7709 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), target, mode, ro_modifier);
7710 if (GET_MODE (op0) == mode)
7711 return op0;
7712
7713 if (target == 0)
7714 target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
7715 convert_move (target, op0, unsignedp);
7716 return target;
7717 }
7718
7719 /* Check for X ? A + B : A. If we have this, we can copy A to the
7720 output and conditionally add B. Similarly for unary operations.
7721 Don't do this if X has side-effects because those side effects
7722 might affect A or B and the "?" operation is a sequence point in
7723 ANSI. (operand_equal_p tests for side effects.) */
7724
7725 if (TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1))) == '2'
7726 && operand_equal_p (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2),
7727 TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 0), 0))
7728 singleton = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2), binary_op = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
7729 else if (TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2))) == '2'
7730 && operand_equal_p (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1),
7731 TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2), 0), 0))
7732 singleton = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), binary_op = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2);
7733 else if (TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1))) == '1'
7734 && operand_equal_p (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2),
7735 TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 0), 0))
7736 singleton = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2), unary_op = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
7737 else if (TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2))) == '1'
7738 && operand_equal_p (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1),
7739 TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2), 0), 0))
7740 singleton = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), unary_op = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2);
7741
7742 /* If we are not to produce a result, we have no target. Otherwise,
7743 if a target was specified use it; it will not be used as an
7744 intermediate target unless it is safe. If no target, use a
7745 temporary. */
7746
7747 if (ignore)
7748 temp = 0;
7749 else if (original_target
7750 && (safe_from_p (original_target, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 1)
7751 || (singleton && GET_CODE (original_target) == REG
7752 && REGNO (original_target) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
7753 && original_target == var_rtx (singleton)))
7754 && GET_MODE (original_target) == mode
7755 #ifdef HAVE_conditional_move
7756 && (! can_conditionally_move_p (mode)
7757 || GET_CODE (original_target) == REG
7758 || TREE_ADDRESSABLE (type))
7759 #endif
7760 && ! (GET_CODE (original_target) == MEM
7761 && MEM_VOLATILE_P (original_target)))
7762 temp = original_target;
7763 else if (TREE_ADDRESSABLE (type))
7764 abort ();
7765 else
7766 temp = assign_temp (type, 0, 0, 1);
7767
7768 /* If we had X ? A + C : A, with C a constant power of 2, and we can
7769 do the test of X as a store-flag operation, do this as
7770 A + ((X != 0) << log C). Similarly for other simple binary
7771 operators. Only do for C == 1 if BRANCH_COST is low. */
7772 if (temp && singleton && binary_op
7773 && (TREE_CODE (binary_op) == PLUS_EXPR
7774 || TREE_CODE (binary_op) == MINUS_EXPR
7775 || TREE_CODE (binary_op) == BIT_IOR_EXPR
7776 || TREE_CODE (binary_op) == BIT_XOR_EXPR)
7777 && (BRANCH_COST >= 3 ? integer_pow2p (TREE_OPERAND (binary_op, 1))
7778 : integer_onep (TREE_OPERAND (binary_op, 1)))
7779 && TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))) == '<')
7780 {
7781 rtx result;
7782 optab boptab = (TREE_CODE (binary_op) == PLUS_EXPR ? add_optab
7783 : TREE_CODE (binary_op) == MINUS_EXPR ? sub_optab
7784 : TREE_CODE (binary_op) == BIT_IOR_EXPR ? ior_optab
7785 : xor_optab);
7786
7787 /* If we had X ? A : A + 1, do this as A + (X == 0).
7788
7789 We have to invert the truth value here and then put it
7790 back later if do_store_flag fails. We cannot simply copy
7791 TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0) to another variable and modify that
7792 because invert_truthvalue can modify the tree pointed to
7793 by its argument. */
7794 if (singleton == TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1))
7795 TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)
7796 = invert_truthvalue (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
7797
7798 result = do_store_flag (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0),
7799 (safe_from_p (temp, singleton, 1)
7800 ? temp : NULL_RTX),
7801 mode, BRANCH_COST <= 1);
7802
7803 if (result != 0 && ! integer_onep (TREE_OPERAND (binary_op, 1)))
7804 result = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, mode, result,
7805 build_int_2 (tree_log2
7806 (TREE_OPERAND
7807 (binary_op, 1)),
7808 0),
7809 (safe_from_p (temp, singleton, 1)
7810 ? temp : NULL_RTX), 0);
7811
7812 if (result)
7813 {
7814 op1 = expand_expr (singleton, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
7815 return expand_binop (mode, boptab, op1, result, temp,
7816 unsignedp, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
7817 }
7818 else if (singleton == TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1))
7819 TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)
7820 = invert_truthvalue (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
7821 }
7822
7823 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
7824 NO_DEFER_POP;
7825 op0 = gen_label_rtx ();
7826
7827 if (singleton && ! TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)))
7828 {
7829 if (temp != 0)
7830 {
7831 /* If the target conflicts with the other operand of the
7832 binary op, we can't use it. Also, we can't use the target
7833 if it is a hard register, because evaluating the condition
7834 might clobber it. */
7835 if ((binary_op
7836 && ! safe_from_p (temp, TREE_OPERAND (binary_op, 1), 1))
7837 || (GET_CODE (temp) == REG
7838 && REGNO (temp) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER))
7839 temp = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
7840 store_expr (singleton, temp, 0);
7841 }
7842 else
7843 expand_expr (singleton,
7844 ignore ? const0_rtx : NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
7845 if (singleton == TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1))
7846 jumpif (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), op0);
7847 else
7848 jumpifnot (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), op0);
7849
7850 start_cleanup_deferral ();
7851 if (binary_op && temp == 0)
7852 /* Just touch the other operand. */
7853 expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (binary_op, 1),
7854 ignore ? const0_rtx : NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
7855 else if (binary_op)
7856 store_expr (build (TREE_CODE (binary_op), type,
7857 make_tree (type, temp),
7858 TREE_OPERAND (binary_op, 1)),
7859 temp, 0);
7860 else
7861 store_expr (build1 (TREE_CODE (unary_op), type,
7862 make_tree (type, temp)),
7863 temp, 0);
7864 op1 = op0;
7865 }
7866 /* Check for A op 0 ? A : FOO and A op 0 ? FOO : A where OP is any
7867 comparison operator. If we have one of these cases, set the
7868 output to A, branch on A (cse will merge these two references),
7869 then set the output to FOO. */
7870 else if (temp
7871 && TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))) == '<'
7872 && integer_zerop (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 1))
7873 && operand_equal_p (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0),
7874 TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 0)
7875 && (! TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))
7876 || TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)) == SAVE_EXPR)
7877 && safe_from_p (temp, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2), 1))
7878 {
7879 if (GET_CODE (temp) == REG && REGNO (temp) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
7880 temp = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
7881 store_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), temp, 0);
7882 jumpif (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), op0);
7883
7884 start_cleanup_deferral ();
7885 store_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2), temp, 0);
7886 op1 = op0;
7887 }
7888 else if (temp
7889 && TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))) == '<'
7890 && integer_zerop (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 1))
7891 && operand_equal_p (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0),
7892 TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2), 0)
7893 && (! TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))
7894 || TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2)) == SAVE_EXPR)
7895 && safe_from_p (temp, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 1))
7896 {
7897 if (GET_CODE (temp) == REG && REGNO (temp) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
7898 temp = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
7899 store_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2), temp, 0);
7900 jumpifnot (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), op0);
7901
7902 start_cleanup_deferral ();
7903 store_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), temp, 0);
7904 op1 = op0;
7905 }
7906 else
7907 {
7908 op1 = gen_label_rtx ();
7909 jumpifnot (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), op0);
7910
7911 start_cleanup_deferral ();
7912
7913 /* One branch of the cond can be void, if it never returns. For
7914 example A ? throw : E */
7915 if (temp != 0
7916 && TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)) != void_type_node)
7917 store_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), temp, 0);
7918 else
7919 expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1),
7920 ignore ? const0_rtx : NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
7921 end_cleanup_deferral ();
7922 emit_queue ();
7923 emit_jump_insn (gen_jump (op1));
7924 emit_barrier ();
7925 emit_label (op0);
7926 start_cleanup_deferral ();
7927 if (temp != 0
7928 && TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2)) != void_type_node)
7929 store_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2), temp, 0);
7930 else
7931 expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2),
7932 ignore ? const0_rtx : NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
7933 }
7934
7935 end_cleanup_deferral ();
7936
7937 emit_queue ();
7938 emit_label (op1);
7939 OK_DEFER_POP;
7940
7941 return temp;
7942 }
7943
7944 case TARGET_EXPR:
7945 {
7946 /* Something needs to be initialized, but we didn't know
7947 where that thing was when building the tree. For example,
7948 it could be the return value of a function, or a parameter
7949 to a function which lays down in the stack, or a temporary
7950 variable which must be passed by reference.
7951
7952 We guarantee that the expression will either be constructed
7953 or copied into our original target. */
7954
7955 tree slot = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
7956 tree cleanups = NULL_TREE;
7957 tree exp1;
7958
7959 if (TREE_CODE (slot) != VAR_DECL)
7960 abort ();
7961
7962 if (! ignore)
7963 target = original_target;
7964
7965 /* Set this here so that if we get a target that refers to a
7966 register variable that's already been used, put_reg_into_stack
7967 knows that it should fix up those uses. */
7968 TREE_USED (slot) = 1;
7969
7970 if (target == 0)
7971 {
7972 if (DECL_RTL (slot) != 0)
7973 {
7974 target = DECL_RTL (slot);
7975 /* If we have already expanded the slot, so don't do
7976 it again. (mrs) */
7977 if (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1) == NULL_TREE)
7978 return target;
7979 }
7980 else
7981 {
7982 target = assign_temp (type, 2, 0, 1);
7983 /* All temp slots at this level must not conflict. */
7984 preserve_temp_slots (target);
7985 DECL_RTL (slot) = target;
7986 if (TREE_ADDRESSABLE (slot))
7987 {
7988 TREE_ADDRESSABLE (slot) = 0;
7989 mark_addressable (slot);
7990 }
7991
7992 /* Since SLOT is not known to the called function
7993 to belong to its stack frame, we must build an explicit
7994 cleanup. This case occurs when we must build up a reference
7995 to pass the reference as an argument. In this case,
7996 it is very likely that such a reference need not be
7997 built here. */
7998
7999 if (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2) == 0)
8000 TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2) = maybe_build_cleanup (slot);
8001 cleanups = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2);
8002 }
8003 }
8004 else
8005 {
8006 /* This case does occur, when expanding a parameter which
8007 needs to be constructed on the stack. The target
8008 is the actual stack address that we want to initialize.
8009 The function we call will perform the cleanup in this case. */
8010
8011 /* If we have already assigned it space, use that space,
8012 not target that we were passed in, as our target
8013 parameter is only a hint. */
8014 if (DECL_RTL (slot) != 0)
8015 {
8016 target = DECL_RTL (slot);
8017 /* If we have already expanded the slot, so don't do
8018 it again. (mrs) */
8019 if (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1) == NULL_TREE)
8020 return target;
8021 }
8022 else
8023 {
8024 DECL_RTL (slot) = target;
8025 /* If we must have an addressable slot, then make sure that
8026 the RTL that we just stored in slot is OK. */
8027 if (TREE_ADDRESSABLE (slot))
8028 {
8029 TREE_ADDRESSABLE (slot) = 0;
8030 mark_addressable (slot);
8031 }
8032 }
8033 }
8034
8035 exp1 = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 3) = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
8036 /* Mark it as expanded. */
8037 TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1) = NULL_TREE;
8038
8039 store_expr (exp1, target, 0);
8040
8041 expand_decl_cleanup (NULL_TREE, cleanups);
8042
8043 return target;
8044 }
8045
8046 case INIT_EXPR:
8047 {
8048 tree lhs = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
8049 tree rhs = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
8050 tree noncopied_parts = 0;
8051 tree lhs_type = TREE_TYPE (lhs);
8052
8053 temp = expand_assignment (lhs, rhs, ! ignore, original_target != 0);
8054 if (TYPE_NONCOPIED_PARTS (lhs_type) != 0 && !fixed_type_p (rhs))
8055 noncopied_parts = init_noncopied_parts (stabilize_reference (lhs),
8056 TYPE_NONCOPIED_PARTS (lhs_type));
8057 while (noncopied_parts != 0)
8058 {
8059 expand_assignment (TREE_VALUE (noncopied_parts),
8060 TREE_PURPOSE (noncopied_parts), 0, 0);
8061 noncopied_parts = TREE_CHAIN (noncopied_parts);
8062 }
8063 return temp;
8064 }
8065
8066 case MODIFY_EXPR:
8067 {
8068 /* If lhs is complex, expand calls in rhs before computing it.
8069 That's so we don't compute a pointer and save it over a call.
8070 If lhs is simple, compute it first so we can give it as a
8071 target if the rhs is just a call. This avoids an extra temp and copy
8072 and that prevents a partial-subsumption which makes bad code.
8073 Actually we could treat component_ref's of vars like vars. */
8074
8075 tree lhs = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
8076 tree rhs = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
8077 tree noncopied_parts = 0;
8078 tree lhs_type = TREE_TYPE (lhs);
8079
8080 temp = 0;
8081
8082 if (TREE_CODE (lhs) != VAR_DECL
8083 && TREE_CODE (lhs) != RESULT_DECL
8084 && TREE_CODE (lhs) != PARM_DECL
8085 && ! (TREE_CODE (lhs) == INDIRECT_REF
8086 && TYPE_READONLY (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (lhs, 0)))))
8087 preexpand_calls (exp);
8088
8089 /* Check for |= or &= of a bitfield of size one into another bitfield
8090 of size 1. In this case, (unless we need the result of the
8091 assignment) we can do this more efficiently with a
8092 test followed by an assignment, if necessary.
8093
8094 ??? At this point, we can't get a BIT_FIELD_REF here. But if
8095 things change so we do, this code should be enhanced to
8096 support it. */
8097 if (ignore
8098 && TREE_CODE (lhs) == COMPONENT_REF
8099 && (TREE_CODE (rhs) == BIT_IOR_EXPR
8100 || TREE_CODE (rhs) == BIT_AND_EXPR)
8101 && TREE_OPERAND (rhs, 0) == lhs
8102 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (rhs, 1)) == COMPONENT_REF
8103 && TREE_INT_CST_LOW (DECL_SIZE (TREE_OPERAND (lhs, 1))) == 1
8104 && TREE_INT_CST_LOW (DECL_SIZE (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (rhs, 1), 1))) == 1)
8105 {
8106 rtx label = gen_label_rtx ();
8107
8108 do_jump (TREE_OPERAND (rhs, 1),
8109 TREE_CODE (rhs) == BIT_IOR_EXPR ? label : 0,
8110 TREE_CODE (rhs) == BIT_AND_EXPR ? label : 0);
8111 expand_assignment (lhs, convert (TREE_TYPE (rhs),
8112 (TREE_CODE (rhs) == BIT_IOR_EXPR
8113 ? integer_one_node
8114 : integer_zero_node)),
8115 0, 0);
8116 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
8117 emit_label (label);
8118 return const0_rtx;
8119 }
8120
8121 if (TYPE_NONCOPIED_PARTS (lhs_type) != 0
8122 && ! (fixed_type_p (lhs) && fixed_type_p (rhs)))
8123 noncopied_parts = save_noncopied_parts (stabilize_reference (lhs),
8124 TYPE_NONCOPIED_PARTS (lhs_type));
8125
8126 temp = expand_assignment (lhs, rhs, ! ignore, original_target != 0);
8127 while (noncopied_parts != 0)
8128 {
8129 expand_assignment (TREE_PURPOSE (noncopied_parts),
8130 TREE_VALUE (noncopied_parts), 0, 0);
8131 noncopied_parts = TREE_CHAIN (noncopied_parts);
8132 }
8133 return temp;
8134 }
8135
8136 case RETURN_EXPR:
8137 if (!TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))
8138 expand_null_return ();
8139 else
8140 expand_return (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
8141 return const0_rtx;
8142
8143 case PREINCREMENT_EXPR:
8144 case PREDECREMENT_EXPR:
8145 return expand_increment (exp, 0, ignore);
8146
8147 case POSTINCREMENT_EXPR:
8148 case POSTDECREMENT_EXPR:
8149 /* Faster to treat as pre-increment if result is not used. */
8150 return expand_increment (exp, ! ignore, ignore);
8151
8152 case ADDR_EXPR:
8153 /* If nonzero, TEMP will be set to the address of something that might
8154 be a MEM corresponding to a stack slot. */
8155 temp = 0;
8156
8157 /* Are we taking the address of a nested function? */
8158 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)) == FUNCTION_DECL
8159 && decl_function_context (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)) != 0
8160 && ! DECL_NO_STATIC_CHAIN (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))
8161 && ! TREE_STATIC (exp))
8162 {
8163 op0 = trampoline_address (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
8164 op0 = force_operand (op0, target);
8165 }
8166 /* If we are taking the address of something erroneous, just
8167 return a zero. */
8168 else if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)) == ERROR_MARK)
8169 return const0_rtx;
8170 else
8171 {
8172 /* We make sure to pass const0_rtx down if we came in with
8173 ignore set, to avoid doing the cleanups twice for something. */
8174 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0),
8175 ignore ? const0_rtx : NULL_RTX, VOIDmode,
8176 (modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER
8177 ? modifier : EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS));
8178
8179 /* If we are going to ignore the result, OP0 will have been set
8180 to const0_rtx, so just return it. Don't get confused and
8181 think we are taking the address of the constant. */
8182 if (ignore)
8183 return op0;
8184
8185 op0 = protect_from_queue (op0, 0);
8186
8187 /* We would like the object in memory. If it is a constant, we can
8188 have it be statically allocated into memory. For a non-constant,
8189 we need to allocate some memory and store the value into it. */
8190
8191 if (CONSTANT_P (op0))
8192 op0 = force_const_mem (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))),
8193 op0);
8194 else if (GET_CODE (op0) == MEM)
8195 {
8196 mark_temp_addr_taken (op0);
8197 temp = XEXP (op0, 0);
8198 }
8199
8200 else if (GET_CODE (op0) == REG || GET_CODE (op0) == SUBREG
8201 || GET_CODE (op0) == CONCAT || GET_CODE (op0) == ADDRESSOF)
8202 {
8203 /* If this object is in a register, it must be not
8204 be BLKmode. */
8205 tree inner_type = TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
8206 rtx memloc = assign_temp (inner_type, 1, 1, 1);
8207
8208 mark_temp_addr_taken (memloc);
8209 emit_move_insn (memloc, op0);
8210 op0 = memloc;
8211 }
8212
8213 if (GET_CODE (op0) != MEM)
8214 abort ();
8215
8216 if (modifier == EXPAND_SUM || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
8217 {
8218 temp = XEXP (op0, 0);
8219 #ifdef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
8220 if (GET_MODE (temp) == Pmode && GET_MODE (temp) != mode
8221 && mode == ptr_mode)
8222 temp = convert_memory_address (ptr_mode, temp);
8223 #endif
8224 return temp;
8225 }
8226
8227 op0 = force_operand (XEXP (op0, 0), target);
8228 }
8229
8230 if (flag_force_addr && GET_CODE (op0) != REG)
8231 op0 = force_reg (Pmode, op0);
8232
8233 if (GET_CODE (op0) == REG
8234 && ! REG_USERVAR_P (op0))
8235 mark_reg_pointer (op0, TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (type)) / BITS_PER_UNIT);
8236
8237 /* If we might have had a temp slot, add an equivalent address
8238 for it. */
8239 if (temp != 0)
8240 update_temp_slot_address (temp, op0);
8241
8242 #ifdef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
8243 if (GET_MODE (op0) == Pmode && GET_MODE (op0) != mode
8244 && mode == ptr_mode)
8245 op0 = convert_memory_address (ptr_mode, op0);
8246 #endif
8247
8248 return op0;
8249
8250 case ENTRY_VALUE_EXPR:
8251 abort ();
8252
8253 /* COMPLEX type for Extended Pascal & Fortran */
8254 case COMPLEX_EXPR:
8255 {
8256 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
8257 rtx insns;
8258
8259 /* Get the rtx code of the operands. */
8260 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0, VOIDmode, 0);
8261 op1 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 0, VOIDmode, 0);
8262
8263 if (! target)
8264 target = gen_reg_rtx (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
8265
8266 start_sequence ();
8267
8268 /* Move the real (op0) and imaginary (op1) parts to their location. */
8269 emit_move_insn (gen_realpart (mode, target), op0);
8270 emit_move_insn (gen_imagpart (mode, target), op1);
8271
8272 insns = get_insns ();
8273 end_sequence ();
8274
8275 /* Complex construction should appear as a single unit. */
8276 /* If TARGET is a CONCAT, we got insns like RD = RS, ID = IS,
8277 each with a separate pseudo as destination.
8278 It's not correct for flow to treat them as a unit. */
8279 if (GET_CODE (target) != CONCAT)
8280 emit_no_conflict_block (insns, target, op0, op1, NULL_RTX);
8281 else
8282 emit_insns (insns);
8283
8284 return target;
8285 }
8286
8287 case REALPART_EXPR:
8288 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0, VOIDmode, 0);
8289 return gen_realpart (mode, op0);
8290
8291 case IMAGPART_EXPR:
8292 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0, VOIDmode, 0);
8293 return gen_imagpart (mode, op0);
8294
8295 case CONJ_EXPR:
8296 {
8297 enum machine_mode partmode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
8298 rtx imag_t;
8299 rtx insns;
8300
8301 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0, VOIDmode, 0);
8302
8303 if (! target)
8304 target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
8305
8306 start_sequence ();
8307
8308 /* Store the realpart and the negated imagpart to target. */
8309 emit_move_insn (gen_realpart (partmode, target),
8310 gen_realpart (partmode, op0));
8311
8312 imag_t = gen_imagpart (partmode, target);
8313 temp = expand_unop (partmode, neg_optab,
8314 gen_imagpart (partmode, op0), imag_t, 0);
8315 if (temp != imag_t)
8316 emit_move_insn (imag_t, temp);
8317
8318 insns = get_insns ();
8319 end_sequence ();
8320
8321 /* Conjugate should appear as a single unit
8322 If TARGET is a CONCAT, we got insns like RD = RS, ID = - IS,
8323 each with a separate pseudo as destination.
8324 It's not correct for flow to treat them as a unit. */
8325 if (GET_CODE (target) != CONCAT)
8326 emit_no_conflict_block (insns, target, op0, NULL_RTX, NULL_RTX);
8327 else
8328 emit_insns (insns);
8329
8330 return target;
8331 }
8332
8333 case TRY_CATCH_EXPR:
8334 {
8335 tree handler = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
8336
8337 expand_eh_region_start ();
8338
8339 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0, VOIDmode, 0);
8340
8341 expand_eh_region_end (handler);
8342
8343 return op0;
8344 }
8345
8346 case TRY_FINALLY_EXPR:
8347 {
8348 tree try_block = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
8349 tree finally_block = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
8350 rtx finally_label = gen_label_rtx ();
8351 rtx done_label = gen_label_rtx ();
8352 rtx return_link = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
8353 tree cleanup = build (GOTO_SUBROUTINE_EXPR, void_type_node,
8354 (tree) finally_label, (tree) return_link);
8355 TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (cleanup) = 1;
8356
8357 /* Start a new binding layer that will keep track of all cleanup
8358 actions to be performed. */
8359 expand_start_bindings (2);
8360
8361 target_temp_slot_level = temp_slot_level;
8362
8363 expand_decl_cleanup (NULL_TREE, cleanup);
8364 op0 = expand_expr (try_block, target, tmode, modifier);
8365
8366 preserve_temp_slots (op0);
8367 expand_end_bindings (NULL_TREE, 0, 0);
8368 emit_jump (done_label);
8369 emit_label (finally_label);
8370 expand_expr (finally_block, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, 0);
8371 emit_indirect_jump (return_link);
8372 emit_label (done_label);
8373 return op0;
8374 }
8375
8376 case GOTO_SUBROUTINE_EXPR:
8377 {
8378 rtx subr = (rtx) TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
8379 rtx return_link = *(rtx *) &TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
8380 rtx return_address = gen_label_rtx ();
8381 emit_move_insn (return_link, gen_rtx_LABEL_REF (Pmode, return_address));
8382 emit_jump (subr);
8383 emit_label (return_address);
8384 return const0_rtx;
8385 }
8386
8387 case POPDCC_EXPR:
8388 {
8389 rtx dcc = get_dynamic_cleanup_chain ();
8390 emit_move_insn (dcc, validize_mem (gen_rtx_MEM (Pmode, dcc)));
8391 return const0_rtx;
8392 }
8393
8394 case POPDHC_EXPR:
8395 {
8396 rtx dhc = get_dynamic_handler_chain ();
8397 emit_move_insn (dhc, validize_mem (gen_rtx_MEM (Pmode, dhc)));
8398 return const0_rtx;
8399 }
8400
8401 case VA_ARG_EXPR:
8402 return expand_builtin_va_arg (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), type);
8403
8404 default:
8405 return (*lang_expand_expr) (exp, original_target, tmode, modifier);
8406 }
8407
8408 /* Here to do an ordinary binary operator, generating an instruction
8409 from the optab already placed in `this_optab'. */
8410 binop:
8411 preexpand_calls (exp);
8412 if (! safe_from_p (subtarget, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 1))
8413 subtarget = 0;
8414 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), subtarget, VOIDmode, 0);
8415 op1 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
8416 binop2:
8417 temp = expand_binop (mode, this_optab, op0, op1, target,
8418 unsignedp, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
8419 if (temp == 0)
8420 abort ();
8421 return temp;
8422 }
8423 \f
8424 /* Similar to expand_expr, except that we don't specify a target, target
8425 mode, or modifier and we return the alignment of the inner type. This is
8426 used in cases where it is not necessary to align the result to the
8427 alignment of its type as long as we know the alignment of the result, for
8428 example for comparisons of BLKmode values. */
8429
8430 static rtx
8431 expand_expr_unaligned (exp, palign)
8432 register tree exp;
8433 int *palign;
8434 {
8435 register rtx op0;
8436 tree type = TREE_TYPE (exp);
8437 register enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (type);
8438
8439 /* Default the alignment we return to that of the type. */
8440 *palign = TYPE_ALIGN (type);
8441
8442 /* The only cases in which we do anything special is if the resulting mode
8443 is BLKmode. */
8444 if (mode != BLKmode)
8445 return expand_expr (exp, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8446
8447 switch (TREE_CODE (exp))
8448 {
8449 case CONVERT_EXPR:
8450 case NOP_EXPR:
8451 case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
8452 /* Conversions between BLKmode values don't change the underlying
8453 alignment or value. */
8454 if (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))) == BLKmode)
8455 return expand_expr_unaligned (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), palign);
8456 break;
8457
8458 case ARRAY_REF:
8459 /* Much of the code for this case is copied directly from expand_expr.
8460 We need to duplicate it here because we will do something different
8461 in the fall-through case, so we need to handle the same exceptions
8462 it does. */
8463 {
8464 tree array = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
8465 tree domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (TREE_TYPE (array));
8466 tree low_bound = domain ? TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain) : integer_zero_node;
8467 tree index = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
8468 tree index_type = TREE_TYPE (index);
8469 HOST_WIDE_INT i;
8470
8471 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))) != ARRAY_TYPE)
8472 abort ();
8473
8474 /* Optimize the special-case of a zero lower bound.
8475
8476 We convert the low_bound to sizetype to avoid some problems
8477 with constant folding. (E.g. suppose the lower bound is 1,
8478 and its mode is QI. Without the conversion, (ARRAY
8479 +(INDEX-(unsigned char)1)) becomes ((ARRAY+(-(unsigned char)1))
8480 +INDEX), which becomes (ARRAY+255+INDEX). Oops!)
8481
8482 But sizetype isn't quite right either (especially if
8483 the lowbound is negative). FIXME */
8484
8485 if (! integer_zerop (low_bound))
8486 index = fold (build (MINUS_EXPR, index_type, index,
8487 convert (sizetype, low_bound)));
8488
8489 /* If this is a constant index into a constant array,
8490 just get the value from the array. Handle both the cases when
8491 we have an explicit constructor and when our operand is a variable
8492 that was declared const. */
8493
8494 if (TREE_CODE (array) == CONSTRUCTOR && ! TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (array))
8495 {
8496 if (TREE_CODE (index) == INTEGER_CST
8497 && TREE_INT_CST_HIGH (index) == 0)
8498 {
8499 tree elem = CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
8500
8501 i = TREE_INT_CST_LOW (index);
8502 while (elem && i--)
8503 elem = TREE_CHAIN (elem);
8504 if (elem)
8505 return expand_expr_unaligned (fold (TREE_VALUE (elem)),
8506 palign);
8507 }
8508 }
8509
8510 else if (optimize >= 1
8511 && TREE_READONLY (array) && ! TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (array)
8512 && TREE_CODE (array) == VAR_DECL && DECL_INITIAL (array)
8513 && TREE_CODE (DECL_INITIAL (array)) != ERROR_MARK)
8514 {
8515 if (TREE_CODE (index) == INTEGER_CST)
8516 {
8517 tree init = DECL_INITIAL (array);
8518
8519 i = TREE_INT_CST_LOW (index);
8520 if (TREE_CODE (init) == CONSTRUCTOR)
8521 {
8522 tree elem = CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (init);
8523
8524 while (elem
8525 && !tree_int_cst_equal (TREE_PURPOSE (elem), index))
8526 elem = TREE_CHAIN (elem);
8527 if (elem)
8528 return expand_expr_unaligned (fold (TREE_VALUE (elem)),
8529 palign);
8530 }
8531 }
8532 }
8533 }
8534
8535 /* ... fall through ... */
8536
8537 case COMPONENT_REF:
8538 case BIT_FIELD_REF:
8539 /* If the operand is a CONSTRUCTOR, we can just extract the
8540 appropriate field if it is present. Don't do this if we have
8541 already written the data since we want to refer to that copy
8542 and varasm.c assumes that's what we'll do. */
8543 if (TREE_CODE (exp) != ARRAY_REF
8544 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)) == CONSTRUCTOR
8545 && TREE_CST_RTL (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)) == 0)
8546 {
8547 tree elt;
8548
8549 for (elt = CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)); elt;
8550 elt = TREE_CHAIN (elt))
8551 if (TREE_PURPOSE (elt) == TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1))
8552 /* Note that unlike the case in expand_expr, we know this is
8553 BLKmode and hence not an integer. */
8554 return expand_expr_unaligned (TREE_VALUE (elt), palign);
8555 }
8556
8557 {
8558 enum machine_mode mode1;
8559 int bitsize;
8560 int bitpos;
8561 tree offset;
8562 int volatilep = 0;
8563 int alignment;
8564 int unsignedp;
8565 tree tem = get_inner_reference (exp, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset,
8566 &mode1, &unsignedp, &volatilep,
8567 &alignment);
8568
8569 /* If we got back the original object, something is wrong. Perhaps
8570 we are evaluating an expression too early. In any event, don't
8571 infinitely recurse. */
8572 if (tem == exp)
8573 abort ();
8574
8575 op0 = expand_expr (tem, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8576
8577 /* If this is a constant, put it into a register if it is a
8578 legitimate constant and OFFSET is 0 and memory if it isn't. */
8579 if (CONSTANT_P (op0))
8580 {
8581 enum machine_mode inner_mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (tem));
8582
8583 if (inner_mode != BLKmode && LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (op0)
8584 && offset == 0)
8585 op0 = force_reg (inner_mode, op0);
8586 else
8587 op0 = validize_mem (force_const_mem (inner_mode, op0));
8588 }
8589
8590 if (offset != 0)
8591 {
8592 rtx offset_rtx = expand_expr (offset, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
8593
8594 /* If this object is in a register, put it into memory.
8595 This case can't occur in C, but can in Ada if we have
8596 unchecked conversion of an expression from a scalar type to
8597 an array or record type. */
8598 if (GET_CODE (op0) == REG || GET_CODE (op0) == SUBREG
8599 || GET_CODE (op0) == CONCAT || GET_CODE (op0) == ADDRESSOF)
8600 {
8601 rtx memloc = assign_temp (TREE_TYPE (tem), 1, 1, 1);
8602
8603 mark_temp_addr_taken (memloc);
8604 emit_move_insn (memloc, op0);
8605 op0 = memloc;
8606 }
8607
8608 if (GET_CODE (op0) != MEM)
8609 abort ();
8610
8611 if (GET_MODE (offset_rtx) != ptr_mode)
8612 {
8613 #ifdef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
8614 offset_rtx = convert_memory_address (ptr_mode, offset_rtx);
8615 #else
8616 offset_rtx = convert_to_mode (ptr_mode, offset_rtx, 0);
8617 #endif
8618 }
8619
8620 op0 = change_address (op0, VOIDmode,
8621 gen_rtx_PLUS (ptr_mode, XEXP (op0, 0),
8622 force_reg (ptr_mode,
8623 offset_rtx)));
8624 }
8625
8626 /* Don't forget about volatility even if this is a bitfield. */
8627 if (GET_CODE (op0) == MEM && volatilep && ! MEM_VOLATILE_P (op0))
8628 {
8629 op0 = copy_rtx (op0);
8630 MEM_VOLATILE_P (op0) = 1;
8631 }
8632
8633 /* Check the access. */
8634 if (current_function_check_memory_usage && GET_CODE (op0) == MEM)
8635 {
8636 rtx to;
8637 int size;
8638
8639 to = plus_constant (XEXP (op0, 0), (bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT));
8640 size = (bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT) + bitsize + BITS_PER_UNIT - 1;
8641
8642 /* Check the access right of the pointer. */
8643 if (size > BITS_PER_UNIT)
8644 emit_library_call (chkr_check_addr_libfunc, 1, VOIDmode, 3,
8645 to, ptr_mode, GEN_INT (size / BITS_PER_UNIT),
8646 TYPE_MODE (sizetype),
8647 GEN_INT (MEMORY_USE_RO),
8648 TYPE_MODE (integer_type_node));
8649 }
8650
8651 /* In cases where an aligned union has an unaligned object
8652 as a field, we might be extracting a BLKmode value from
8653 an integer-mode (e.g., SImode) object. Handle this case
8654 by doing the extract into an object as wide as the field
8655 (which we know to be the width of a basic mode), then
8656 storing into memory, and changing the mode to BLKmode.
8657 If we ultimately want the address (EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS or
8658 EXPAND_INITIALIZER), then we must not copy to a temporary. */
8659 if (mode1 == VOIDmode
8660 || GET_CODE (op0) == REG || GET_CODE (op0) == SUBREG
8661 || (SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS
8662 && (TYPE_ALIGN (type) > alignment * BITS_PER_UNIT
8663 || bitpos % TYPE_ALIGN (type) != 0)))
8664 {
8665 enum machine_mode ext_mode = mode_for_size (bitsize, MODE_INT, 1);
8666
8667 if (ext_mode == BLKmode)
8668 {
8669 /* In this case, BITPOS must start at a byte boundary. */
8670 if (GET_CODE (op0) != MEM
8671 || bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0)
8672 abort ();
8673
8674 op0 = change_address (op0, VOIDmode,
8675 plus_constant (XEXP (op0, 0),
8676 bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT));
8677 }
8678 else
8679 {
8680 rtx new = assign_stack_temp (ext_mode,
8681 bitsize / BITS_PER_UNIT, 0);
8682
8683 op0 = extract_bit_field (validize_mem (op0), bitsize, bitpos,
8684 unsignedp, NULL_RTX, ext_mode,
8685 ext_mode, alignment,
8686 int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (tem)));
8687
8688 /* If the result is a record type and BITSIZE is narrower than
8689 the mode of OP0, an integral mode, and this is a big endian
8690 machine, we must put the field into the high-order bits. */
8691 if (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE && BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
8692 && GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (op0)) == MODE_INT
8693 && bitsize < GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (op0)))
8694 op0 = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, GET_MODE (op0), op0,
8695 size_int (GET_MODE_BITSIZE
8696 (GET_MODE (op0))
8697 - bitsize),
8698 op0, 1);
8699
8700
8701 emit_move_insn (new, op0);
8702 op0 = copy_rtx (new);
8703 PUT_MODE (op0, BLKmode);
8704 }
8705 }
8706 else
8707 /* Get a reference to just this component. */
8708 op0 = change_address (op0, mode1,
8709 plus_constant (XEXP (op0, 0),
8710 (bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT)));
8711
8712 MEM_ALIAS_SET (op0) = get_alias_set (exp);
8713
8714 /* Adjust the alignment in case the bit position is not
8715 a multiple of the alignment of the inner object. */
8716 while (bitpos % alignment != 0)
8717 alignment >>= 1;
8718
8719 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (op0, 0)) == REG)
8720 mark_reg_pointer (XEXP (op0, 0), alignment);
8721
8722 MEM_IN_STRUCT_P (op0) = 1;
8723 MEM_VOLATILE_P (op0) |= volatilep;
8724
8725 *palign = alignment;
8726 return op0;
8727 }
8728
8729 default:
8730 break;
8731
8732 }
8733
8734 return expand_expr (exp, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8735 }
8736 \f
8737 /* Return the tree node and offset if a given argument corresponds to
8738 a string constant. */
8739
8740 tree
8741 string_constant (arg, ptr_offset)
8742 tree arg;
8743 tree *ptr_offset;
8744 {
8745 STRIP_NOPS (arg);
8746
8747 if (TREE_CODE (arg) == ADDR_EXPR
8748 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0)) == STRING_CST)
8749 {
8750 *ptr_offset = integer_zero_node;
8751 return TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0);
8752 }
8753 else if (TREE_CODE (arg) == PLUS_EXPR)
8754 {
8755 tree arg0 = TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0);
8756 tree arg1 = TREE_OPERAND (arg, 1);
8757
8758 STRIP_NOPS (arg0);
8759 STRIP_NOPS (arg1);
8760
8761 if (TREE_CODE (arg0) == ADDR_EXPR
8762 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (arg0, 0)) == STRING_CST)
8763 {
8764 *ptr_offset = arg1;
8765 return TREE_OPERAND (arg0, 0);
8766 }
8767 else if (TREE_CODE (arg1) == ADDR_EXPR
8768 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (arg1, 0)) == STRING_CST)
8769 {
8770 *ptr_offset = arg0;
8771 return TREE_OPERAND (arg1, 0);
8772 }
8773 }
8774
8775 return 0;
8776 }
8777 \f
8778 /* Expand code for a post- or pre- increment or decrement
8779 and return the RTX for the result.
8780 POST is 1 for postinc/decrements and 0 for preinc/decrements. */
8781
8782 static rtx
8783 expand_increment (exp, post, ignore)
8784 register tree exp;
8785 int post, ignore;
8786 {
8787 register rtx op0, op1;
8788 register rtx temp, value;
8789 register tree incremented = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
8790 optab this_optab = add_optab;
8791 int icode;
8792 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp));
8793 int op0_is_copy = 0;
8794 int single_insn = 0;
8795 /* 1 means we can't store into OP0 directly,
8796 because it is a subreg narrower than a word,
8797 and we don't dare clobber the rest of the word. */
8798 int bad_subreg = 0;
8799
8800 /* Stabilize any component ref that might need to be
8801 evaluated more than once below. */
8802 if (!post
8803 || TREE_CODE (incremented) == BIT_FIELD_REF
8804 || (TREE_CODE (incremented) == COMPONENT_REF
8805 && (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (incremented, 0)) != INDIRECT_REF
8806 || DECL_BIT_FIELD (TREE_OPERAND (incremented, 1)))))
8807 incremented = stabilize_reference (incremented);
8808 /* Nested *INCREMENT_EXPRs can happen in C++. We must force innermost
8809 ones into save exprs so that they don't accidentally get evaluated
8810 more than once by the code below. */
8811 if (TREE_CODE (incremented) == PREINCREMENT_EXPR
8812 || TREE_CODE (incremented) == PREDECREMENT_EXPR)
8813 incremented = save_expr (incremented);
8814
8815 /* Compute the operands as RTX.
8816 Note whether OP0 is the actual lvalue or a copy of it:
8817 I believe it is a copy iff it is a register or subreg
8818 and insns were generated in computing it. */
8819
8820 temp = get_last_insn ();
8821 op0 = expand_expr (incremented, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_MEMORY_USE_RW);
8822
8823 /* If OP0 is a SUBREG made for a promoted variable, we cannot increment
8824 in place but instead must do sign- or zero-extension during assignment,
8825 so we copy it into a new register and let the code below use it as
8826 a copy.
8827
8828 Note that we can safely modify this SUBREG since it is know not to be
8829 shared (it was made by the expand_expr call above). */
8830
8831 if (GET_CODE (op0) == SUBREG && SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (op0))
8832 {
8833 if (post)
8834 SUBREG_REG (op0) = copy_to_reg (SUBREG_REG (op0));
8835 else
8836 bad_subreg = 1;
8837 }
8838 else if (GET_CODE (op0) == SUBREG
8839 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (op0)) < BITS_PER_WORD)
8840 {
8841 /* We cannot increment this SUBREG in place. If we are
8842 post-incrementing, get a copy of the old value. Otherwise,
8843 just mark that we cannot increment in place. */
8844 if (post)
8845 op0 = copy_to_reg (op0);
8846 else
8847 bad_subreg = 1;
8848 }
8849
8850 op0_is_copy = ((GET_CODE (op0) == SUBREG || GET_CODE (op0) == REG)
8851 && temp != get_last_insn ());
8852 op1 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), NULL_RTX, VOIDmode,
8853 EXPAND_MEMORY_USE_BAD);
8854
8855 /* Decide whether incrementing or decrementing. */
8856 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == POSTDECREMENT_EXPR
8857 || TREE_CODE (exp) == PREDECREMENT_EXPR)
8858 this_optab = sub_optab;
8859
8860 /* Convert decrement by a constant into a negative increment. */
8861 if (this_optab == sub_optab
8862 && GET_CODE (op1) == CONST_INT)
8863 {
8864 op1 = GEN_INT (- INTVAL (op1));
8865 this_optab = add_optab;
8866 }
8867
8868 /* For a preincrement, see if we can do this with a single instruction. */
8869 if (!post)
8870 {
8871 icode = (int) this_optab->handlers[(int) mode].insn_code;
8872 if (icode != (int) CODE_FOR_nothing
8873 /* Make sure that OP0 is valid for operands 0 and 1
8874 of the insn we want to queue. */
8875 && (*insn_data[icode].operand[0].predicate) (op0, mode)
8876 && (*insn_data[icode].operand[1].predicate) (op0, mode)
8877 && (*insn_data[icode].operand[2].predicate) (op1, mode))
8878 single_insn = 1;
8879 }
8880
8881 /* If OP0 is not the actual lvalue, but rather a copy in a register,
8882 then we cannot just increment OP0. We must therefore contrive to
8883 increment the original value. Then, for postincrement, we can return
8884 OP0 since it is a copy of the old value. For preincrement, expand here
8885 unless we can do it with a single insn.
8886
8887 Likewise if storing directly into OP0 would clobber high bits
8888 we need to preserve (bad_subreg). */
8889 if (op0_is_copy || (!post && !single_insn) || bad_subreg)
8890 {
8891 /* This is the easiest way to increment the value wherever it is.
8892 Problems with multiple evaluation of INCREMENTED are prevented
8893 because either (1) it is a component_ref or preincrement,
8894 in which case it was stabilized above, or (2) it is an array_ref
8895 with constant index in an array in a register, which is
8896 safe to reevaluate. */
8897 tree newexp = build (((TREE_CODE (exp) == POSTDECREMENT_EXPR
8898 || TREE_CODE (exp) == PREDECREMENT_EXPR)
8899 ? MINUS_EXPR : PLUS_EXPR),
8900 TREE_TYPE (exp),
8901 incremented,
8902 TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1));
8903
8904 while (TREE_CODE (incremented) == NOP_EXPR
8905 || TREE_CODE (incremented) == CONVERT_EXPR)
8906 {
8907 newexp = convert (TREE_TYPE (incremented), newexp);
8908 incremented = TREE_OPERAND (incremented, 0);
8909 }
8910
8911 temp = expand_assignment (incremented, newexp, ! post && ! ignore , 0);
8912 return post ? op0 : temp;
8913 }
8914
8915 if (post)
8916 {
8917 /* We have a true reference to the value in OP0.
8918 If there is an insn to add or subtract in this mode, queue it.
8919 Queueing the increment insn avoids the register shuffling
8920 that often results if we must increment now and first save
8921 the old value for subsequent use. */
8922
8923 #if 0 /* Turned off to avoid making extra insn for indexed memref. */
8924 op0 = stabilize (op0);
8925 #endif
8926
8927 icode = (int) this_optab->handlers[(int) mode].insn_code;
8928 if (icode != (int) CODE_FOR_nothing
8929 /* Make sure that OP0 is valid for operands 0 and 1
8930 of the insn we want to queue. */
8931 && (*insn_data[icode].operand[0].predicate) (op0, mode)
8932 && (*insn_data[icode].operand[1].predicate) (op0, mode))
8933 {
8934 if (! (*insn_data[icode].operand[2].predicate) (op1, mode))
8935 op1 = force_reg (mode, op1);
8936
8937 return enqueue_insn (op0, GEN_FCN (icode) (op0, op0, op1));
8938 }
8939 if (icode != (int) CODE_FOR_nothing && GET_CODE (op0) == MEM)
8940 {
8941 rtx addr = (general_operand (XEXP (op0, 0), mode)
8942 ? force_reg (Pmode, XEXP (op0, 0))
8943 : copy_to_reg (XEXP (op0, 0)));
8944 rtx temp, result;
8945
8946 op0 = change_address (op0, VOIDmode, addr);
8947 temp = force_reg (GET_MODE (op0), op0);
8948 if (! (*insn_data[icode].operand[2].predicate) (op1, mode))
8949 op1 = force_reg (mode, op1);
8950
8951 /* The increment queue is LIFO, thus we have to `queue'
8952 the instructions in reverse order. */
8953 enqueue_insn (op0, gen_move_insn (op0, temp));
8954 result = enqueue_insn (temp, GEN_FCN (icode) (temp, temp, op1));
8955 return result;
8956 }
8957 }
8958
8959 /* Preincrement, or we can't increment with one simple insn. */
8960 if (post)
8961 /* Save a copy of the value before inc or dec, to return it later. */
8962 temp = value = copy_to_reg (op0);
8963 else
8964 /* Arrange to return the incremented value. */
8965 /* Copy the rtx because expand_binop will protect from the queue,
8966 and the results of that would be invalid for us to return
8967 if our caller does emit_queue before using our result. */
8968 temp = copy_rtx (value = op0);
8969
8970 /* Increment however we can. */
8971 op1 = expand_binop (mode, this_optab, value, op1,
8972 current_function_check_memory_usage ? NULL_RTX : op0,
8973 TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (exp)), OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
8974 /* Make sure the value is stored into OP0. */
8975 if (op1 != op0)
8976 emit_move_insn (op0, op1);
8977
8978 return temp;
8979 }
8980 \f
8981 /* Expand all function calls contained within EXP, innermost ones first.
8982 But don't look within expressions that have sequence points.
8983 For each CALL_EXPR, record the rtx for its value
8984 in the CALL_EXPR_RTL field. */
8985
8986 static void
8987 preexpand_calls (exp)
8988 tree exp;
8989 {
8990 register int nops, i;
8991 int type = TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (exp));
8992
8993 if (! do_preexpand_calls)
8994 return;
8995
8996 /* Only expressions and references can contain calls. */
8997
8998 if (type != 'e' && type != '<' && type != '1' && type != '2' && type != 'r')
8999 return;
9000
9001 switch (TREE_CODE (exp))
9002 {
9003 case CALL_EXPR:
9004 /* Do nothing if already expanded. */
9005 if (CALL_EXPR_RTL (exp) != 0
9006 /* Do nothing if the call returns a variable-sized object. */
9007 || TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE(exp))) != INTEGER_CST
9008 /* Do nothing to built-in functions. */
9009 || (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)) == ADDR_EXPR
9010 && (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0))
9011 == FUNCTION_DECL)
9012 && DECL_BUILT_IN (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0))))
9013 return;
9014
9015 CALL_EXPR_RTL (exp) = expand_call (exp, NULL_RTX, 0);
9016 return;
9017
9018 case COMPOUND_EXPR:
9019 case COND_EXPR:
9020 case TRUTH_ANDIF_EXPR:
9021 case TRUTH_ORIF_EXPR:
9022 /* If we find one of these, then we can be sure
9023 the adjust will be done for it (since it makes jumps).
9024 Do it now, so that if this is inside an argument
9025 of a function, we don't get the stack adjustment
9026 after some other args have already been pushed. */
9027 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
9028 return;
9029
9030 case BLOCK:
9031 case RTL_EXPR:
9032 case WITH_CLEANUP_EXPR:
9033 case CLEANUP_POINT_EXPR:
9034 case TRY_CATCH_EXPR:
9035 return;
9036
9037 case SAVE_EXPR:
9038 if (SAVE_EXPR_RTL (exp) != 0)
9039 return;
9040
9041 default:
9042 break;
9043 }
9044
9045 nops = tree_code_length[(int) TREE_CODE (exp)];
9046 for (i = 0; i < nops; i++)
9047 if (TREE_OPERAND (exp, i) != 0)
9048 {
9049 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == TARGET_EXPR && i == 2)
9050 /* We don't need to preexpand the cleanup for a TARGET_EXPR.
9051 It doesn't happen before the call is made. */
9052 ;
9053 else
9054 {
9055 type = TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, i)));
9056 if (type == 'e' || type == '<' || type == '1' || type == '2'
9057 || type == 'r')
9058 preexpand_calls (TREE_OPERAND (exp, i));
9059 }
9060 }
9061 }
9062 \f
9063 /* At the start of a function, record that we have no previously-pushed
9064 arguments waiting to be popped. */
9065
9066 void
9067 init_pending_stack_adjust ()
9068 {
9069 pending_stack_adjust = 0;
9070 }
9071
9072 /* When exiting from function, if safe, clear out any pending stack adjust
9073 so the adjustment won't get done.
9074
9075 Note, if the current function calls alloca, then it must have a
9076 frame pointer regardless of the value of flag_omit_frame_pointer. */
9077
9078 void
9079 clear_pending_stack_adjust ()
9080 {
9081 #ifdef EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
9082 if (optimize > 0
9083 && (! flag_omit_frame_pointer || current_function_calls_alloca)
9084 && EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
9085 && ! (DECL_INLINE (current_function_decl) && ! flag_no_inline)
9086 && ! flag_inline_functions)
9087 pending_stack_adjust = 0;
9088 #endif
9089 }
9090
9091 /* Pop any previously-pushed arguments that have not been popped yet. */
9092
9093 void
9094 do_pending_stack_adjust ()
9095 {
9096 if (inhibit_defer_pop == 0)
9097 {
9098 if (pending_stack_adjust != 0)
9099 adjust_stack (GEN_INT (pending_stack_adjust));
9100 pending_stack_adjust = 0;
9101 }
9102 }
9103 \f
9104 /* Expand conditional expressions. */
9105
9106 /* Generate code to evaluate EXP and jump to LABEL if the value is zero.
9107 LABEL is an rtx of code CODE_LABEL, in this function and all the
9108 functions here. */
9109
9110 void
9111 jumpifnot (exp, label)
9112 tree exp;
9113 rtx label;
9114 {
9115 do_jump (exp, label, NULL_RTX);
9116 }
9117
9118 /* Generate code to evaluate EXP and jump to LABEL if the value is nonzero. */
9119
9120 void
9121 jumpif (exp, label)
9122 tree exp;
9123 rtx label;
9124 {
9125 do_jump (exp, NULL_RTX, label);
9126 }
9127
9128 /* Generate code to evaluate EXP and jump to IF_FALSE_LABEL if
9129 the result is zero, or IF_TRUE_LABEL if the result is one.
9130 Either of IF_FALSE_LABEL and IF_TRUE_LABEL may be zero,
9131 meaning fall through in that case.
9132
9133 do_jump always does any pending stack adjust except when it does not
9134 actually perform a jump. An example where there is no jump
9135 is when EXP is `(foo (), 0)' and IF_FALSE_LABEL is null.
9136
9137 This function is responsible for optimizing cases such as
9138 &&, || and comparison operators in EXP. */
9139
9140 void
9141 do_jump (exp, if_false_label, if_true_label)
9142 tree exp;
9143 rtx if_false_label, if_true_label;
9144 {
9145 register enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (exp);
9146 /* Some cases need to create a label to jump to
9147 in order to properly fall through.
9148 These cases set DROP_THROUGH_LABEL nonzero. */
9149 rtx drop_through_label = 0;
9150 rtx temp;
9151 int i;
9152 tree type;
9153 enum machine_mode mode;
9154
9155 #ifdef MAX_INTEGER_COMPUTATION_MODE
9156 check_max_integer_computation_mode (exp);
9157 #endif
9158
9159 emit_queue ();
9160
9161 switch (code)
9162 {
9163 case ERROR_MARK:
9164 break;
9165
9166 case INTEGER_CST:
9167 temp = integer_zerop (exp) ? if_false_label : if_true_label;
9168 if (temp)
9169 emit_jump (temp);
9170 break;
9171
9172 #if 0
9173 /* This is not true with #pragma weak */
9174 case ADDR_EXPR:
9175 /* The address of something can never be zero. */
9176 if (if_true_label)
9177 emit_jump (if_true_label);
9178 break;
9179 #endif
9180
9181 case NOP_EXPR:
9182 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)) == COMPONENT_REF
9183 || TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)) == BIT_FIELD_REF
9184 || TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)) == ARRAY_REF)
9185 goto normal;
9186 case CONVERT_EXPR:
9187 /* If we are narrowing the operand, we have to do the compare in the
9188 narrower mode. */
9189 if ((TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (exp))
9190 < TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)))))
9191 goto normal;
9192 case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
9193 case REFERENCE_EXPR:
9194 case ABS_EXPR:
9195 case NEGATE_EXPR:
9196 case LROTATE_EXPR:
9197 case RROTATE_EXPR:
9198 /* These cannot change zero->non-zero or vice versa. */
9199 do_jump (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), if_false_label, if_true_label);
9200 break;
9201
9202 case WITH_RECORD_EXPR:
9203 /* Put the object on the placeholder list, recurse through our first
9204 operand, and pop the list. */
9205 placeholder_list = tree_cons (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), NULL_TREE,
9206 placeholder_list);
9207 do_jump (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), if_false_label, if_true_label);
9208 placeholder_list = TREE_CHAIN (placeholder_list);
9209 break;
9210
9211 #if 0
9212 /* This is never less insns than evaluating the PLUS_EXPR followed by
9213 a test and can be longer if the test is eliminated. */
9214 case PLUS_EXPR:
9215 /* Reduce to minus. */
9216 exp = build (MINUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (exp),
9217 TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0),
9218 fold (build1 (NEGATE_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)),
9219 TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1))));
9220 /* Process as MINUS. */
9221 #endif
9222
9223 case MINUS_EXPR:
9224 /* Non-zero iff operands of minus differ. */
9225 do_compare_and_jump (build (NE_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (exp),
9226 TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0),
9227 TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)),
9228 NE, NE, if_false_label, if_true_label);
9229 break;
9230
9231 case BIT_AND_EXPR:
9232 /* If we are AND'ing with a small constant, do this comparison in the
9233 smallest type that fits. If the machine doesn't have comparisons
9234 that small, it will be converted back to the wider comparison.
9235 This helps if we are testing the sign bit of a narrower object.
9236 combine can't do this for us because it can't know whether a
9237 ZERO_EXTRACT or a compare in a smaller mode exists, but we do. */
9238
9239 if (! SLOW_BYTE_ACCESS
9240 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)) == INTEGER_CST
9241 && TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (exp)) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
9242 && (i = floor_log2 (TREE_INT_CST_LOW (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)))) >= 0
9243 && (mode = mode_for_size (i + 1, MODE_INT, 0)) != BLKmode
9244 && (type = type_for_mode (mode, 1)) != 0
9245 && TYPE_PRECISION (type) < TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (exp))
9246 && (cmp_optab->handlers[(int) TYPE_MODE (type)].insn_code
9247 != CODE_FOR_nothing))
9248 {
9249 do_jump (convert (type, exp), if_false_label, if_true_label);
9250 break;
9251 }
9252 goto normal;
9253
9254 case TRUTH_NOT_EXPR:
9255 do_jump (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), if_true_label, if_false_label);
9256 break;
9257
9258 case TRUTH_ANDIF_EXPR:
9259 if (if_false_label == 0)
9260 if_false_label = drop_through_label = gen_label_rtx ();
9261 do_jump (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), if_false_label, NULL_RTX);
9262 start_cleanup_deferral ();
9263 do_jump (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), if_false_label, if_true_label);
9264 end_cleanup_deferral ();
9265 break;
9266
9267 case TRUTH_ORIF_EXPR:
9268 if (if_true_label == 0)
9269 if_true_label = drop_through_label = gen_label_rtx ();
9270 do_jump (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), NULL_RTX, if_true_label);
9271 start_cleanup_deferral ();
9272 do_jump (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), if_false_label, if_true_label);
9273 end_cleanup_deferral ();
9274 break;
9275
9276 case COMPOUND_EXPR:
9277 push_temp_slots ();
9278 expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), const0_rtx, VOIDmode, 0);
9279 preserve_temp_slots (NULL_RTX);
9280 free_temp_slots ();
9281 pop_temp_slots ();
9282 emit_queue ();
9283 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
9284 do_jump (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), if_false_label, if_true_label);
9285 break;
9286
9287 case COMPONENT_REF:
9288 case BIT_FIELD_REF:
9289 case ARRAY_REF:
9290 {
9291 int bitsize, bitpos, unsignedp;
9292 enum machine_mode mode;
9293 tree type;
9294 tree offset;
9295 int volatilep = 0;
9296 int alignment;
9297
9298 /* Get description of this reference. We don't actually care
9299 about the underlying object here. */
9300 get_inner_reference (exp, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset,
9301 &mode, &unsignedp, &volatilep,
9302 &alignment);
9303
9304 type = type_for_size (bitsize, unsignedp);
9305 if (! SLOW_BYTE_ACCESS
9306 && type != 0 && bitsize >= 0
9307 && TYPE_PRECISION (type) < TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (exp))
9308 && (cmp_optab->handlers[(int) TYPE_MODE (type)].insn_code
9309 != CODE_FOR_nothing))
9310 {
9311 do_jump (convert (type, exp), if_false_label, if_true_label);
9312 break;
9313 }
9314 goto normal;
9315 }
9316
9317 case COND_EXPR:
9318 /* Do (a ? 1 : 0) and (a ? 0 : 1) as special cases. */
9319 if (integer_onep (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1))
9320 && integer_zerop (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2)))
9321 do_jump (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), if_false_label, if_true_label);
9322
9323 else if (integer_zerop (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1))
9324 && integer_onep (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2)))
9325 do_jump (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), if_true_label, if_false_label);
9326
9327 else
9328 {
9329 register rtx label1 = gen_label_rtx ();
9330 drop_through_label = gen_label_rtx ();
9331
9332 do_jump (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), label1, NULL_RTX);
9333
9334 start_cleanup_deferral ();
9335 /* Now the THEN-expression. */
9336 do_jump (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1),
9337 if_false_label ? if_false_label : drop_through_label,
9338 if_true_label ? if_true_label : drop_through_label);
9339 /* In case the do_jump just above never jumps. */
9340 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
9341 emit_label (label1);
9342
9343 /* Now the ELSE-expression. */
9344 do_jump (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2),
9345 if_false_label ? if_false_label : drop_through_label,
9346 if_true_label ? if_true_label : drop_through_label);
9347 end_cleanup_deferral ();
9348 }
9349 break;
9350
9351 case EQ_EXPR:
9352 {
9353 tree inner_type = TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
9354
9355 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (TYPE_MODE (inner_type)) == MODE_COMPLEX_FLOAT
9356 || GET_MODE_CLASS (TYPE_MODE (inner_type)) == MODE_COMPLEX_INT)
9357 {
9358 tree exp0 = save_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
9359 tree exp1 = save_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1));
9360 do_jump
9361 (fold
9362 (build (TRUTH_ANDIF_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (exp),
9363 fold (build (EQ_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (exp),
9364 fold (build1 (REALPART_EXPR,
9365 TREE_TYPE (inner_type),
9366 exp0)),
9367 fold (build1 (REALPART_EXPR,
9368 TREE_TYPE (inner_type),
9369 exp1)))),
9370 fold (build (EQ_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (exp),
9371 fold (build1 (IMAGPART_EXPR,
9372 TREE_TYPE (inner_type),
9373 exp0)),
9374 fold (build1 (IMAGPART_EXPR,
9375 TREE_TYPE (inner_type),
9376 exp1)))))),
9377 if_false_label, if_true_label);
9378 }
9379
9380 else if (integer_zerop (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)))
9381 do_jump (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), if_true_label, if_false_label);
9382
9383 else if (GET_MODE_CLASS (TYPE_MODE (inner_type)) == MODE_INT
9384 && !can_compare_p (TYPE_MODE (inner_type), ccp_jump))
9385 do_jump_by_parts_equality (exp, if_false_label, if_true_label);
9386 else
9387 do_compare_and_jump (exp, EQ, EQ, if_false_label, if_true_label);
9388 break;
9389 }
9390
9391 case NE_EXPR:
9392 {
9393 tree inner_type = TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
9394
9395 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (TYPE_MODE (inner_type)) == MODE_COMPLEX_FLOAT
9396 || GET_MODE_CLASS (TYPE_MODE (inner_type)) == MODE_COMPLEX_INT)
9397 {
9398 tree exp0 = save_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
9399 tree exp1 = save_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1));
9400 do_jump
9401 (fold
9402 (build (TRUTH_ORIF_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (exp),
9403 fold (build (NE_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (exp),
9404 fold (build1 (REALPART_EXPR,
9405 TREE_TYPE (inner_type),
9406 exp0)),
9407 fold (build1 (REALPART_EXPR,
9408 TREE_TYPE (inner_type),
9409 exp1)))),
9410 fold (build (NE_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (exp),
9411 fold (build1 (IMAGPART_EXPR,
9412 TREE_TYPE (inner_type),
9413 exp0)),
9414 fold (build1 (IMAGPART_EXPR,
9415 TREE_TYPE (inner_type),
9416 exp1)))))),
9417 if_false_label, if_true_label);
9418 }
9419
9420 else if (integer_zerop (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)))
9421 do_jump (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), if_false_label, if_true_label);
9422
9423 else if (GET_MODE_CLASS (TYPE_MODE (inner_type)) == MODE_INT
9424 && !can_compare_p (TYPE_MODE (inner_type), ccp_jump))
9425 do_jump_by_parts_equality (exp, if_true_label, if_false_label);
9426 else
9427 do_compare_and_jump (exp, NE, NE, if_false_label, if_true_label);
9428 break;
9429 }
9430
9431 case LT_EXPR:
9432 mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)));
9433 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
9434 && ! can_compare_p (mode, ccp_jump))
9435 do_jump_by_parts_greater (exp, 1, if_false_label, if_true_label);
9436 else
9437 do_compare_and_jump (exp, LT, LTU, if_false_label, if_true_label);
9438 break;
9439
9440 case LE_EXPR:
9441 mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)));
9442 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
9443 && ! can_compare_p (mode, ccp_jump))
9444 do_jump_by_parts_greater (exp, 0, if_true_label, if_false_label);
9445 else
9446 do_compare_and_jump (exp, LE, LEU, if_false_label, if_true_label);
9447 break;
9448
9449 case GT_EXPR:
9450 mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)));
9451 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
9452 && ! can_compare_p (mode, ccp_jump))
9453 do_jump_by_parts_greater (exp, 0, if_false_label, if_true_label);
9454 else
9455 do_compare_and_jump (exp, GT, GTU, if_false_label, if_true_label);
9456 break;
9457
9458 case GE_EXPR:
9459 mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)));
9460 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
9461 && ! can_compare_p (mode, ccp_jump))
9462 do_jump_by_parts_greater (exp, 1, if_true_label, if_false_label);
9463 else
9464 do_compare_and_jump (exp, GE, GEU, if_false_label, if_true_label);
9465 break;
9466
9467 default:
9468 normal:
9469 temp = expand_expr (exp, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
9470 #if 0
9471 /* This is not needed any more and causes poor code since it causes
9472 comparisons and tests from non-SI objects to have different code
9473 sequences. */
9474 /* Copy to register to avoid generating bad insns by cse
9475 from (set (mem ...) (arithop)) (set (cc0) (mem ...)). */
9476 if (!cse_not_expected && GET_CODE (temp) == MEM)
9477 temp = copy_to_reg (temp);
9478 #endif
9479 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
9480 /* Do any postincrements in the expression that was tested. */
9481 emit_queue ();
9482
9483 if (GET_CODE (temp) == CONST_INT || GET_CODE (temp) == LABEL_REF)
9484 {
9485 rtx target = temp == const0_rtx ? if_false_label : if_true_label;
9486 if (target)
9487 emit_jump (target);
9488 }
9489 else if (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (temp)) == MODE_INT
9490 && ! can_compare_p (GET_MODE (temp), ccp_jump))
9491 /* Note swapping the labels gives us not-equal. */
9492 do_jump_by_parts_equality_rtx (temp, if_true_label, if_false_label);
9493 else if (GET_MODE (temp) != VOIDmode)
9494 do_compare_rtx_and_jump (temp, CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE (temp)),
9495 NE, TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (exp)),
9496 GET_MODE (temp), NULL_RTX, 0,
9497 if_false_label, if_true_label);
9498 else
9499 abort ();
9500 }
9501
9502 if (drop_through_label)
9503 {
9504 /* If do_jump produces code that might be jumped around,
9505 do any stack adjusts from that code, before the place
9506 where control merges in. */
9507 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
9508 emit_label (drop_through_label);
9509 }
9510 }
9511 \f
9512 /* Given a comparison expression EXP for values too wide to be compared
9513 with one insn, test the comparison and jump to the appropriate label.
9514 The code of EXP is ignored; we always test GT if SWAP is 0,
9515 and LT if SWAP is 1. */
9516
9517 static void
9518 do_jump_by_parts_greater (exp, swap, if_false_label, if_true_label)
9519 tree exp;
9520 int swap;
9521 rtx if_false_label, if_true_label;
9522 {
9523 rtx op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, swap), NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
9524 rtx op1 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, !swap), NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
9525 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)));
9526 int unsignedp = TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)));
9527
9528 do_jump_by_parts_greater_rtx (mode, unsignedp, op0, op1, if_false_label, if_true_label);
9529 }
9530
9531 /* Compare OP0 with OP1, word at a time, in mode MODE.
9532 UNSIGNEDP says to do unsigned comparison.
9533 Jump to IF_TRUE_LABEL if OP0 is greater, IF_FALSE_LABEL otherwise. */
9534
9535 void
9536 do_jump_by_parts_greater_rtx (mode, unsignedp, op0, op1, if_false_label, if_true_label)
9537 enum machine_mode mode;
9538 int unsignedp;
9539 rtx op0, op1;
9540 rtx if_false_label, if_true_label;
9541 {
9542 int nwords = (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) / UNITS_PER_WORD);
9543 rtx drop_through_label = 0;
9544 int i;
9545
9546 if (! if_true_label || ! if_false_label)
9547 drop_through_label = gen_label_rtx ();
9548 if (! if_true_label)
9549 if_true_label = drop_through_label;
9550 if (! if_false_label)
9551 if_false_label = drop_through_label;
9552
9553 /* Compare a word at a time, high order first. */
9554 for (i = 0; i < nwords; i++)
9555 {
9556 rtx op0_word, op1_word;
9557
9558 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
9559 {
9560 op0_word = operand_subword_force (op0, i, mode);
9561 op1_word = operand_subword_force (op1, i, mode);
9562 }
9563 else
9564 {
9565 op0_word = operand_subword_force (op0, nwords - 1 - i, mode);
9566 op1_word = operand_subword_force (op1, nwords - 1 - i, mode);
9567 }
9568
9569 /* All but high-order word must be compared as unsigned. */
9570 do_compare_rtx_and_jump (op0_word, op1_word, GT,
9571 (unsignedp || i > 0), word_mode, NULL_RTX, 0,
9572 NULL_RTX, if_true_label);
9573
9574 /* Consider lower words only if these are equal. */
9575 do_compare_rtx_and_jump (op0_word, op1_word, NE, unsignedp, word_mode,
9576 NULL_RTX, 0, NULL_RTX, if_false_label);
9577 }
9578
9579 if (if_false_label)
9580 emit_jump (if_false_label);
9581 if (drop_through_label)
9582 emit_label (drop_through_label);
9583 }
9584
9585 /* Given an EQ_EXPR expression EXP for values too wide to be compared
9586 with one insn, test the comparison and jump to the appropriate label. */
9587
9588 static void
9589 do_jump_by_parts_equality (exp, if_false_label, if_true_label)
9590 tree exp;
9591 rtx if_false_label, if_true_label;
9592 {
9593 rtx op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
9594 rtx op1 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
9595 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)));
9596 int nwords = (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) / UNITS_PER_WORD);
9597 int i;
9598 rtx drop_through_label = 0;
9599
9600 if (! if_false_label)
9601 drop_through_label = if_false_label = gen_label_rtx ();
9602
9603 for (i = 0; i < nwords; i++)
9604 do_compare_rtx_and_jump (operand_subword_force (op0, i, mode),
9605 operand_subword_force (op1, i, mode),
9606 EQ, TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (exp)),
9607 word_mode, NULL_RTX, 0, if_false_label,
9608 NULL_RTX);
9609
9610 if (if_true_label)
9611 emit_jump (if_true_label);
9612 if (drop_through_label)
9613 emit_label (drop_through_label);
9614 }
9615 \f
9616 /* Jump according to whether OP0 is 0.
9617 We assume that OP0 has an integer mode that is too wide
9618 for the available compare insns. */
9619
9620 void
9621 do_jump_by_parts_equality_rtx (op0, if_false_label, if_true_label)
9622 rtx op0;
9623 rtx if_false_label, if_true_label;
9624 {
9625 int nwords = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (op0)) / UNITS_PER_WORD;
9626 rtx part;
9627 int i;
9628 rtx drop_through_label = 0;
9629
9630 /* The fastest way of doing this comparison on almost any machine is to
9631 "or" all the words and compare the result. If all have to be loaded
9632 from memory and this is a very wide item, it's possible this may
9633 be slower, but that's highly unlikely. */
9634
9635 part = gen_reg_rtx (word_mode);
9636 emit_move_insn (part, operand_subword_force (op0, 0, GET_MODE (op0)));
9637 for (i = 1; i < nwords && part != 0; i++)
9638 part = expand_binop (word_mode, ior_optab, part,
9639 operand_subword_force (op0, i, GET_MODE (op0)),
9640 part, 1, OPTAB_WIDEN);
9641
9642 if (part != 0)
9643 {
9644 do_compare_rtx_and_jump (part, const0_rtx, EQ, 1, word_mode,
9645 NULL_RTX, 0, if_false_label, if_true_label);
9646
9647 return;
9648 }
9649
9650 /* If we couldn't do the "or" simply, do this with a series of compares. */
9651 if (! if_false_label)
9652 drop_through_label = if_false_label = gen_label_rtx ();
9653
9654 for (i = 0; i < nwords; i++)
9655 do_compare_rtx_and_jump (operand_subword_force (op0, i, GET_MODE (op0)),
9656 const0_rtx, EQ, 1, word_mode, NULL_RTX, 0,
9657 if_false_label, NULL_RTX);
9658
9659 if (if_true_label)
9660 emit_jump (if_true_label);
9661
9662 if (drop_through_label)
9663 emit_label (drop_through_label);
9664 }
9665 \f
9666 /* Generate code for a comparison of OP0 and OP1 with rtx code CODE.
9667 (including code to compute the values to be compared)
9668 and set (CC0) according to the result.
9669 The decision as to signed or unsigned comparison must be made by the caller.
9670
9671 We force a stack adjustment unless there are currently
9672 things pushed on the stack that aren't yet used.
9673
9674 If MODE is BLKmode, SIZE is an RTX giving the size of the objects being
9675 compared.
9676
9677 If ALIGN is non-zero, it is the alignment of this type; if zero, the
9678 size of MODE should be used. */
9679
9680 rtx
9681 compare_from_rtx (op0, op1, code, unsignedp, mode, size, align)
9682 register rtx op0, op1;
9683 enum rtx_code code;
9684 int unsignedp;
9685 enum machine_mode mode;
9686 rtx size;
9687 int align;
9688 {
9689 rtx tem;
9690
9691 /* If one operand is constant, make it the second one. Only do this
9692 if the other operand is not constant as well. */
9693
9694 if ((CONSTANT_P (op0) && ! CONSTANT_P (op1))
9695 || (GET_CODE (op0) == CONST_INT && GET_CODE (op1) != CONST_INT))
9696 {
9697 tem = op0;
9698 op0 = op1;
9699 op1 = tem;
9700 code = swap_condition (code);
9701 }
9702
9703 if (flag_force_mem)
9704 {
9705 op0 = force_not_mem (op0);
9706 op1 = force_not_mem (op1);
9707 }
9708
9709 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
9710
9711 if (GET_CODE (op0) == CONST_INT && GET_CODE (op1) == CONST_INT
9712 && (tem = simplify_relational_operation (code, mode, op0, op1)) != 0)
9713 return tem;
9714
9715 #if 0
9716 /* There's no need to do this now that combine.c can eliminate lots of
9717 sign extensions. This can be less efficient in certain cases on other
9718 machines. */
9719
9720 /* If this is a signed equality comparison, we can do it as an
9721 unsigned comparison since zero-extension is cheaper than sign
9722 extension and comparisons with zero are done as unsigned. This is
9723 the case even on machines that can do fast sign extension, since
9724 zero-extension is easier to combine with other operations than
9725 sign-extension is. If we are comparing against a constant, we must
9726 convert it to what it would look like unsigned. */
9727 if ((code == EQ || code == NE) && ! unsignedp
9728 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (op0)) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
9729 {
9730 if (GET_CODE (op1) == CONST_INT
9731 && (INTVAL (op1) & GET_MODE_MASK (GET_MODE (op0))) != INTVAL (op1))
9732 op1 = GEN_INT (INTVAL (op1) & GET_MODE_MASK (GET_MODE (op0)));
9733 unsignedp = 1;
9734 }
9735 #endif
9736
9737 emit_cmp_insn (op0, op1, code, size, mode, unsignedp, align);
9738
9739 return gen_rtx_fmt_ee (code, VOIDmode, cc0_rtx, const0_rtx);
9740 }
9741
9742 /* Like do_compare_and_jump but expects the values to compare as two rtx's.
9743 The decision as to signed or unsigned comparison must be made by the caller.
9744
9745 If MODE is BLKmode, SIZE is an RTX giving the size of the objects being
9746 compared.
9747
9748 If ALIGN is non-zero, it is the alignment of this type; if zero, the
9749 size of MODE should be used. */
9750
9751 void
9752 do_compare_rtx_and_jump (op0, op1, code, unsignedp, mode, size, align,
9753 if_false_label, if_true_label)
9754 register rtx op0, op1;
9755 enum rtx_code code;
9756 int unsignedp;
9757 enum machine_mode mode;
9758 rtx size;
9759 int align;
9760 rtx if_false_label, if_true_label;
9761 {
9762 rtx tem;
9763 int dummy_true_label = 0;
9764
9765 /* Reverse the comparison if that is safe and we want to jump if it is
9766 false. */
9767 if (! if_true_label && ! FLOAT_MODE_P (mode))
9768 {
9769 if_true_label = if_false_label;
9770 if_false_label = 0;
9771 code = reverse_condition (code);
9772 }
9773
9774 /* If one operand is constant, make it the second one. Only do this
9775 if the other operand is not constant as well. */
9776
9777 if ((CONSTANT_P (op0) && ! CONSTANT_P (op1))
9778 || (GET_CODE (op0) == CONST_INT && GET_CODE (op1) != CONST_INT))
9779 {
9780 tem = op0;
9781 op0 = op1;
9782 op1 = tem;
9783 code = swap_condition (code);
9784 }
9785
9786 if (flag_force_mem)
9787 {
9788 op0 = force_not_mem (op0);
9789 op1 = force_not_mem (op1);
9790 }
9791
9792 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
9793
9794 if (GET_CODE (op0) == CONST_INT && GET_CODE (op1) == CONST_INT
9795 && (tem = simplify_relational_operation (code, mode, op0, op1)) != 0)
9796 {
9797 if (tem == const_true_rtx)
9798 {
9799 if (if_true_label)
9800 emit_jump (if_true_label);
9801 }
9802 else
9803 {
9804 if (if_false_label)
9805 emit_jump (if_false_label);
9806 }
9807 return;
9808 }
9809
9810 #if 0
9811 /* There's no need to do this now that combine.c can eliminate lots of
9812 sign extensions. This can be less efficient in certain cases on other
9813 machines. */
9814
9815 /* If this is a signed equality comparison, we can do it as an
9816 unsigned comparison since zero-extension is cheaper than sign
9817 extension and comparisons with zero are done as unsigned. This is
9818 the case even on machines that can do fast sign extension, since
9819 zero-extension is easier to combine with other operations than
9820 sign-extension is. If we are comparing against a constant, we must
9821 convert it to what it would look like unsigned. */
9822 if ((code == EQ || code == NE) && ! unsignedp
9823 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (op0)) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
9824 {
9825 if (GET_CODE (op1) == CONST_INT
9826 && (INTVAL (op1) & GET_MODE_MASK (GET_MODE (op0))) != INTVAL (op1))
9827 op1 = GEN_INT (INTVAL (op1) & GET_MODE_MASK (GET_MODE (op0)));
9828 unsignedp = 1;
9829 }
9830 #endif
9831
9832 if (! if_true_label)
9833 {
9834 dummy_true_label = 1;
9835 if_true_label = gen_label_rtx ();
9836 }
9837
9838 emit_cmp_and_jump_insns (op0, op1, code, size, mode, unsignedp, align,
9839 if_true_label);
9840
9841 if (if_false_label)
9842 emit_jump (if_false_label);
9843 if (dummy_true_label)
9844 emit_label (if_true_label);
9845 }
9846
9847 /* Generate code for a comparison expression EXP (including code to compute
9848 the values to be compared) and a conditional jump to IF_FALSE_LABEL and/or
9849 IF_TRUE_LABEL. One of the labels can be NULL_RTX, in which case the
9850 generated code will drop through.
9851 SIGNED_CODE should be the rtx operation for this comparison for
9852 signed data; UNSIGNED_CODE, likewise for use if data is unsigned.
9853
9854 We force a stack adjustment unless there are currently
9855 things pushed on the stack that aren't yet used. */
9856
9857 static void
9858 do_compare_and_jump (exp, signed_code, unsigned_code, if_false_label,
9859 if_true_label)
9860 register tree exp;
9861 enum rtx_code signed_code, unsigned_code;
9862 rtx if_false_label, if_true_label;
9863 {
9864 int align0, align1;
9865 register rtx op0, op1;
9866 register tree type;
9867 register enum machine_mode mode;
9868 int unsignedp;
9869 enum rtx_code code;
9870
9871 /* Don't crash if the comparison was erroneous. */
9872 op0 = expand_expr_unaligned (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), &align0);
9873 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)) == ERROR_MARK)
9874 return;
9875
9876 op1 = expand_expr_unaligned (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), &align1);
9877 type = TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
9878 mode = TYPE_MODE (type);
9879 unsignedp = TREE_UNSIGNED (type);
9880 code = unsignedp ? unsigned_code : signed_code;
9881
9882 #ifdef HAVE_canonicalize_funcptr_for_compare
9883 /* If function pointers need to be "canonicalized" before they can
9884 be reliably compared, then canonicalize them. */
9885 if (HAVE_canonicalize_funcptr_for_compare
9886 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))) == POINTER_TYPE
9887 && (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))))
9888 == FUNCTION_TYPE))
9889 {
9890 rtx new_op0 = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
9891
9892 emit_insn (gen_canonicalize_funcptr_for_compare (new_op0, op0));
9893 op0 = new_op0;
9894 }
9895
9896 if (HAVE_canonicalize_funcptr_for_compare
9897 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1))) == POINTER_TYPE
9898 && (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1))))
9899 == FUNCTION_TYPE))
9900 {
9901 rtx new_op1 = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
9902
9903 emit_insn (gen_canonicalize_funcptr_for_compare (new_op1, op1));
9904 op1 = new_op1;
9905 }
9906 #endif
9907
9908 /* Do any postincrements in the expression that was tested. */
9909 emit_queue ();
9910
9911 do_compare_rtx_and_jump (op0, op1, code, unsignedp, mode,
9912 ((mode == BLKmode)
9913 ? expr_size (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)) : NULL_RTX),
9914 MIN (align0, align1) / BITS_PER_UNIT,
9915 if_false_label, if_true_label);
9916 }
9917 \f
9918 /* Generate code to calculate EXP using a store-flag instruction
9919 and return an rtx for the result. EXP is either a comparison
9920 or a TRUTH_NOT_EXPR whose operand is a comparison.
9921
9922 If TARGET is nonzero, store the result there if convenient.
9923
9924 If ONLY_CHEAP is non-zero, only do this if it is likely to be very
9925 cheap.
9926
9927 Return zero if there is no suitable set-flag instruction
9928 available on this machine.
9929
9930 Once expand_expr has been called on the arguments of the comparison,
9931 we are committed to doing the store flag, since it is not safe to
9932 re-evaluate the expression. We emit the store-flag insn by calling
9933 emit_store_flag, but only expand the arguments if we have a reason
9934 to believe that emit_store_flag will be successful. If we think that
9935 it will, but it isn't, we have to simulate the store-flag with a
9936 set/jump/set sequence. */
9937
9938 static rtx
9939 do_store_flag (exp, target, mode, only_cheap)
9940 tree exp;
9941 rtx target;
9942 enum machine_mode mode;
9943 int only_cheap;
9944 {
9945 enum rtx_code code;
9946 tree arg0, arg1, type;
9947 tree tem;
9948 enum machine_mode operand_mode;
9949 int invert = 0;
9950 int unsignedp;
9951 rtx op0, op1;
9952 enum insn_code icode;
9953 rtx subtarget = target;
9954 rtx result, label;
9955
9956 /* If this is a TRUTH_NOT_EXPR, set a flag indicating we must invert the
9957 result at the end. We can't simply invert the test since it would
9958 have already been inverted if it were valid. This case occurs for
9959 some floating-point comparisons. */
9960
9961 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == TRUTH_NOT_EXPR)
9962 invert = 1, exp = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
9963
9964 arg0 = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
9965 arg1 = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
9966 type = TREE_TYPE (arg0);
9967 operand_mode = TYPE_MODE (type);
9968 unsignedp = TREE_UNSIGNED (type);
9969
9970 /* We won't bother with BLKmode store-flag operations because it would mean
9971 passing a lot of information to emit_store_flag. */
9972 if (operand_mode == BLKmode)
9973 return 0;
9974
9975 /* We won't bother with store-flag operations involving function pointers
9976 when function pointers must be canonicalized before comparisons. */
9977 #ifdef HAVE_canonicalize_funcptr_for_compare
9978 if (HAVE_canonicalize_funcptr_for_compare
9979 && ((TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))) == POINTER_TYPE
9980 && (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))))
9981 == FUNCTION_TYPE))
9982 || (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1))) == POINTER_TYPE
9983 && (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1))))
9984 == FUNCTION_TYPE))))
9985 return 0;
9986 #endif
9987
9988 STRIP_NOPS (arg0);
9989 STRIP_NOPS (arg1);
9990
9991 /* Get the rtx comparison code to use. We know that EXP is a comparison
9992 operation of some type. Some comparisons against 1 and -1 can be
9993 converted to comparisons with zero. Do so here so that the tests
9994 below will be aware that we have a comparison with zero. These
9995 tests will not catch constants in the first operand, but constants
9996 are rarely passed as the first operand. */
9997
9998 switch (TREE_CODE (exp))
9999 {
10000 case EQ_EXPR:
10001 code = EQ;
10002 break;
10003 case NE_EXPR:
10004 code = NE;
10005 break;
10006 case LT_EXPR:
10007 if (integer_onep (arg1))
10008 arg1 = integer_zero_node, code = unsignedp ? LEU : LE;
10009 else
10010 code = unsignedp ? LTU : LT;
10011 break;
10012 case LE_EXPR:
10013 if (! unsignedp && integer_all_onesp (arg1))
10014 arg1 = integer_zero_node, code = LT;
10015 else
10016 code = unsignedp ? LEU : LE;
10017 break;
10018 case GT_EXPR:
10019 if (! unsignedp && integer_all_onesp (arg1))
10020 arg1 = integer_zero_node, code = GE;
10021 else
10022 code = unsignedp ? GTU : GT;
10023 break;
10024 case GE_EXPR:
10025 if (integer_onep (arg1))
10026 arg1 = integer_zero_node, code = unsignedp ? GTU : GT;
10027 else
10028 code = unsignedp ? GEU : GE;
10029 break;
10030 default:
10031 abort ();
10032 }
10033
10034 /* Put a constant second. */
10035 if (TREE_CODE (arg0) == REAL_CST || TREE_CODE (arg0) == INTEGER_CST)
10036 {
10037 tem = arg0; arg0 = arg1; arg1 = tem;
10038 code = swap_condition (code);
10039 }
10040
10041 /* If this is an equality or inequality test of a single bit, we can
10042 do this by shifting the bit being tested to the low-order bit and
10043 masking the result with the constant 1. If the condition was EQ,
10044 we xor it with 1. This does not require an scc insn and is faster
10045 than an scc insn even if we have it. */
10046
10047 if ((code == NE || code == EQ)
10048 && TREE_CODE (arg0) == BIT_AND_EXPR && integer_zerop (arg1)
10049 && integer_pow2p (TREE_OPERAND (arg0, 1)))
10050 {
10051 tree inner = TREE_OPERAND (arg0, 0);
10052 int bitnum = tree_log2 (TREE_OPERAND (arg0, 1));
10053 int ops_unsignedp;
10054
10055 /* If INNER is a right shift of a constant and it plus BITNUM does
10056 not overflow, adjust BITNUM and INNER. */
10057
10058 if (TREE_CODE (inner) == RSHIFT_EXPR
10059 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (inner, 1)) == INTEGER_CST
10060 && TREE_INT_CST_HIGH (TREE_OPERAND (inner, 1)) == 0
10061 && (bitnum + TREE_INT_CST_LOW (TREE_OPERAND (inner, 1))
10062 < TYPE_PRECISION (type)))
10063 {
10064 bitnum += TREE_INT_CST_LOW (TREE_OPERAND (inner, 1));
10065 inner = TREE_OPERAND (inner, 0);
10066 }
10067
10068 /* If we are going to be able to omit the AND below, we must do our
10069 operations as unsigned. If we must use the AND, we have a choice.
10070 Normally unsigned is faster, but for some machines signed is. */
10071 ops_unsignedp = (bitnum == TYPE_PRECISION (type) - 1 ? 1
10072 #ifdef LOAD_EXTEND_OP
10073 : (LOAD_EXTEND_OP (operand_mode) == SIGN_EXTEND ? 0 : 1)
10074 #else
10075 : 1
10076 #endif
10077 );
10078
10079 if (subtarget == 0 || GET_CODE (subtarget) != REG
10080 || GET_MODE (subtarget) != operand_mode
10081 || ! safe_from_p (subtarget, inner, 1))
10082 subtarget = 0;
10083
10084 op0 = expand_expr (inner, subtarget, VOIDmode, 0);
10085
10086 if (bitnum != 0)
10087 op0 = expand_shift (RSHIFT_EXPR, GET_MODE (op0), op0,
10088 size_int (bitnum), subtarget, ops_unsignedp);
10089
10090 if (GET_MODE (op0) != mode)
10091 op0 = convert_to_mode (mode, op0, ops_unsignedp);
10092
10093 if ((code == EQ && ! invert) || (code == NE && invert))
10094 op0 = expand_binop (mode, xor_optab, op0, const1_rtx, subtarget,
10095 ops_unsignedp, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
10096
10097 /* Put the AND last so it can combine with more things. */
10098 if (bitnum != TYPE_PRECISION (type) - 1)
10099 op0 = expand_and (op0, const1_rtx, subtarget);
10100
10101 return op0;
10102 }
10103
10104 /* Now see if we are likely to be able to do this. Return if not. */
10105 if (! can_compare_p (operand_mode, ccp_store_flag))
10106 return 0;
10107 icode = setcc_gen_code[(int) code];
10108 if (icode == CODE_FOR_nothing
10109 || (only_cheap && insn_data[(int) icode].operand[0].mode != mode))
10110 {
10111 /* We can only do this if it is one of the special cases that
10112 can be handled without an scc insn. */
10113 if ((code == LT && integer_zerop (arg1))
10114 || (! only_cheap && code == GE && integer_zerop (arg1)))
10115 ;
10116 else if (BRANCH_COST >= 0
10117 && ! only_cheap && (code == NE || code == EQ)
10118 && TREE_CODE (type) != REAL_TYPE
10119 && ((abs_optab->handlers[(int) operand_mode].insn_code
10120 != CODE_FOR_nothing)
10121 || (ffs_optab->handlers[(int) operand_mode].insn_code
10122 != CODE_FOR_nothing)))
10123 ;
10124 else
10125 return 0;
10126 }
10127
10128 preexpand_calls (exp);
10129 if (subtarget == 0 || GET_CODE (subtarget) != REG
10130 || GET_MODE (subtarget) != operand_mode
10131 || ! safe_from_p (subtarget, arg1, 1))
10132 subtarget = 0;
10133
10134 op0 = expand_expr (arg0, subtarget, VOIDmode, 0);
10135 op1 = expand_expr (arg1, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
10136
10137 if (target == 0)
10138 target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
10139
10140 /* Pass copies of OP0 and OP1 in case they contain a QUEUED. This is safe
10141 because, if the emit_store_flag does anything it will succeed and
10142 OP0 and OP1 will not be used subsequently. */
10143
10144 result = emit_store_flag (target, code,
10145 queued_subexp_p (op0) ? copy_rtx (op0) : op0,
10146 queued_subexp_p (op1) ? copy_rtx (op1) : op1,
10147 operand_mode, unsignedp, 1);
10148
10149 if (result)
10150 {
10151 if (invert)
10152 result = expand_binop (mode, xor_optab, result, const1_rtx,
10153 result, 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
10154 return result;
10155 }
10156
10157 /* If this failed, we have to do this with set/compare/jump/set code. */
10158 if (GET_CODE (target) != REG
10159 || reg_mentioned_p (target, op0) || reg_mentioned_p (target, op1))
10160 target = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (target));
10161
10162 emit_move_insn (target, invert ? const0_rtx : const1_rtx);
10163 result = compare_from_rtx (op0, op1, code, unsignedp,
10164 operand_mode, NULL_RTX, 0);
10165 if (GET_CODE (result) == CONST_INT)
10166 return (((result == const0_rtx && ! invert)
10167 || (result != const0_rtx && invert))
10168 ? const0_rtx : const1_rtx);
10169
10170 label = gen_label_rtx ();
10171 if (bcc_gen_fctn[(int) code] == 0)
10172 abort ();
10173
10174 emit_jump_insn ((*bcc_gen_fctn[(int) code]) (label));
10175 emit_move_insn (target, invert ? const1_rtx : const0_rtx);
10176 emit_label (label);
10177
10178 return target;
10179 }
10180 \f
10181 /* Generate a tablejump instruction (used for switch statements). */
10182
10183 #ifdef HAVE_tablejump
10184
10185 /* INDEX is the value being switched on, with the lowest value
10186 in the table already subtracted.
10187 MODE is its expected mode (needed if INDEX is constant).
10188 RANGE is the length of the jump table.
10189 TABLE_LABEL is a CODE_LABEL rtx for the table itself.
10190
10191 DEFAULT_LABEL is a CODE_LABEL rtx to jump to if the
10192 index value is out of range. */
10193
10194 void
10195 do_tablejump (index, mode, range, table_label, default_label)
10196 rtx index, range, table_label, default_label;
10197 enum machine_mode mode;
10198 {
10199 register rtx temp, vector;
10200
10201 /* Do an unsigned comparison (in the proper mode) between the index
10202 expression and the value which represents the length of the range.
10203 Since we just finished subtracting the lower bound of the range
10204 from the index expression, this comparison allows us to simultaneously
10205 check that the original index expression value is both greater than
10206 or equal to the minimum value of the range and less than or equal to
10207 the maximum value of the range. */
10208
10209 emit_cmp_and_jump_insns (index, range, GTU, NULL_RTX, mode, 1,
10210 0, default_label);
10211
10212 /* If index is in range, it must fit in Pmode.
10213 Convert to Pmode so we can index with it. */
10214 if (mode != Pmode)
10215 index = convert_to_mode (Pmode, index, 1);
10216
10217 /* Don't let a MEM slip thru, because then INDEX that comes
10218 out of PIC_CASE_VECTOR_ADDRESS won't be a valid address,
10219 and break_out_memory_refs will go to work on it and mess it up. */
10220 #ifdef PIC_CASE_VECTOR_ADDRESS
10221 if (flag_pic && GET_CODE (index) != REG)
10222 index = copy_to_mode_reg (Pmode, index);
10223 #endif
10224
10225 /* If flag_force_addr were to affect this address
10226 it could interfere with the tricky assumptions made
10227 about addresses that contain label-refs,
10228 which may be valid only very near the tablejump itself. */
10229 /* ??? The only correct use of CASE_VECTOR_MODE is the one inside the
10230 GET_MODE_SIZE, because this indicates how large insns are. The other
10231 uses should all be Pmode, because they are addresses. This code
10232 could fail if addresses and insns are not the same size. */
10233 index = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode,
10234 gen_rtx_MULT (Pmode, index,
10235 GEN_INT (GET_MODE_SIZE (CASE_VECTOR_MODE))),
10236 gen_rtx_LABEL_REF (Pmode, table_label));
10237 #ifdef PIC_CASE_VECTOR_ADDRESS
10238 if (flag_pic)
10239 index = PIC_CASE_VECTOR_ADDRESS (index);
10240 else
10241 #endif
10242 index = memory_address_noforce (CASE_VECTOR_MODE, index);
10243 temp = gen_reg_rtx (CASE_VECTOR_MODE);
10244 vector = gen_rtx_MEM (CASE_VECTOR_MODE, index);
10245 RTX_UNCHANGING_P (vector) = 1;
10246 convert_move (temp, vector, 0);
10247
10248 emit_jump_insn (gen_tablejump (temp, table_label));
10249
10250 /* If we are generating PIC code or if the table is PC-relative, the
10251 table and JUMP_INSN must be adjacent, so don't output a BARRIER. */
10252 if (! CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE && ! flag_pic)
10253 emit_barrier ();
10254 }
10255
10256 #endif /* HAVE_tablejump */